xref: /NextBSD/contrib/binutils/bfd/elfxx-mips.c (revision eb1a5f8de9f7ea602c373a710f531abbf81141c4)
1 /* MIPS-specific support for ELF
2    Copyright 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002,
3    2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4 
5    Most of the information added by Ian Lance Taylor, Cygnus Support,
6    <ian@cygnus.com>.
7    N32/64 ABI support added by Mark Mitchell, CodeSourcery, LLC.
8    <mark@codesourcery.com>
9    Traditional MIPS targets support added by Koundinya.K, Dansk Data
10    Elektronik & Operations Research Group. <kk@ddeorg.soft.net>
11 
12    This file is part of BFD, the Binary File Descriptor library.
13 
14    This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
15    it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
16    the Free Software Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or
17    (at your option) any later version.
18 
19    This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
20    but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
21    MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
22    GNU General Public License for more details.
23 
24    You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
25    along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
26    Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street - Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA.  */
27 
28 /* This file handles functionality common to the different MIPS ABI's.  */
29 
30 #include "sysdep.h"
31 #include "bfd.h"
32 #include "libbfd.h"
33 #include "libiberty.h"
34 #include "elf-bfd.h"
35 #include "elfxx-mips.h"
36 #include "elf/mips.h"
37 #include "elf-vxworks.h"
38 
39 /* Get the ECOFF swapping routines.  */
40 #include "coff/sym.h"
41 #include "coff/symconst.h"
42 #include "coff/ecoff.h"
43 #include "coff/mips.h"
44 
45 #include "hashtab.h"
46 
47 /* This structure is used to hold information about one GOT entry.
48    There are three types of entry:
49 
50       (1) absolute addresses
51 	    (abfd == NULL)
52       (2) SYMBOL + OFFSET addresses, where SYMBOL is local to an input bfd
53 	    (abfd != NULL, symndx >= 0)
54       (3) global and forced-local symbols
55 	    (abfd != NULL, symndx == -1)
56 
57    Type (3) entries are treated differently for different types of GOT.
58    In the "master" GOT -- i.e.  the one that describes every GOT
59    reference needed in the link -- the mips_got_entry is keyed on both
60    the symbol and the input bfd that references it.  If it turns out
61    that we need multiple GOTs, we can then use this information to
62    create separate GOTs for each input bfd.
63 
64    However, we want each of these separate GOTs to have at most one
65    entry for a given symbol, so their type (3) entries are keyed only
66    on the symbol.  The input bfd given by the "abfd" field is somewhat
67    arbitrary in this case.
68 
69    This means that when there are multiple GOTs, each GOT has a unique
70    mips_got_entry for every symbol within it.  We can therefore use the
71    mips_got_entry fields (tls_type and gotidx) to track the symbol's
72    GOT index.
73 
74    However, if it turns out that we need only a single GOT, we continue
75    to use the master GOT to describe it.  There may therefore be several
76    mips_got_entries for the same symbol, each with a different input bfd.
77    We want to make sure that each symbol gets a unique GOT entry, so when
78    there's a single GOT, we use the symbol's hash entry, not the
79    mips_got_entry fields, to track a symbol's GOT index.  */
80 struct mips_got_entry
81 {
82   /* The input bfd in which the symbol is defined.  */
83   bfd *abfd;
84   /* The index of the symbol, as stored in the relocation r_info, if
85      we have a local symbol; -1 otherwise.  */
86   long symndx;
87   union
88   {
89     /* If abfd == NULL, an address that must be stored in the got.  */
90     bfd_vma address;
91     /* If abfd != NULL && symndx != -1, the addend of the relocation
92        that should be added to the symbol value.  */
93     bfd_vma addend;
94     /* If abfd != NULL && symndx == -1, the hash table entry
95        corresponding to a global symbol in the got (or, local, if
96        h->forced_local).  */
97     struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
98   } d;
99 
100   /* The TLS types included in this GOT entry (specifically, GD and
101      IE).  The GD and IE flags can be added as we encounter new
102      relocations.  LDM can also be set; it will always be alone, not
103      combined with any GD or IE flags.  An LDM GOT entry will be
104      a local symbol entry with r_symndx == 0.  */
105   unsigned char tls_type;
106 
107   /* The offset from the beginning of the .got section to the entry
108      corresponding to this symbol+addend.  If it's a global symbol
109      whose offset is yet to be decided, it's going to be -1.  */
110   long gotidx;
111 };
112 
113 /* This structure is used to hold .got information when linking.  */
114 
115 struct mips_got_info
116 {
117   /* The global symbol in the GOT with the lowest index in the dynamic
118      symbol table.  */
119   struct elf_link_hash_entry *global_gotsym;
120   /* The number of global .got entries.  */
121   unsigned int global_gotno;
122   /* The number of .got slots used for TLS.  */
123   unsigned int tls_gotno;
124   /* The first unused TLS .got entry.  Used only during
125      mips_elf_initialize_tls_index.  */
126   unsigned int tls_assigned_gotno;
127   /* The number of local .got entries.  */
128   unsigned int local_gotno;
129   /* The number of local .got entries we have used.  */
130   unsigned int assigned_gotno;
131   /* A hash table holding members of the got.  */
132   struct htab *got_entries;
133   /* A hash table mapping input bfds to other mips_got_info.  NULL
134      unless multi-got was necessary.  */
135   struct htab *bfd2got;
136   /* In multi-got links, a pointer to the next got (err, rather, most
137      of the time, it points to the previous got).  */
138   struct mips_got_info *next;
139   /* This is the GOT index of the TLS LDM entry for the GOT, MINUS_ONE
140      for none, or MINUS_TWO for not yet assigned.  This is needed
141      because a single-GOT link may have multiple hash table entries
142      for the LDM.  It does not get initialized in multi-GOT mode.  */
143   bfd_vma tls_ldm_offset;
144 };
145 
146 /* Map an input bfd to a got in a multi-got link.  */
147 
148 struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash {
149   bfd *bfd;
150   struct mips_got_info *g;
151 };
152 
153 /* Structure passed when traversing the bfd2got hash table, used to
154    create and merge bfd's gots.  */
155 
156 struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg
157 {
158   /* A hashtable that maps bfds to gots.  */
159   htab_t bfd2got;
160   /* The output bfd.  */
161   bfd *obfd;
162   /* The link information.  */
163   struct bfd_link_info *info;
164   /* A pointer to the primary got, i.e., the one that's going to get
165      the implicit relocations from DT_MIPS_LOCAL_GOTNO and
166      DT_MIPS_GOTSYM.  */
167   struct mips_got_info *primary;
168   /* A non-primary got we're trying to merge with other input bfd's
169      gots.  */
170   struct mips_got_info *current;
171   /* The maximum number of got entries that can be addressed with a
172      16-bit offset.  */
173   unsigned int max_count;
174   /* The number of local and global entries in the primary got.  */
175   unsigned int primary_count;
176   /* The number of local and global entries in the current got.  */
177   unsigned int current_count;
178   /* The total number of global entries which will live in the
179      primary got and be automatically relocated.  This includes
180      those not referenced by the primary GOT but included in
181      the "master" GOT.  */
182   unsigned int global_count;
183 };
184 
185 /* Another structure used to pass arguments for got entries traversal.  */
186 
187 struct mips_elf_set_global_got_offset_arg
188 {
189   struct mips_got_info *g;
190   int value;
191   unsigned int needed_relocs;
192   struct bfd_link_info *info;
193 };
194 
195 /* A structure used to count TLS relocations or GOT entries, for GOT
196    entry or ELF symbol table traversal.  */
197 
198 struct mips_elf_count_tls_arg
199 {
200   struct bfd_link_info *info;
201   unsigned int needed;
202 };
203 
204 struct _mips_elf_section_data
205 {
206   struct bfd_elf_section_data elf;
207   union
208   {
209     struct mips_got_info *got_info;
210     bfd_byte *tdata;
211   } u;
212 };
213 
214 #define mips_elf_section_data(sec) \
215   ((struct _mips_elf_section_data *) elf_section_data (sec))
216 
217 /* This structure is passed to mips_elf_sort_hash_table_f when sorting
218    the dynamic symbols.  */
219 
220 struct mips_elf_hash_sort_data
221 {
222   /* The symbol in the global GOT with the lowest dynamic symbol table
223      index.  */
224   struct elf_link_hash_entry *low;
225   /* The least dynamic symbol table index corresponding to a non-TLS
226      symbol with a GOT entry.  */
227   long min_got_dynindx;
228   /* The greatest dynamic symbol table index corresponding to a symbol
229      with a GOT entry that is not referenced (e.g., a dynamic symbol
230      with dynamic relocations pointing to it from non-primary GOTs).  */
231   long max_unref_got_dynindx;
232   /* The greatest dynamic symbol table index not corresponding to a
233      symbol without a GOT entry.  */
234   long max_non_got_dynindx;
235 };
236 
237 /* The MIPS ELF linker needs additional information for each symbol in
238    the global hash table.  */
239 
240 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry
241 {
242   struct elf_link_hash_entry root;
243 
244   /* External symbol information.  */
245   EXTR esym;
246 
247   /* Number of R_MIPS_32, R_MIPS_REL32, or R_MIPS_64 relocs against
248      this symbol.  */
249   unsigned int possibly_dynamic_relocs;
250 
251   /* If the R_MIPS_32, R_MIPS_REL32, or R_MIPS_64 reloc is against
252      a readonly section.  */
253   bfd_boolean readonly_reloc;
254 
255   /* We must not create a stub for a symbol that has relocations
256      related to taking the function's address, i.e. any but
257      R_MIPS_CALL*16 ones -- see "MIPS ABI Supplement, 3rd Edition",
258      p. 4-20.  */
259   bfd_boolean no_fn_stub;
260 
261   /* If there is a stub that 32 bit functions should use to call this
262      16 bit function, this points to the section containing the stub.  */
263   asection *fn_stub;
264 
265   /* Whether we need the fn_stub; this is set if this symbol appears
266      in any relocs other than a 16 bit call.  */
267   bfd_boolean need_fn_stub;
268 
269   /* If there is a stub that 16 bit functions should use to call this
270      32 bit function, this points to the section containing the stub.  */
271   asection *call_stub;
272 
273   /* This is like the call_stub field, but it is used if the function
274      being called returns a floating point value.  */
275   asection *call_fp_stub;
276 
277   /* Are we forced local?  This will only be set if we have converted
278      the initial global GOT entry to a local GOT entry.  */
279   bfd_boolean forced_local;
280 
281   /* Are we referenced by some kind of relocation?  */
282   bfd_boolean is_relocation_target;
283 
284   /* Are we referenced by branch relocations?  */
285   bfd_boolean is_branch_target;
286 
287 #define GOT_NORMAL	0
288 #define GOT_TLS_GD	1
289 #define GOT_TLS_LDM	2
290 #define GOT_TLS_IE	4
291 #define GOT_TLS_OFFSET_DONE    0x40
292 #define GOT_TLS_DONE    0x80
293   unsigned char tls_type;
294   /* This is only used in single-GOT mode; in multi-GOT mode there
295      is one mips_got_entry per GOT entry, so the offset is stored
296      there.  In single-GOT mode there may be many mips_got_entry
297      structures all referring to the same GOT slot.  It might be
298      possible to use root.got.offset instead, but that field is
299      overloaded already.  */
300   bfd_vma tls_got_offset;
301 };
302 
303 /* MIPS ELF linker hash table.  */
304 
305 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table
306 {
307   struct elf_link_hash_table root;
308 #if 0
309   /* We no longer use this.  */
310   /* String section indices for the dynamic section symbols.  */
311   bfd_size_type dynsym_sec_strindex[SIZEOF_MIPS_DYNSYM_SECNAMES];
312 #endif
313   /* The number of .rtproc entries.  */
314   bfd_size_type procedure_count;
315   /* The size of the .compact_rel section (if SGI_COMPAT).  */
316   bfd_size_type compact_rel_size;
317   /* This flag indicates that the value of DT_MIPS_RLD_MAP dynamic
318      entry is set to the address of __rld_obj_head as in IRIX5.  */
319   bfd_boolean use_rld_obj_head;
320   /* This is the value of the __rld_map or __rld_obj_head symbol.  */
321   bfd_vma rld_value;
322   /* This is set if we see any mips16 stub sections.  */
323   bfd_boolean mips16_stubs_seen;
324   /* True if we're generating code for VxWorks.  */
325   bfd_boolean is_vxworks;
326   /* Shortcuts to some dynamic sections, or NULL if they are not
327      being used.  */
328   asection *srelbss;
329   asection *sdynbss;
330   asection *srelplt;
331   asection *srelplt2;
332   asection *sgotplt;
333   asection *splt;
334   /* The size of the PLT header in bytes (VxWorks only).  */
335   bfd_vma plt_header_size;
336   /* The size of a PLT entry in bytes (VxWorks only).  */
337   bfd_vma plt_entry_size;
338   /* The size of a function stub entry in bytes.  */
339   bfd_vma function_stub_size;
340 };
341 
342 #define TLS_RELOC_P(r_type) \
343   (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_DTPMOD32		\
344    || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_DTPMOD64		\
345    || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL32		\
346    || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL64		\
347    || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_GD			\
348    || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_LDM			\
349    || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL_HI16		\
350    || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL_LO16		\
351    || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL		\
352    || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL32		\
353    || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL64		\
354    || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL_HI16		\
355    || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL_LO16)
356 
357 /* Structure used to pass information to mips_elf_output_extsym.  */
358 
359 struct extsym_info
360 {
361   bfd *abfd;
362   struct bfd_link_info *info;
363   struct ecoff_debug_info *debug;
364   const struct ecoff_debug_swap *swap;
365   bfd_boolean failed;
366 };
367 
368 /* The names of the runtime procedure table symbols used on IRIX5.  */
369 
370 static const char * const mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[] =
371 {
372   "_procedure_table",
373   "_procedure_string_table",
374   "_procedure_table_size",
375   NULL
376 };
377 
378 /* These structures are used to generate the .compact_rel section on
379    IRIX5.  */
380 
381 typedef struct
382 {
383   unsigned long id1;		/* Always one?  */
384   unsigned long num;		/* Number of compact relocation entries.  */
385   unsigned long id2;		/* Always two?  */
386   unsigned long offset;		/* The file offset of the first relocation.  */
387   unsigned long reserved0;	/* Zero?  */
388   unsigned long reserved1;	/* Zero?  */
389 } Elf32_compact_rel;
390 
391 typedef struct
392 {
393   bfd_byte id1[4];
394   bfd_byte num[4];
395   bfd_byte id2[4];
396   bfd_byte offset[4];
397   bfd_byte reserved0[4];
398   bfd_byte reserved1[4];
399 } Elf32_External_compact_rel;
400 
401 typedef struct
402 {
403   unsigned int ctype : 1;	/* 1: long 0: short format. See below.  */
404   unsigned int rtype : 4;	/* Relocation types. See below.  */
405   unsigned int dist2to : 8;
406   unsigned int relvaddr : 19;	/* (VADDR - vaddr of the previous entry)/ 4 */
407   unsigned long konst;		/* KONST field. See below.  */
408   unsigned long vaddr;		/* VADDR to be relocated.  */
409 } Elf32_crinfo;
410 
411 typedef struct
412 {
413   unsigned int ctype : 1;	/* 1: long 0: short format. See below.  */
414   unsigned int rtype : 4;	/* Relocation types. See below.  */
415   unsigned int dist2to : 8;
416   unsigned int relvaddr : 19;	/* (VADDR - vaddr of the previous entry)/ 4 */
417   unsigned long konst;		/* KONST field. See below.  */
418 } Elf32_crinfo2;
419 
420 typedef struct
421 {
422   bfd_byte info[4];
423   bfd_byte konst[4];
424   bfd_byte vaddr[4];
425 } Elf32_External_crinfo;
426 
427 typedef struct
428 {
429   bfd_byte info[4];
430   bfd_byte konst[4];
431 } Elf32_External_crinfo2;
432 
433 /* These are the constants used to swap the bitfields in a crinfo.  */
434 
435 #define CRINFO_CTYPE (0x1)
436 #define CRINFO_CTYPE_SH (31)
437 #define CRINFO_RTYPE (0xf)
438 #define CRINFO_RTYPE_SH (27)
439 #define CRINFO_DIST2TO (0xff)
440 #define CRINFO_DIST2TO_SH (19)
441 #define CRINFO_RELVADDR (0x7ffff)
442 #define CRINFO_RELVADDR_SH (0)
443 
444 /* A compact relocation info has long (3 words) or short (2 words)
445    formats.  A short format doesn't have VADDR field and relvaddr
446    fields contains ((VADDR - vaddr of the previous entry) >> 2).  */
447 #define CRF_MIPS_LONG			1
448 #define CRF_MIPS_SHORT			0
449 
450 /* There are 4 types of compact relocation at least. The value KONST
451    has different meaning for each type:
452 
453    (type)		(konst)
454    CT_MIPS_REL32	Address in data
455    CT_MIPS_WORD		Address in word (XXX)
456    CT_MIPS_GPHI_LO	GP - vaddr
457    CT_MIPS_JMPAD	Address to jump
458    */
459 
460 #define CRT_MIPS_REL32			0xa
461 #define CRT_MIPS_WORD			0xb
462 #define CRT_MIPS_GPHI_LO		0xc
463 #define CRT_MIPS_JMPAD			0xd
464 
465 #define mips_elf_set_cr_format(x,format)	((x).ctype = (format))
466 #define mips_elf_set_cr_type(x,type)		((x).rtype = (type))
467 #define mips_elf_set_cr_dist2to(x,v)		((x).dist2to = (v))
468 #define mips_elf_set_cr_relvaddr(x,d)		((x).relvaddr = (d)<<2)
469 
470 /* The structure of the runtime procedure descriptor created by the
471    loader for use by the static exception system.  */
472 
473 typedef struct runtime_pdr {
474 	bfd_vma	adr;		/* Memory address of start of procedure.  */
475 	long	regmask;	/* Save register mask.  */
476 	long	regoffset;	/* Save register offset.  */
477 	long	fregmask;	/* Save floating point register mask.  */
478 	long	fregoffset;	/* Save floating point register offset.  */
479 	long	frameoffset;	/* Frame size.  */
480 	short	framereg;	/* Frame pointer register.  */
481 	short	pcreg;		/* Offset or reg of return pc.  */
482 	long	irpss;		/* Index into the runtime string table.  */
483 	long	reserved;
484 	struct exception_info *exception_info;/* Pointer to exception array.  */
485 } RPDR, *pRPDR;
486 #define cbRPDR sizeof (RPDR)
487 #define rpdNil ((pRPDR) 0)
488 
489 static struct mips_got_entry *mips_elf_create_local_got_entry
490   (bfd *, struct bfd_link_info *, bfd *, struct mips_got_info *, asection *,
491    bfd_vma, unsigned long, struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *, int);
492 static bfd_boolean mips_elf_sort_hash_table_f
493   (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *, void *);
494 static bfd_vma mips_elf_high
495   (bfd_vma);
496 static bfd_boolean mips16_stub_section_p
497   (bfd *, asection *);
498 static bfd_boolean mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation
499   (bfd *, struct bfd_link_info *, const Elf_Internal_Rela *,
500    struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *, asection *, bfd_vma,
501    bfd_vma *, asection *);
502 static hashval_t mips_elf_got_entry_hash
503   (const void *);
504 static bfd_vma mips_elf_adjust_gp
505   (bfd *, struct mips_got_info *, bfd *);
506 static struct mips_got_info *mips_elf_got_for_ibfd
507   (struct mips_got_info *, bfd *);
508 
509 /* This will be used when we sort the dynamic relocation records.  */
510 static bfd *reldyn_sorting_bfd;
511 
512 /* Nonzero if ABFD is using the N32 ABI.  */
513 #define ABI_N32_P(abfd) \
514   ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI2) != 0)
515 
516 /* Nonzero if ABFD is using the N64 ABI.  */
517 #define ABI_64_P(abfd) \
518   (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS64)
519 
520 /* Nonzero if ABFD is using NewABI conventions.  */
521 #define NEWABI_P(abfd) (ABI_N32_P (abfd) || ABI_64_P (abfd))
522 
523 /* The IRIX compatibility level we are striving for.  */
524 #define IRIX_COMPAT(abfd) \
525   (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_backend_mips_irix_compat (abfd))
526 
527 /* Whether we are trying to be compatible with IRIX at all.  */
528 #define SGI_COMPAT(abfd) \
529   (IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) != ict_none)
530 
531 /* The name of the options section.  */
532 #define MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME(abfd) \
533   (NEWABI_P (abfd) ? ".MIPS.options" : ".options")
534 
535 /* True if NAME is the recognized name of any SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS section.
536    Some IRIX system files do not use MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME.  */
537 #define MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME_P(NAME) \
538   (strcmp (NAME, ".MIPS.options") == 0 || strcmp (NAME, ".options") == 0)
539 
540 /* Whether the section is readonly.  */
541 #define MIPS_ELF_READONLY_SECTION(sec) \
542   ((sec->flags & (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY))		\
543    == (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY))
544 
545 /* The name of the stub section.  */
546 #define MIPS_ELF_STUB_SECTION_NAME(abfd) ".MIPS.stubs"
547 
548 /* The size of an external REL relocation.  */
549 #define MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE(abfd) \
550   (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_rel)
551 
552 /* The size of an external RELA relocation.  */
553 #define MIPS_ELF_RELA_SIZE(abfd) \
554   (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_rela)
555 
556 /* The size of an external dynamic table entry.  */
557 #define MIPS_ELF_DYN_SIZE(abfd) \
558   (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_dyn)
559 
560 /* The size of the rld_map pointer.  */
561 #define MIPS_ELF_RLD_MAP_SIZE(abfd) \
562   (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->arch_size / 8)
563 
564 /* The size of a GOT entry.  */
565 #define MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE(abfd) \
566   (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->arch_size / 8)
567 
568 /* The size of a symbol-table entry.  */
569 #define MIPS_ELF_SYM_SIZE(abfd) \
570   (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_sym)
571 
572 /* The default alignment for sections, as a power of two.  */
573 #define MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN(abfd)				\
574   (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->log_file_align)
575 
576 /* Get word-sized data.  */
577 #define MIPS_ELF_GET_WORD(abfd, ptr) \
578   (ABI_64_P (abfd) ? bfd_get_64 (abfd, ptr) : bfd_get_32 (abfd, ptr))
579 
580 /* Put out word-sized data.  */
581 #define MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD(abfd, val, ptr)	\
582   (ABI_64_P (abfd) 				\
583    ? bfd_put_64 (abfd, val, ptr) 		\
584    : bfd_put_32 (abfd, val, ptr))
585 
586 /* Add a dynamic symbol table-entry.  */
587 #define MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY(info, tag, val)	\
588   _bfd_elf_add_dynamic_entry (info, tag, val)
589 
590 #define MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO(abfd, rtype, rela)			\
591   (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_backend_mips_rtype_to_howto (rtype, rela))
592 
593 /* Determine whether the internal relocation of index REL_IDX is REL
594    (zero) or RELA (non-zero).  The assumption is that, if there are
595    two relocation sections for this section, one of them is REL and
596    the other is RELA.  If the index of the relocation we're testing is
597    in range for the first relocation section, check that the external
598    relocation size is that for RELA.  It is also assumed that, if
599    rel_idx is not in range for the first section, and this first
600    section contains REL relocs, then the relocation is in the second
601    section, that is RELA.  */
602 #define MIPS_RELOC_RELA_P(abfd, sec, rel_idx)				\
603   ((NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (&elf_section_data (sec)->rel_hdr)			\
604     * get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel		\
605     > (bfd_vma)(rel_idx))						\
606    == (elf_section_data (sec)->rel_hdr.sh_entsize			\
607        == (ABI_64_P (abfd) ? sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela)		\
608 	   : sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela))))
609 
610 /* The name of the dynamic relocation section.  */
611 #define MIPS_ELF_REL_DYN_NAME(INFO) \
612   (mips_elf_hash_table (INFO)->is_vxworks ? ".rela.dyn" : ".rel.dyn")
613 
614 /* In case we're on a 32-bit machine, construct a 64-bit "-1" value
615    from smaller values.  Start with zero, widen, *then* decrement.  */
616 #define MINUS_ONE	(((bfd_vma)0) - 1)
617 #define MINUS_TWO	(((bfd_vma)0) - 2)
618 
619 /* The number of local .got entries we reserve.  */
620 #define MIPS_RESERVED_GOTNO(INFO) \
621   (mips_elf_hash_table (INFO)->is_vxworks ? 3 : 2)
622 
623 /* The offset of $gp from the beginning of the .got section.  */
624 #define ELF_MIPS_GP_OFFSET(INFO) \
625   (mips_elf_hash_table (INFO)->is_vxworks ? 0x0 : 0x7ff0)
626 
627 /* The maximum size of the GOT for it to be addressable using 16-bit
628    offsets from $gp.  */
629 #define MIPS_ELF_GOT_MAX_SIZE(INFO) (ELF_MIPS_GP_OFFSET (INFO) + 0x7fff)
630 
631 /* Instructions which appear in a stub.  */
632 #define STUB_LW(abfd)							\
633   ((ABI_64_P (abfd)							\
634     ? 0xdf998010				/* ld t9,0x8010(gp) */	\
635     : 0x8f998010))              		/* lw t9,0x8010(gp) */
636 #define STUB_MOVE(abfd)							\
637    ((ABI_64_P (abfd)							\
638      ? 0x03e0782d				/* daddu t7,ra */	\
639      : 0x03e07821))				/* addu t7,ra */
640 #define STUB_LUI(VAL) (0x3c180000 + (VAL))	/* lui t8,VAL */
641 #define STUB_JALR 0x0320f809			/* jalr t9,ra */
642 #define STUB_ORI(VAL) (0x37180000 + (VAL))	/* ori t8,t8,VAL */
643 #define STUB_LI16U(VAL) (0x34180000 + (VAL))	/* ori t8,zero,VAL unsigned */
644 #define STUB_LI16S(abfd, VAL)						\
645    ((ABI_64_P (abfd)							\
646     ? (0x64180000 + (VAL))	/* daddiu t8,zero,VAL sign extended */	\
647     : (0x24180000 + (VAL))))	/* addiu t8,zero,VAL sign extended */
648 
649 #define MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_NORMAL_SIZE 16
650 #define MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_BIG_SIZE 20
651 
652 /* The name of the dynamic interpreter.  This is put in the .interp
653    section.  */
654 
655 #define ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER(abfd) 		\
656    (ABI_N32_P (abfd) ? "/usr/lib32/libc.so.1" 	\
657     : ABI_64_P (abfd) ? "/usr/lib64/libc.so.1" 	\
658     : "/usr/lib/libc.so.1")
659 
660 #ifdef BFD64
661 #define MNAME(bfd,pre,pos) \
662   (ABI_64_P (bfd) ? CONCAT4 (pre,64,_,pos) : CONCAT4 (pre,32,_,pos))
663 #define ELF_R_SYM(bfd, i)					\
664   (ABI_64_P (bfd) ? ELF64_R_SYM (i) : ELF32_R_SYM (i))
665 #define ELF_R_TYPE(bfd, i)					\
666   (ABI_64_P (bfd) ? ELF64_MIPS_R_TYPE (i) : ELF32_R_TYPE (i))
667 #define ELF_R_INFO(bfd, s, t)					\
668   (ABI_64_P (bfd) ? ELF64_R_INFO (s, t) : ELF32_R_INFO (s, t))
669 #else
670 #define MNAME(bfd,pre,pos) CONCAT4 (pre,32,_,pos)
671 #define ELF_R_SYM(bfd, i)					\
672   (ELF32_R_SYM (i))
673 #define ELF_R_TYPE(bfd, i)					\
674   (ELF32_R_TYPE (i))
675 #define ELF_R_INFO(bfd, s, t)					\
676   (ELF32_R_INFO (s, t))
677 #endif
678 
679   /* The mips16 compiler uses a couple of special sections to handle
680      floating point arguments.
681 
682      Section names that look like .mips16.fn.FNNAME contain stubs that
683      copy floating point arguments from the fp regs to the gp regs and
684      then jump to FNNAME.  If any 32 bit function calls FNNAME, the
685      call should be redirected to the stub instead.  If no 32 bit
686      function calls FNNAME, the stub should be discarded.  We need to
687      consider any reference to the function, not just a call, because
688      if the address of the function is taken we will need the stub,
689      since the address might be passed to a 32 bit function.
690 
691      Section names that look like .mips16.call.FNNAME contain stubs
692      that copy floating point arguments from the gp regs to the fp
693      regs and then jump to FNNAME.  If FNNAME is a 32 bit function,
694      then any 16 bit function that calls FNNAME should be redirected
695      to the stub instead.  If FNNAME is not a 32 bit function, the
696      stub should be discarded.
697 
698      .mips16.call.fp.FNNAME sections are similar, but contain stubs
699      which call FNNAME and then copy the return value from the fp regs
700      to the gp regs.  These stubs store the return value in $18 while
701      calling FNNAME; any function which might call one of these stubs
702      must arrange to save $18 around the call.  (This case is not
703      needed for 32 bit functions that call 16 bit functions, because
704      16 bit functions always return floating point values in both
705      $f0/$f1 and $2/$3.)
706 
707      Note that in all cases FNNAME might be defined statically.
708      Therefore, FNNAME is not used literally.  Instead, the relocation
709      information will indicate which symbol the section is for.
710 
711      We record any stubs that we find in the symbol table.  */
712 
713 #define FN_STUB ".mips16.fn."
714 #define CALL_STUB ".mips16.call."
715 #define CALL_FP_STUB ".mips16.call.fp."
716 
717 #define FN_STUB_P(name) CONST_STRNEQ (name, FN_STUB)
718 #define CALL_STUB_P(name) CONST_STRNEQ (name, CALL_STUB)
719 #define CALL_FP_STUB_P(name) CONST_STRNEQ (name, CALL_FP_STUB)
720 
721 /* The format of the first PLT entry in a VxWorks executable.  */
722 static const bfd_vma mips_vxworks_exec_plt0_entry[] = {
723   0x3c190000,	/* lui t9, %hi(_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_)		*/
724   0x27390000,	/* addiu t9, t9, %lo(_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_)	*/
725   0x8f390008,	/* lw t9, 8(t9)					*/
726   0x00000000,	/* nop						*/
727   0x03200008,	/* jr t9					*/
728   0x00000000	/* nop						*/
729 };
730 
731 /* The format of subsequent PLT entries.  */
732 static const bfd_vma mips_vxworks_exec_plt_entry[] = {
733   0x10000000,	/* b .PLT_resolver			*/
734   0x24180000,	/* li t8, <pltindex>			*/
735   0x3c190000,	/* lui t9, %hi(<.got.plt slot>)		*/
736   0x27390000,	/* addiu t9, t9, %lo(<.got.plt slot>)	*/
737   0x8f390000,	/* lw t9, 0(t9)				*/
738   0x00000000,	/* nop					*/
739   0x03200008,	/* jr t9				*/
740   0x00000000	/* nop					*/
741 };
742 
743 /* The format of the first PLT entry in a VxWorks shared object.  */
744 static const bfd_vma mips_vxworks_shared_plt0_entry[] = {
745   0x8f990008,	/* lw t9, 8(gp)		*/
746   0x00000000,	/* nop			*/
747   0x03200008,	/* jr t9		*/
748   0x00000000,	/* nop			*/
749   0x00000000,	/* nop			*/
750   0x00000000	/* nop			*/
751 };
752 
753 /* The format of subsequent PLT entries.  */
754 static const bfd_vma mips_vxworks_shared_plt_entry[] = {
755   0x10000000,	/* b .PLT_resolver	*/
756   0x24180000	/* li t8, <pltindex>	*/
757 };
758 
759 /* Look up an entry in a MIPS ELF linker hash table.  */
760 
761 #define mips_elf_link_hash_lookup(table, string, create, copy, follow)	\
762   ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)					\
763    elf_link_hash_lookup (&(table)->root, (string), (create),		\
764 			 (copy), (follow)))
765 
766 /* Traverse a MIPS ELF linker hash table.  */
767 
768 #define mips_elf_link_hash_traverse(table, func, info)			\
769   (elf_link_hash_traverse						\
770    (&(table)->root,							\
771     (bfd_boolean (*) (struct elf_link_hash_entry *, void *)) (func),	\
772     (info)))
773 
774 /* Get the MIPS ELF linker hash table from a link_info structure.  */
775 
776 #define mips_elf_hash_table(p) \
777   ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *) ((p)->hash))
778 
779 /* Find the base offsets for thread-local storage in this object,
780    for GD/LD and IE/LE respectively.  */
781 
782 #define TP_OFFSET 0x7000
783 #define DTP_OFFSET 0x8000
784 
785 static bfd_vma
dtprel_base(struct bfd_link_info * info)786 dtprel_base (struct bfd_link_info *info)
787 {
788   /* If tls_sec is NULL, we should have signalled an error already.  */
789   if (elf_hash_table (info)->tls_sec == NULL)
790     return 0;
791   return elf_hash_table (info)->tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
792 }
793 
794 static bfd_vma
tprel_base(struct bfd_link_info * info)795 tprel_base (struct bfd_link_info *info)
796 {
797   /* If tls_sec is NULL, we should have signalled an error already.  */
798   if (elf_hash_table (info)->tls_sec == NULL)
799     return 0;
800   return elf_hash_table (info)->tls_sec->vma + TP_OFFSET;
801 }
802 
803 /* Create an entry in a MIPS ELF linker hash table.  */
804 
805 static struct bfd_hash_entry *
mips_elf_link_hash_newfunc(struct bfd_hash_entry * entry,struct bfd_hash_table * table,const char * string)806 mips_elf_link_hash_newfunc (struct bfd_hash_entry *entry,
807 			    struct bfd_hash_table *table, const char *string)
808 {
809   struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *ret =
810     (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) entry;
811 
812   /* Allocate the structure if it has not already been allocated by a
813      subclass.  */
814   if (ret == NULL)
815     ret = bfd_hash_allocate (table, sizeof (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry));
816   if (ret == NULL)
817     return (struct bfd_hash_entry *) ret;
818 
819   /* Call the allocation method of the superclass.  */
820   ret = ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
821 	 _bfd_elf_link_hash_newfunc ((struct bfd_hash_entry *) ret,
822 				     table, string));
823   if (ret != NULL)
824     {
825       /* Set local fields.  */
826       memset (&ret->esym, 0, sizeof (EXTR));
827       /* We use -2 as a marker to indicate that the information has
828 	 not been set.  -1 means there is no associated ifd.  */
829       ret->esym.ifd = -2;
830       ret->possibly_dynamic_relocs = 0;
831       ret->readonly_reloc = FALSE;
832       ret->no_fn_stub = FALSE;
833       ret->fn_stub = NULL;
834       ret->need_fn_stub = FALSE;
835       ret->call_stub = NULL;
836       ret->call_fp_stub = NULL;
837       ret->forced_local = FALSE;
838       ret->is_branch_target = FALSE;
839       ret->is_relocation_target = FALSE;
840       ret->tls_type = GOT_NORMAL;
841     }
842 
843   return (struct bfd_hash_entry *) ret;
844 }
845 
846 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_new_section_hook(bfd * abfd,asection * sec)847 _bfd_mips_elf_new_section_hook (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
848 {
849   if (!sec->used_by_bfd)
850     {
851       struct _mips_elf_section_data *sdata;
852       bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (*sdata);
853 
854       sdata = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
855       if (sdata == NULL)
856 	return FALSE;
857       sec->used_by_bfd = sdata;
858     }
859 
860   return _bfd_elf_new_section_hook (abfd, sec);
861 }
862 
863 /* Read ECOFF debugging information from a .mdebug section into a
864    ecoff_debug_info structure.  */
865 
866 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_read_ecoff_info(bfd * abfd,asection * section,struct ecoff_debug_info * debug)867 _bfd_mips_elf_read_ecoff_info (bfd *abfd, asection *section,
868 			       struct ecoff_debug_info *debug)
869 {
870   HDRR *symhdr;
871   const struct ecoff_debug_swap *swap;
872   char *ext_hdr;
873 
874   swap = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap;
875   memset (debug, 0, sizeof (*debug));
876 
877   ext_hdr = bfd_malloc (swap->external_hdr_size);
878   if (ext_hdr == NULL && swap->external_hdr_size != 0)
879     goto error_return;
880 
881   if (! bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, section, ext_hdr, 0,
882 				  swap->external_hdr_size))
883     goto error_return;
884 
885   symhdr = &debug->symbolic_header;
886   (*swap->swap_hdr_in) (abfd, ext_hdr, symhdr);
887 
888   /* The symbolic header contains absolute file offsets and sizes to
889      read.  */
890 #define READ(ptr, offset, count, size, type)				\
891   if (symhdr->count == 0)						\
892     debug->ptr = NULL;							\
893   else									\
894     {									\
895       bfd_size_type amt = (bfd_size_type) size * symhdr->count;		\
896       debug->ptr = bfd_malloc (amt);					\
897       if (debug->ptr == NULL)						\
898 	goto error_return;						\
899       if (bfd_seek (abfd, symhdr->offset, SEEK_SET) != 0		\
900 	  || bfd_bread (debug->ptr, amt, abfd) != amt)			\
901 	goto error_return;						\
902     }
903 
904   READ (line, cbLineOffset, cbLine, sizeof (unsigned char), unsigned char *);
905   READ (external_dnr, cbDnOffset, idnMax, swap->external_dnr_size, void *);
906   READ (external_pdr, cbPdOffset, ipdMax, swap->external_pdr_size, void *);
907   READ (external_sym, cbSymOffset, isymMax, swap->external_sym_size, void *);
908   READ (external_opt, cbOptOffset, ioptMax, swap->external_opt_size, void *);
909   READ (external_aux, cbAuxOffset, iauxMax, sizeof (union aux_ext),
910 	union aux_ext *);
911   READ (ss, cbSsOffset, issMax, sizeof (char), char *);
912   READ (ssext, cbSsExtOffset, issExtMax, sizeof (char), char *);
913   READ (external_fdr, cbFdOffset, ifdMax, swap->external_fdr_size, void *);
914   READ (external_rfd, cbRfdOffset, crfd, swap->external_rfd_size, void *);
915   READ (external_ext, cbExtOffset, iextMax, swap->external_ext_size, void *);
916 #undef READ
917 
918   debug->fdr = NULL;
919 
920   return TRUE;
921 
922  error_return:
923   if (ext_hdr != NULL)
924     free (ext_hdr);
925   if (debug->line != NULL)
926     free (debug->line);
927   if (debug->external_dnr != NULL)
928     free (debug->external_dnr);
929   if (debug->external_pdr != NULL)
930     free (debug->external_pdr);
931   if (debug->external_sym != NULL)
932     free (debug->external_sym);
933   if (debug->external_opt != NULL)
934     free (debug->external_opt);
935   if (debug->external_aux != NULL)
936     free (debug->external_aux);
937   if (debug->ss != NULL)
938     free (debug->ss);
939   if (debug->ssext != NULL)
940     free (debug->ssext);
941   if (debug->external_fdr != NULL)
942     free (debug->external_fdr);
943   if (debug->external_rfd != NULL)
944     free (debug->external_rfd);
945   if (debug->external_ext != NULL)
946     free (debug->external_ext);
947   return FALSE;
948 }
949 
950 /* Swap RPDR (runtime procedure table entry) for output.  */
951 
952 static void
ecoff_swap_rpdr_out(bfd * abfd,const RPDR * in,struct rpdr_ext * ex)953 ecoff_swap_rpdr_out (bfd *abfd, const RPDR *in, struct rpdr_ext *ex)
954 {
955   H_PUT_S32 (abfd, in->adr, ex->p_adr);
956   H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->regmask, ex->p_regmask);
957   H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->regoffset, ex->p_regoffset);
958   H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->fregmask, ex->p_fregmask);
959   H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->fregoffset, ex->p_fregoffset);
960   H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->frameoffset, ex->p_frameoffset);
961 
962   H_PUT_16 (abfd, in->framereg, ex->p_framereg);
963   H_PUT_16 (abfd, in->pcreg, ex->p_pcreg);
964 
965   H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->irpss, ex->p_irpss);
966 }
967 
968 /* Create a runtime procedure table from the .mdebug section.  */
969 
970 static bfd_boolean
mips_elf_create_procedure_table(void * handle,bfd * abfd,struct bfd_link_info * info,asection * s,struct ecoff_debug_info * debug)971 mips_elf_create_procedure_table (void *handle, bfd *abfd,
972 				 struct bfd_link_info *info, asection *s,
973 				 struct ecoff_debug_info *debug)
974 {
975   const struct ecoff_debug_swap *swap;
976   HDRR *hdr = &debug->symbolic_header;
977   RPDR *rpdr, *rp;
978   struct rpdr_ext *erp;
979   void *rtproc;
980   struct pdr_ext *epdr;
981   struct sym_ext *esym;
982   char *ss, **sv;
983   char *str;
984   bfd_size_type size;
985   bfd_size_type count;
986   unsigned long sindex;
987   unsigned long i;
988   PDR pdr;
989   SYMR sym;
990   const char *no_name_func = _("static procedure (no name)");
991 
992   epdr = NULL;
993   rpdr = NULL;
994   esym = NULL;
995   ss = NULL;
996   sv = NULL;
997 
998   swap = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap;
999 
1000   sindex = strlen (no_name_func) + 1;
1001   count = hdr->ipdMax;
1002   if (count > 0)
1003     {
1004       size = swap->external_pdr_size;
1005 
1006       epdr = bfd_malloc (size * count);
1007       if (epdr == NULL)
1008 	goto error_return;
1009 
1010       if (! _bfd_ecoff_get_accumulated_pdr (handle, (bfd_byte *) epdr))
1011 	goto error_return;
1012 
1013       size = sizeof (RPDR);
1014       rp = rpdr = bfd_malloc (size * count);
1015       if (rpdr == NULL)
1016 	goto error_return;
1017 
1018       size = sizeof (char *);
1019       sv = bfd_malloc (size * count);
1020       if (sv == NULL)
1021 	goto error_return;
1022 
1023       count = hdr->isymMax;
1024       size = swap->external_sym_size;
1025       esym = bfd_malloc (size * count);
1026       if (esym == NULL)
1027 	goto error_return;
1028 
1029       if (! _bfd_ecoff_get_accumulated_sym (handle, (bfd_byte *) esym))
1030 	goto error_return;
1031 
1032       count = hdr->issMax;
1033       ss = bfd_malloc (count);
1034       if (ss == NULL)
1035 	goto error_return;
1036       if (! _bfd_ecoff_get_accumulated_ss (handle, (bfd_byte *) ss))
1037 	goto error_return;
1038 
1039       count = hdr->ipdMax;
1040       for (i = 0; i < (unsigned long) count; i++, rp++)
1041 	{
1042 	  (*swap->swap_pdr_in) (abfd, epdr + i, &pdr);
1043 	  (*swap->swap_sym_in) (abfd, &esym[pdr.isym], &sym);
1044 	  rp->adr = sym.value;
1045 	  rp->regmask = pdr.regmask;
1046 	  rp->regoffset = pdr.regoffset;
1047 	  rp->fregmask = pdr.fregmask;
1048 	  rp->fregoffset = pdr.fregoffset;
1049 	  rp->frameoffset = pdr.frameoffset;
1050 	  rp->framereg = pdr.framereg;
1051 	  rp->pcreg = pdr.pcreg;
1052 	  rp->irpss = sindex;
1053 	  sv[i] = ss + sym.iss;
1054 	  sindex += strlen (sv[i]) + 1;
1055 	}
1056     }
1057 
1058   size = sizeof (struct rpdr_ext) * (count + 2) + sindex;
1059   size = BFD_ALIGN (size, 16);
1060   rtproc = bfd_alloc (abfd, size);
1061   if (rtproc == NULL)
1062     {
1063       mips_elf_hash_table (info)->procedure_count = 0;
1064       goto error_return;
1065     }
1066 
1067   mips_elf_hash_table (info)->procedure_count = count + 2;
1068 
1069   erp = rtproc;
1070   memset (erp, 0, sizeof (struct rpdr_ext));
1071   erp++;
1072   str = (char *) rtproc + sizeof (struct rpdr_ext) * (count + 2);
1073   strcpy (str, no_name_func);
1074   str += strlen (no_name_func) + 1;
1075   for (i = 0; i < count; i++)
1076     {
1077       ecoff_swap_rpdr_out (abfd, rpdr + i, erp + i);
1078       strcpy (str, sv[i]);
1079       str += strlen (sv[i]) + 1;
1080     }
1081   H_PUT_S32 (abfd, -1, (erp + count)->p_adr);
1082 
1083   /* Set the size and contents of .rtproc section.  */
1084   s->size = size;
1085   s->contents = rtproc;
1086 
1087   /* Skip this section later on (I don't think this currently
1088      matters, but someday it might).  */
1089   s->map_head.link_order = NULL;
1090 
1091   if (epdr != NULL)
1092     free (epdr);
1093   if (rpdr != NULL)
1094     free (rpdr);
1095   if (esym != NULL)
1096     free (esym);
1097   if (ss != NULL)
1098     free (ss);
1099   if (sv != NULL)
1100     free (sv);
1101 
1102   return TRUE;
1103 
1104  error_return:
1105   if (epdr != NULL)
1106     free (epdr);
1107   if (rpdr != NULL)
1108     free (rpdr);
1109   if (esym != NULL)
1110     free (esym);
1111   if (ss != NULL)
1112     free (ss);
1113   if (sv != NULL)
1114     free (sv);
1115   return FALSE;
1116 }
1117 
1118 /* Check the mips16 stubs for a particular symbol, and see if we can
1119    discard them.  */
1120 
1121 static bfd_boolean
mips_elf_check_mips16_stubs(struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry * h,void * data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)1122 mips_elf_check_mips16_stubs (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h,
1123 			     void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1124 {
1125   if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
1126     h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
1127 
1128   if (h->fn_stub != NULL
1129       && ! h->need_fn_stub)
1130     {
1131       /* We don't need the fn_stub; the only references to this symbol
1132          are 16 bit calls.  Clobber the size to 0 to prevent it from
1133          being included in the link.  */
1134       h->fn_stub->size = 0;
1135       h->fn_stub->flags &= ~SEC_RELOC;
1136       h->fn_stub->reloc_count = 0;
1137       h->fn_stub->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
1138     }
1139 
1140   if (h->call_stub != NULL
1141       && h->root.other == STO_MIPS16)
1142     {
1143       /* We don't need the call_stub; this is a 16 bit function, so
1144          calls from other 16 bit functions are OK.  Clobber the size
1145          to 0 to prevent it from being included in the link.  */
1146       h->call_stub->size = 0;
1147       h->call_stub->flags &= ~SEC_RELOC;
1148       h->call_stub->reloc_count = 0;
1149       h->call_stub->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
1150     }
1151 
1152   if (h->call_fp_stub != NULL
1153       && h->root.other == STO_MIPS16)
1154     {
1155       /* We don't need the call_stub; this is a 16 bit function, so
1156          calls from other 16 bit functions are OK.  Clobber the size
1157          to 0 to prevent it from being included in the link.  */
1158       h->call_fp_stub->size = 0;
1159       h->call_fp_stub->flags &= ~SEC_RELOC;
1160       h->call_fp_stub->reloc_count = 0;
1161       h->call_fp_stub->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
1162     }
1163 
1164   return TRUE;
1165 }
1166 
1167 /* R_MIPS16_26 is used for the mips16 jal and jalx instructions.
1168    Most mips16 instructions are 16 bits, but these instructions
1169    are 32 bits.
1170 
1171    The format of these instructions is:
1172 
1173    +--------------+--------------------------------+
1174    |     JALX     | X|   Imm 20:16  |   Imm 25:21  |
1175    +--------------+--------------------------------+
1176    |                Immediate  15:0                |
1177    +-----------------------------------------------+
1178 
1179    JALX is the 5-bit value 00011.  X is 0 for jal, 1 for jalx.
1180    Note that the immediate value in the first word is swapped.
1181 
1182    When producing a relocatable object file, R_MIPS16_26 is
1183    handled mostly like R_MIPS_26.  In particular, the addend is
1184    stored as a straight 26-bit value in a 32-bit instruction.
1185    (gas makes life simpler for itself by never adjusting a
1186    R_MIPS16_26 reloc to be against a section, so the addend is
1187    always zero).  However, the 32 bit instruction is stored as 2
1188    16-bit values, rather than a single 32-bit value.  In a
1189    big-endian file, the result is the same; in a little-endian
1190    file, the two 16-bit halves of the 32 bit value are swapped.
1191    This is so that a disassembler can recognize the jal
1192    instruction.
1193 
1194    When doing a final link, R_MIPS16_26 is treated as a 32 bit
1195    instruction stored as two 16-bit values.  The addend A is the
1196    contents of the targ26 field.  The calculation is the same as
1197    R_MIPS_26.  When storing the calculated value, reorder the
1198    immediate value as shown above, and don't forget to store the
1199    value as two 16-bit values.
1200 
1201    To put it in MIPS ABI terms, the relocation field is T-targ26-16,
1202    defined as
1203 
1204    big-endian:
1205    +--------+----------------------+
1206    |        |                      |
1207    |        |    targ26-16         |
1208    |31    26|25                   0|
1209    +--------+----------------------+
1210 
1211    little-endian:
1212    +----------+------+-------------+
1213    |          |      |             |
1214    |  sub1    |      |     sub2    |
1215    |0        9|10  15|16         31|
1216    +----------+--------------------+
1217    where targ26-16 is sub1 followed by sub2 (i.e., the addend field A is
1218    ((sub1 << 16) | sub2)).
1219 
1220    When producing a relocatable object file, the calculation is
1221    (((A < 2) | ((P + 4) & 0xf0000000) + S) >> 2)
1222    When producing a fully linked file, the calculation is
1223    let R = (((A < 2) | ((P + 4) & 0xf0000000) + S) >> 2)
1224    ((R & 0x1f0000) << 5) | ((R & 0x3e00000) >> 5) | (R & 0xffff)
1225 
1226    R_MIPS16_GPREL is used for GP-relative addressing in mips16
1227    mode.  A typical instruction will have a format like this:
1228 
1229    +--------------+--------------------------------+
1230    |    EXTEND    |     Imm 10:5    |   Imm 15:11  |
1231    +--------------+--------------------------------+
1232    |    Major     |   rx   |   ry   |   Imm  4:0   |
1233    +--------------+--------------------------------+
1234 
1235    EXTEND is the five bit value 11110.  Major is the instruction
1236    opcode.
1237 
1238    This is handled exactly like R_MIPS_GPREL16, except that the
1239    addend is retrieved and stored as shown in this diagram; that
1240    is, the Imm fields above replace the V-rel16 field.
1241 
1242    All we need to do here is shuffle the bits appropriately.  As
1243    above, the two 16-bit halves must be swapped on a
1244    little-endian system.
1245 
1246    R_MIPS16_HI16 and R_MIPS16_LO16 are used in mips16 mode to
1247    access data when neither GP-relative nor PC-relative addressing
1248    can be used.  They are handled like R_MIPS_HI16 and R_MIPS_LO16,
1249    except that the addend is retrieved and stored as shown above
1250    for R_MIPS16_GPREL.
1251   */
1252 void
_bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_unshuffle(bfd * abfd,int r_type,bfd_boolean jal_shuffle,bfd_byte * data)1253 _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_unshuffle (bfd *abfd, int r_type,
1254 				 bfd_boolean jal_shuffle, bfd_byte *data)
1255 {
1256   bfd_vma extend, insn, val;
1257 
1258   if (r_type != R_MIPS16_26 && r_type != R_MIPS16_GPREL
1259       && r_type != R_MIPS16_HI16 && r_type != R_MIPS16_LO16)
1260     return;
1261 
1262   /* Pick up the mips16 extend instruction and the real instruction.  */
1263   extend = bfd_get_16 (abfd, data);
1264   insn = bfd_get_16 (abfd, data + 2);
1265   if (r_type == R_MIPS16_26)
1266     {
1267       if (jal_shuffle)
1268 	val = ((extend & 0xfc00) << 16) | ((extend & 0x3e0) << 11)
1269 	      | ((extend & 0x1f) << 21) | insn;
1270       else
1271 	val = extend << 16 | insn;
1272     }
1273   else
1274     val = ((extend & 0xf800) << 16) | ((insn & 0xffe0) << 11)
1275 	  | ((extend & 0x1f) << 11) | (extend & 0x7e0) | (insn & 0x1f);
1276   bfd_put_32 (abfd, val, data);
1277 }
1278 
1279 void
_bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_shuffle(bfd * abfd,int r_type,bfd_boolean jal_shuffle,bfd_byte * data)1280 _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_shuffle (bfd *abfd, int r_type,
1281 			       bfd_boolean jal_shuffle, bfd_byte *data)
1282 {
1283   bfd_vma extend, insn, val;
1284 
1285   if (r_type != R_MIPS16_26 && r_type != R_MIPS16_GPREL
1286       && r_type != R_MIPS16_HI16 && r_type != R_MIPS16_LO16)
1287     return;
1288 
1289   val = bfd_get_32 (abfd, data);
1290   if (r_type == R_MIPS16_26)
1291     {
1292       if (jal_shuffle)
1293 	{
1294 	  insn = val & 0xffff;
1295 	  extend = ((val >> 16) & 0xfc00) | ((val >> 11) & 0x3e0)
1296 		   | ((val >> 21) & 0x1f);
1297 	}
1298       else
1299 	{
1300 	  insn = val & 0xffff;
1301 	  extend = val >> 16;
1302 	}
1303     }
1304   else
1305     {
1306       insn = ((val >> 11) & 0xffe0) | (val & 0x1f);
1307       extend = ((val >> 16) & 0xf800) | ((val >> 11) & 0x1f) | (val & 0x7e0);
1308     }
1309   bfd_put_16 (abfd, insn, data + 2);
1310   bfd_put_16 (abfd, extend, data);
1311 }
1312 
1313 bfd_reloc_status_type
_bfd_mips_elf_gprel16_with_gp(bfd * abfd,asymbol * symbol,arelent * reloc_entry,asection * input_section,bfd_boolean relocatable,void * data,bfd_vma gp)1314 _bfd_mips_elf_gprel16_with_gp (bfd *abfd, asymbol *symbol,
1315 			       arelent *reloc_entry, asection *input_section,
1316 			       bfd_boolean relocatable, void *data, bfd_vma gp)
1317 {
1318   bfd_vma relocation;
1319   bfd_signed_vma val;
1320   bfd_reloc_status_type status;
1321 
1322   if (bfd_is_com_section (symbol->section))
1323     relocation = 0;
1324   else
1325     relocation = symbol->value;
1326 
1327   relocation += symbol->section->output_section->vma;
1328   relocation += symbol->section->output_offset;
1329 
1330   if (reloc_entry->address > bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, input_section))
1331     return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
1332 
1333   /* Set val to the offset into the section or symbol.  */
1334   val = reloc_entry->addend;
1335 
1336   _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (val, 16);
1337 
1338   /* Adjust val for the final section location and GP value.  If we
1339      are producing relocatable output, we don't want to do this for
1340      an external symbol.  */
1341   if (! relocatable
1342       || (symbol->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) != 0)
1343     val += relocation - gp;
1344 
1345   if (reloc_entry->howto->partial_inplace)
1346     {
1347       status = _bfd_relocate_contents (reloc_entry->howto, abfd, val,
1348 				       (bfd_byte *) data
1349 				       + reloc_entry->address);
1350       if (status != bfd_reloc_ok)
1351 	return status;
1352     }
1353   else
1354     reloc_entry->addend = val;
1355 
1356   if (relocatable)
1357     reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
1358 
1359   return bfd_reloc_ok;
1360 }
1361 
1362 /* Used to store a REL high-part relocation such as R_MIPS_HI16 or
1363    R_MIPS_GOT16.  REL is the relocation, INPUT_SECTION is the section
1364    that contains the relocation field and DATA points to the start of
1365    INPUT_SECTION.  */
1366 
1367 struct mips_hi16
1368 {
1369   struct mips_hi16 *next;
1370   bfd_byte *data;
1371   asection *input_section;
1372   arelent rel;
1373 };
1374 
1375 /* FIXME: This should not be a static variable.  */
1376 
1377 static struct mips_hi16 *mips_hi16_list;
1378 
1379 /* A howto special_function for REL *HI16 relocations.  We can only
1380    calculate the correct value once we've seen the partnering
1381    *LO16 relocation, so just save the information for later.
1382 
1383    The ABI requires that the *LO16 immediately follow the *HI16.
1384    However, as a GNU extension, we permit an arbitrary number of
1385    *HI16s to be associated with a single *LO16.  This significantly
1386    simplies the relocation handling in gcc.  */
1387 
1388 bfd_reloc_status_type
_bfd_mips_elf_hi16_reloc(bfd * abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,arelent * reloc_entry,asymbol * symbol ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,void * data,asection * input_section,bfd * output_bfd,char ** error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)1389 _bfd_mips_elf_hi16_reloc (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, arelent *reloc_entry,
1390 			  asymbol *symbol ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, void *data,
1391 			  asection *input_section, bfd *output_bfd,
1392 			  char **error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1393 {
1394   struct mips_hi16 *n;
1395 
1396   if (reloc_entry->address > bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, input_section))
1397     return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
1398 
1399   n = bfd_malloc (sizeof *n);
1400   if (n == NULL)
1401     return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
1402 
1403   n->next = mips_hi16_list;
1404   n->data = data;
1405   n->input_section = input_section;
1406   n->rel = *reloc_entry;
1407   mips_hi16_list = n;
1408 
1409   if (output_bfd != NULL)
1410     reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
1411 
1412   return bfd_reloc_ok;
1413 }
1414 
1415 /* A howto special_function for REL R_MIPS_GOT16 relocations.  This is just
1416    like any other 16-bit relocation when applied to global symbols, but is
1417    treated in the same as R_MIPS_HI16 when applied to local symbols.  */
1418 
1419 bfd_reloc_status_type
_bfd_mips_elf_got16_reloc(bfd * abfd,arelent * reloc_entry,asymbol * symbol,void * data,asection * input_section,bfd * output_bfd,char ** error_message)1420 _bfd_mips_elf_got16_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *reloc_entry, asymbol *symbol,
1421 			   void *data, asection *input_section,
1422 			   bfd *output_bfd, char **error_message)
1423 {
1424   if ((symbol->flags & (BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_WEAK)) != 0
1425       || bfd_is_und_section (bfd_get_section (symbol))
1426       || bfd_is_com_section (bfd_get_section (symbol)))
1427     /* The relocation is against a global symbol.  */
1428     return _bfd_mips_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
1429 					input_section, output_bfd,
1430 					error_message);
1431 
1432   return _bfd_mips_elf_hi16_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
1433 				   input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
1434 }
1435 
1436 /* A howto special_function for REL *LO16 relocations.  The *LO16 itself
1437    is a straightforward 16 bit inplace relocation, but we must deal with
1438    any partnering high-part relocations as well.  */
1439 
1440 bfd_reloc_status_type
_bfd_mips_elf_lo16_reloc(bfd * abfd,arelent * reloc_entry,asymbol * symbol,void * data,asection * input_section,bfd * output_bfd,char ** error_message)1441 _bfd_mips_elf_lo16_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *reloc_entry, asymbol *symbol,
1442 			  void *data, asection *input_section,
1443 			  bfd *output_bfd, char **error_message)
1444 {
1445   bfd_vma vallo;
1446   bfd_byte *location = (bfd_byte *) data + reloc_entry->address;
1447 
1448   if (reloc_entry->address > bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, input_section))
1449     return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
1450 
1451   _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_unshuffle (abfd, reloc_entry->howto->type, FALSE,
1452 				   location);
1453   vallo = bfd_get_32 (abfd, location);
1454   _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_shuffle (abfd, reloc_entry->howto->type, FALSE,
1455 				 location);
1456 
1457   while (mips_hi16_list != NULL)
1458     {
1459       bfd_reloc_status_type ret;
1460       struct mips_hi16 *hi;
1461 
1462       hi = mips_hi16_list;
1463 
1464       /* R_MIPS_GOT16 relocations are something of a special case.  We
1465 	 want to install the addend in the same way as for a R_MIPS_HI16
1466 	 relocation (with a rightshift of 16).  However, since GOT16
1467 	 relocations can also be used with global symbols, their howto
1468 	 has a rightshift of 0.  */
1469       if (hi->rel.howto->type == R_MIPS_GOT16)
1470 	hi->rel.howto = MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO (abfd, R_MIPS_HI16, FALSE);
1471 
1472       /* VALLO is a signed 16-bit number.  Bias it by 0x8000 so that any
1473 	 carry or borrow will induce a change of +1 or -1 in the high part.  */
1474       hi->rel.addend += (vallo + 0x8000) & 0xffff;
1475 
1476       ret = _bfd_mips_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, &hi->rel, symbol, hi->data,
1477 					 hi->input_section, output_bfd,
1478 					 error_message);
1479       if (ret != bfd_reloc_ok)
1480 	return ret;
1481 
1482       mips_hi16_list = hi->next;
1483       free (hi);
1484     }
1485 
1486   return _bfd_mips_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
1487 				      input_section, output_bfd,
1488 				      error_message);
1489 }
1490 
1491 /* A generic howto special_function.  This calculates and installs the
1492    relocation itself, thus avoiding the oft-discussed problems in
1493    bfd_perform_relocation and bfd_install_relocation.  */
1494 
1495 bfd_reloc_status_type
_bfd_mips_elf_generic_reloc(bfd * abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,arelent * reloc_entry,asymbol * symbol,void * data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,asection * input_section,bfd * output_bfd,char ** error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)1496 _bfd_mips_elf_generic_reloc (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, arelent *reloc_entry,
1497 			     asymbol *symbol, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1498 			     asection *input_section, bfd *output_bfd,
1499 			     char **error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1500 {
1501   bfd_signed_vma val;
1502   bfd_reloc_status_type status;
1503   bfd_boolean relocatable;
1504 
1505   relocatable = (output_bfd != NULL);
1506 
1507   if (reloc_entry->address > bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, input_section))
1508     return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
1509 
1510   /* Build up the field adjustment in VAL.  */
1511   val = 0;
1512   if (!relocatable || (symbol->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) != 0)
1513     {
1514       /* Either we're calculating the final field value or we have a
1515 	 relocation against a section symbol.  Add in the section's
1516 	 offset or address.  */
1517       val += symbol->section->output_section->vma;
1518       val += symbol->section->output_offset;
1519     }
1520 
1521   if (!relocatable)
1522     {
1523       /* We're calculating the final field value.  Add in the symbol's value
1524 	 and, if pc-relative, subtract the address of the field itself.  */
1525       val += symbol->value;
1526       if (reloc_entry->howto->pc_relative)
1527 	{
1528 	  val -= input_section->output_section->vma;
1529 	  val -= input_section->output_offset;
1530 	  val -= reloc_entry->address;
1531 	}
1532     }
1533 
1534   /* VAL is now the final adjustment.  If we're keeping this relocation
1535      in the output file, and if the relocation uses a separate addend,
1536      we just need to add VAL to that addend.  Otherwise we need to add
1537      VAL to the relocation field itself.  */
1538   if (relocatable && !reloc_entry->howto->partial_inplace)
1539     reloc_entry->addend += val;
1540   else
1541     {
1542       bfd_byte *location = (bfd_byte *) data + reloc_entry->address;
1543 
1544       /* Add in the separate addend, if any.  */
1545       val += reloc_entry->addend;
1546 
1547       /* Add VAL to the relocation field.  */
1548       _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_unshuffle (abfd, reloc_entry->howto->type, FALSE,
1549 				       location);
1550       status = _bfd_relocate_contents (reloc_entry->howto, abfd, val,
1551 				       location);
1552       _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_shuffle (abfd, reloc_entry->howto->type, FALSE,
1553 				     location);
1554 
1555       if (status != bfd_reloc_ok)
1556 	return status;
1557     }
1558 
1559   if (relocatable)
1560     reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
1561 
1562   return bfd_reloc_ok;
1563 }
1564 
1565 /* Swap an entry in a .gptab section.  Note that these routines rely
1566    on the equivalence of the two elements of the union.  */
1567 
1568 static void
bfd_mips_elf32_swap_gptab_in(bfd * abfd,const Elf32_External_gptab * ex,Elf32_gptab * in)1569 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_gptab_in (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_External_gptab *ex,
1570 			      Elf32_gptab *in)
1571 {
1572   in->gt_entry.gt_g_value = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->gt_entry.gt_g_value);
1573   in->gt_entry.gt_bytes = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->gt_entry.gt_bytes);
1574 }
1575 
1576 static void
bfd_mips_elf32_swap_gptab_out(bfd * abfd,const Elf32_gptab * in,Elf32_External_gptab * ex)1577 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_gptab_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_gptab *in,
1578 			       Elf32_External_gptab *ex)
1579 {
1580   H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->gt_entry.gt_g_value, ex->gt_entry.gt_g_value);
1581   H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->gt_entry.gt_bytes, ex->gt_entry.gt_bytes);
1582 }
1583 
1584 static void
bfd_elf32_swap_compact_rel_out(bfd * abfd,const Elf32_compact_rel * in,Elf32_External_compact_rel * ex)1585 bfd_elf32_swap_compact_rel_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_compact_rel *in,
1586 				Elf32_External_compact_rel *ex)
1587 {
1588   H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->id1, ex->id1);
1589   H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->num, ex->num);
1590   H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->id2, ex->id2);
1591   H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->offset, ex->offset);
1592   H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->reserved0, ex->reserved0);
1593   H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->reserved1, ex->reserved1);
1594 }
1595 
1596 static void
bfd_elf32_swap_crinfo_out(bfd * abfd,const Elf32_crinfo * in,Elf32_External_crinfo * ex)1597 bfd_elf32_swap_crinfo_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_crinfo *in,
1598 			   Elf32_External_crinfo *ex)
1599 {
1600   unsigned long l;
1601 
1602   l = (((in->ctype & CRINFO_CTYPE) << CRINFO_CTYPE_SH)
1603        | ((in->rtype & CRINFO_RTYPE) << CRINFO_RTYPE_SH)
1604        | ((in->dist2to & CRINFO_DIST2TO) << CRINFO_DIST2TO_SH)
1605        | ((in->relvaddr & CRINFO_RELVADDR) << CRINFO_RELVADDR_SH));
1606   H_PUT_32 (abfd, l, ex->info);
1607   H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->konst, ex->konst);
1608   H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->vaddr, ex->vaddr);
1609 }
1610 
1611 /* A .reginfo section holds a single Elf32_RegInfo structure.  These
1612    routines swap this structure in and out.  They are used outside of
1613    BFD, so they are globally visible.  */
1614 
1615 void
bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_in(bfd * abfd,const Elf32_External_RegInfo * ex,Elf32_RegInfo * in)1616 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_in (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_External_RegInfo *ex,
1617 				Elf32_RegInfo *in)
1618 {
1619   in->ri_gprmask = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_gprmask);
1620   in->ri_cprmask[0] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[0]);
1621   in->ri_cprmask[1] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[1]);
1622   in->ri_cprmask[2] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[2]);
1623   in->ri_cprmask[3] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[3]);
1624   in->ri_gp_value = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_gp_value);
1625 }
1626 
1627 void
bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_out(bfd * abfd,const Elf32_RegInfo * in,Elf32_External_RegInfo * ex)1628 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_RegInfo *in,
1629 				 Elf32_External_RegInfo *ex)
1630 {
1631   H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_gprmask, ex->ri_gprmask);
1632   H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[0], ex->ri_cprmask[0]);
1633   H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[1], ex->ri_cprmask[1]);
1634   H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[2], ex->ri_cprmask[2]);
1635   H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[3], ex->ri_cprmask[3]);
1636   H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_gp_value, ex->ri_gp_value);
1637 }
1638 
1639 /* In the 64 bit ABI, the .MIPS.options section holds register
1640    information in an Elf64_Reginfo structure.  These routines swap
1641    them in and out.  They are globally visible because they are used
1642    outside of BFD.  These routines are here so that gas can call them
1643    without worrying about whether the 64 bit ABI has been included.  */
1644 
1645 void
bfd_mips_elf64_swap_reginfo_in(bfd * abfd,const Elf64_External_RegInfo * ex,Elf64_Internal_RegInfo * in)1646 bfd_mips_elf64_swap_reginfo_in (bfd *abfd, const Elf64_External_RegInfo *ex,
1647 				Elf64_Internal_RegInfo *in)
1648 {
1649   in->ri_gprmask = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_gprmask);
1650   in->ri_pad = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_pad);
1651   in->ri_cprmask[0] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[0]);
1652   in->ri_cprmask[1] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[1]);
1653   in->ri_cprmask[2] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[2]);
1654   in->ri_cprmask[3] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[3]);
1655   in->ri_gp_value = H_GET_64 (abfd, ex->ri_gp_value);
1656 }
1657 
1658 void
bfd_mips_elf64_swap_reginfo_out(bfd * abfd,const Elf64_Internal_RegInfo * in,Elf64_External_RegInfo * ex)1659 bfd_mips_elf64_swap_reginfo_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf64_Internal_RegInfo *in,
1660 				 Elf64_External_RegInfo *ex)
1661 {
1662   H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_gprmask, ex->ri_gprmask);
1663   H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_pad, ex->ri_pad);
1664   H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[0], ex->ri_cprmask[0]);
1665   H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[1], ex->ri_cprmask[1]);
1666   H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[2], ex->ri_cprmask[2]);
1667   H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[3], ex->ri_cprmask[3]);
1668   H_PUT_64 (abfd, in->ri_gp_value, ex->ri_gp_value);
1669 }
1670 
1671 /* Swap in an options header.  */
1672 
1673 void
bfd_mips_elf_swap_options_in(bfd * abfd,const Elf_External_Options * ex,Elf_Internal_Options * in)1674 bfd_mips_elf_swap_options_in (bfd *abfd, const Elf_External_Options *ex,
1675 			      Elf_Internal_Options *in)
1676 {
1677   in->kind = H_GET_8 (abfd, ex->kind);
1678   in->size = H_GET_8 (abfd, ex->size);
1679   in->section = H_GET_16 (abfd, ex->section);
1680   in->info = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->info);
1681 }
1682 
1683 /* Swap out an options header.  */
1684 
1685 void
bfd_mips_elf_swap_options_out(bfd * abfd,const Elf_Internal_Options * in,Elf_External_Options * ex)1686 bfd_mips_elf_swap_options_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf_Internal_Options *in,
1687 			       Elf_External_Options *ex)
1688 {
1689   H_PUT_8 (abfd, in->kind, ex->kind);
1690   H_PUT_8 (abfd, in->size, ex->size);
1691   H_PUT_16 (abfd, in->section, ex->section);
1692   H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->info, ex->info);
1693 }
1694 
1695 /* This function is called via qsort() to sort the dynamic relocation
1696    entries by increasing r_symndx value.  */
1697 
1698 static int
sort_dynamic_relocs(const void * arg1,const void * arg2)1699 sort_dynamic_relocs (const void *arg1, const void *arg2)
1700 {
1701   Elf_Internal_Rela int_reloc1;
1702   Elf_Internal_Rela int_reloc2;
1703   int diff;
1704 
1705   bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (reldyn_sorting_bfd, arg1, &int_reloc1);
1706   bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (reldyn_sorting_bfd, arg2, &int_reloc2);
1707 
1708   diff = ELF32_R_SYM (int_reloc1.r_info) - ELF32_R_SYM (int_reloc2.r_info);
1709   if (diff != 0)
1710     return diff;
1711 
1712   if (int_reloc1.r_offset < int_reloc2.r_offset)
1713     return -1;
1714   if (int_reloc1.r_offset > int_reloc2.r_offset)
1715     return 1;
1716   return 0;
1717 }
1718 
1719 /* Like sort_dynamic_relocs, but used for elf64 relocations.  */
1720 
1721 static int
sort_dynamic_relocs_64(const void * arg1 ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,const void * arg2 ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)1722 sort_dynamic_relocs_64 (const void *arg1 ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1723 			const void *arg2 ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1724 {
1725 #ifdef BFD64
1726   Elf_Internal_Rela int_reloc1[3];
1727   Elf_Internal_Rela int_reloc2[3];
1728 
1729   (*get_elf_backend_data (reldyn_sorting_bfd)->s->swap_reloc_in)
1730     (reldyn_sorting_bfd, arg1, int_reloc1);
1731   (*get_elf_backend_data (reldyn_sorting_bfd)->s->swap_reloc_in)
1732     (reldyn_sorting_bfd, arg2, int_reloc2);
1733 
1734   if (ELF64_R_SYM (int_reloc1[0].r_info) < ELF64_R_SYM (int_reloc2[0].r_info))
1735     return -1;
1736   if (ELF64_R_SYM (int_reloc1[0].r_info) > ELF64_R_SYM (int_reloc2[0].r_info))
1737     return 1;
1738 
1739   if (int_reloc1[0].r_offset < int_reloc2[0].r_offset)
1740     return -1;
1741   if (int_reloc1[0].r_offset > int_reloc2[0].r_offset)
1742     return 1;
1743   return 0;
1744 #else
1745   abort ();
1746 #endif
1747 }
1748 
1749 
1750 /* This routine is used to write out ECOFF debugging external symbol
1751    information.  It is called via mips_elf_link_hash_traverse.  The
1752    ECOFF external symbol information must match the ELF external
1753    symbol information.  Unfortunately, at this point we don't know
1754    whether a symbol is required by reloc information, so the two
1755    tables may wind up being different.  We must sort out the external
1756    symbol information before we can set the final size of the .mdebug
1757    section, and we must set the size of the .mdebug section before we
1758    can relocate any sections, and we can't know which symbols are
1759    required by relocation until we relocate the sections.
1760    Fortunately, it is relatively unlikely that any symbol will be
1761    stripped but required by a reloc.  In particular, it can not happen
1762    when generating a final executable.  */
1763 
1764 static bfd_boolean
mips_elf_output_extsym(struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry * h,void * data)1765 mips_elf_output_extsym (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *data)
1766 {
1767   struct extsym_info *einfo = data;
1768   bfd_boolean strip;
1769   asection *sec, *output_section;
1770 
1771   if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
1772     h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
1773 
1774   if (h->root.indx == -2)
1775     strip = FALSE;
1776   else if ((h->root.def_dynamic
1777 	    || h->root.ref_dynamic
1778 	    || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
1779 	   && !h->root.def_regular
1780 	   && !h->root.ref_regular)
1781     strip = TRUE;
1782   else if (einfo->info->strip == strip_all
1783 	   || (einfo->info->strip == strip_some
1784 	       && bfd_hash_lookup (einfo->info->keep_hash,
1785 				   h->root.root.root.string,
1786 				   FALSE, FALSE) == NULL))
1787     strip = TRUE;
1788   else
1789     strip = FALSE;
1790 
1791   if (strip)
1792     return TRUE;
1793 
1794   if (h->esym.ifd == -2)
1795     {
1796       h->esym.jmptbl = 0;
1797       h->esym.cobol_main = 0;
1798       h->esym.weakext = 0;
1799       h->esym.reserved = 0;
1800       h->esym.ifd = ifdNil;
1801       h->esym.asym.value = 0;
1802       h->esym.asym.st = stGlobal;
1803 
1804       if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
1805 	  || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
1806 	{
1807 	  const char *name;
1808 
1809 	  /* Use undefined class.  Also, set class and type for some
1810              special symbols.  */
1811 	  name = h->root.root.root.string;
1812 	  if (strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[0]) == 0
1813 	      || strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[1]) == 0)
1814 	    {
1815 	      h->esym.asym.sc = scData;
1816 	      h->esym.asym.st = stLabel;
1817 	      h->esym.asym.value = 0;
1818 	    }
1819 	  else if (strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[2]) == 0)
1820 	    {
1821 	      h->esym.asym.sc = scAbs;
1822 	      h->esym.asym.st = stLabel;
1823 	      h->esym.asym.value =
1824 		mips_elf_hash_table (einfo->info)->procedure_count;
1825 	    }
1826 	  else if (strcmp (name, "_gp_disp") == 0 && ! NEWABI_P (einfo->abfd))
1827 	    {
1828 	      h->esym.asym.sc = scAbs;
1829 	      h->esym.asym.st = stLabel;
1830 	      h->esym.asym.value = elf_gp (einfo->abfd);
1831 	    }
1832 	  else
1833 	    h->esym.asym.sc = scUndefined;
1834 	}
1835       else if (h->root.root.type != bfd_link_hash_defined
1836 	  && h->root.root.type != bfd_link_hash_defweak)
1837 	h->esym.asym.sc = scAbs;
1838       else
1839 	{
1840 	  const char *name;
1841 
1842 	  sec = h->root.root.u.def.section;
1843 	  output_section = sec->output_section;
1844 
1845 	  /* When making a shared library and symbol h is the one from
1846 	     the another shared library, OUTPUT_SECTION may be null.  */
1847 	  if (output_section == NULL)
1848 	    h->esym.asym.sc = scUndefined;
1849 	  else
1850 	    {
1851 	      name = bfd_section_name (output_section->owner, output_section);
1852 
1853 	      if (strcmp (name, ".text") == 0)
1854 		h->esym.asym.sc = scText;
1855 	      else if (strcmp (name, ".data") == 0)
1856 		h->esym.asym.sc = scData;
1857 	      else if (strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0)
1858 		h->esym.asym.sc = scSData;
1859 	      else if (strcmp (name, ".rodata") == 0
1860 		       || strcmp (name, ".rdata") == 0)
1861 		h->esym.asym.sc = scRData;
1862 	      else if (strcmp (name, ".bss") == 0)
1863 		h->esym.asym.sc = scBss;
1864 	      else if (strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0)
1865 		h->esym.asym.sc = scSBss;
1866 	      else if (strcmp (name, ".init") == 0)
1867 		h->esym.asym.sc = scInit;
1868 	      else if (strcmp (name, ".fini") == 0)
1869 		h->esym.asym.sc = scFini;
1870 	      else
1871 		h->esym.asym.sc = scAbs;
1872 	    }
1873 	}
1874 
1875       h->esym.asym.reserved = 0;
1876       h->esym.asym.index = indexNil;
1877     }
1878 
1879   if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_common)
1880     h->esym.asym.value = h->root.root.u.c.size;
1881   else if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
1882 	   || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
1883     {
1884       if (h->esym.asym.sc == scCommon)
1885 	h->esym.asym.sc = scBss;
1886       else if (h->esym.asym.sc == scSCommon)
1887 	h->esym.asym.sc = scSBss;
1888 
1889       sec = h->root.root.u.def.section;
1890       output_section = sec->output_section;
1891       if (output_section != NULL)
1892 	h->esym.asym.value = (h->root.root.u.def.value
1893 			      + sec->output_offset
1894 			      + output_section->vma);
1895       else
1896 	h->esym.asym.value = 0;
1897     }
1898   else if (h->root.needs_plt)
1899     {
1900       struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hd = h;
1901       bfd_boolean no_fn_stub = h->no_fn_stub;
1902 
1903       while (hd->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
1904 	{
1905 	  hd = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)h->root.root.u.i.link;
1906 	  no_fn_stub = no_fn_stub || hd->no_fn_stub;
1907 	}
1908 
1909       if (!no_fn_stub)
1910 	{
1911 	  /* Set type and value for a symbol with a function stub.  */
1912 	  h->esym.asym.st = stProc;
1913 	  sec = hd->root.root.u.def.section;
1914 	  if (sec == NULL)
1915 	    h->esym.asym.value = 0;
1916 	  else
1917 	    {
1918 	      output_section = sec->output_section;
1919 	      if (output_section != NULL)
1920 		h->esym.asym.value = (hd->root.plt.offset
1921 				      + sec->output_offset
1922 				      + output_section->vma);
1923 	      else
1924 		h->esym.asym.value = 0;
1925 	    }
1926 	}
1927     }
1928 
1929   if (! bfd_ecoff_debug_one_external (einfo->abfd, einfo->debug, einfo->swap,
1930 				      h->root.root.root.string,
1931 				      &h->esym))
1932     {
1933       einfo->failed = TRUE;
1934       return FALSE;
1935     }
1936 
1937   return TRUE;
1938 }
1939 
1940 /* A comparison routine used to sort .gptab entries.  */
1941 
1942 static int
gptab_compare(const void * p1,const void * p2)1943 gptab_compare (const void *p1, const void *p2)
1944 {
1945   const Elf32_gptab *a1 = p1;
1946   const Elf32_gptab *a2 = p2;
1947 
1948   return a1->gt_entry.gt_g_value - a2->gt_entry.gt_g_value;
1949 }
1950 
1951 /* Functions to manage the got entry hash table.  */
1952 
1953 /* Use all 64 bits of a bfd_vma for the computation of a 32-bit
1954    hash number.  */
1955 
1956 static INLINE hashval_t
mips_elf_hash_bfd_vma(bfd_vma addr)1957 mips_elf_hash_bfd_vma (bfd_vma addr)
1958 {
1959 #ifdef BFD64
1960   return addr + (addr >> 32);
1961 #else
1962   return addr;
1963 #endif
1964 }
1965 
1966 /* got_entries only match if they're identical, except for gotidx, so
1967    use all fields to compute the hash, and compare the appropriate
1968    union members.  */
1969 
1970 static hashval_t
mips_elf_got_entry_hash(const void * entry_)1971 mips_elf_got_entry_hash (const void *entry_)
1972 {
1973   const struct mips_got_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_entry *)entry_;
1974 
1975   return entry->symndx
1976     + ((entry->tls_type & GOT_TLS_LDM) << 17)
1977     + (! entry->abfd ? mips_elf_hash_bfd_vma (entry->d.address)
1978        : entry->abfd->id
1979          + (entry->symndx >= 0 ? mips_elf_hash_bfd_vma (entry->d.addend)
1980 	    : entry->d.h->root.root.root.hash));
1981 }
1982 
1983 static int
mips_elf_got_entry_eq(const void * entry1,const void * entry2)1984 mips_elf_got_entry_eq (const void *entry1, const void *entry2)
1985 {
1986   const struct mips_got_entry *e1 = (struct mips_got_entry *)entry1;
1987   const struct mips_got_entry *e2 = (struct mips_got_entry *)entry2;
1988 
1989   /* An LDM entry can only match another LDM entry.  */
1990   if ((e1->tls_type ^ e2->tls_type) & GOT_TLS_LDM)
1991     return 0;
1992 
1993   return e1->abfd == e2->abfd && e1->symndx == e2->symndx
1994     && (! e1->abfd ? e1->d.address == e2->d.address
1995 	: e1->symndx >= 0 ? e1->d.addend == e2->d.addend
1996 	: e1->d.h == e2->d.h);
1997 }
1998 
1999 /* multi_got_entries are still a match in the case of global objects,
2000    even if the input bfd in which they're referenced differs, so the
2001    hash computation and compare functions are adjusted
2002    accordingly.  */
2003 
2004 static hashval_t
mips_elf_multi_got_entry_hash(const void * entry_)2005 mips_elf_multi_got_entry_hash (const void *entry_)
2006 {
2007   const struct mips_got_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_entry *)entry_;
2008 
2009   return entry->symndx
2010     + (! entry->abfd
2011        ? mips_elf_hash_bfd_vma (entry->d.address)
2012        : entry->symndx >= 0
2013        ? ((entry->tls_type & GOT_TLS_LDM)
2014 	  ? (GOT_TLS_LDM << 17)
2015 	  : (entry->abfd->id
2016 	     + mips_elf_hash_bfd_vma (entry->d.addend)))
2017        : entry->d.h->root.root.root.hash);
2018 }
2019 
2020 static int
mips_elf_multi_got_entry_eq(const void * entry1,const void * entry2)2021 mips_elf_multi_got_entry_eq (const void *entry1, const void *entry2)
2022 {
2023   const struct mips_got_entry *e1 = (struct mips_got_entry *)entry1;
2024   const struct mips_got_entry *e2 = (struct mips_got_entry *)entry2;
2025 
2026   /* Any two LDM entries match.  */
2027   if (e1->tls_type & e2->tls_type & GOT_TLS_LDM)
2028     return 1;
2029 
2030   /* Nothing else matches an LDM entry.  */
2031   if ((e1->tls_type ^ e2->tls_type) & GOT_TLS_LDM)
2032     return 0;
2033 
2034   return e1->symndx == e2->symndx
2035     && (e1->symndx >= 0 ? e1->abfd == e2->abfd && e1->d.addend == e2->d.addend
2036 	: e1->abfd == NULL || e2->abfd == NULL
2037 	? e1->abfd == e2->abfd && e1->d.address == e2->d.address
2038 	: e1->d.h == e2->d.h);
2039 }
2040 
2041 /* Return the dynamic relocation section.  If it doesn't exist, try to
2042    create a new it if CREATE_P, otherwise return NULL.  Also return NULL
2043    if creation fails.  */
2044 
2045 static asection *
mips_elf_rel_dyn_section(struct bfd_link_info * info,bfd_boolean create_p)2046 mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (struct bfd_link_info *info, bfd_boolean create_p)
2047 {
2048   const char *dname;
2049   asection *sreloc;
2050   bfd *dynobj;
2051 
2052   dname = MIPS_ELF_REL_DYN_NAME (info);
2053   dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
2054   sreloc = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, dname);
2055   if (sreloc == NULL && create_p)
2056     {
2057       sreloc = bfd_make_section_with_flags (dynobj, dname,
2058 					    (SEC_ALLOC
2059 					     | SEC_LOAD
2060 					     | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2061 					     | SEC_IN_MEMORY
2062 					     | SEC_LINKER_CREATED
2063 					     | SEC_READONLY));
2064       if (sreloc == NULL
2065 	  || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (dynobj, sreloc,
2066 					  MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (dynobj)))
2067 	return NULL;
2068     }
2069   return sreloc;
2070 }
2071 
2072 /* Returns the GOT section for ABFD.  */
2073 
2074 static asection *
mips_elf_got_section(bfd * abfd,bfd_boolean maybe_excluded)2075 mips_elf_got_section (bfd *abfd, bfd_boolean maybe_excluded)
2076 {
2077   asection *sgot = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".got");
2078   if (sgot == NULL
2079       || (! maybe_excluded && (sgot->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) != 0))
2080     return NULL;
2081   return sgot;
2082 }
2083 
2084 /* Returns the GOT information associated with the link indicated by
2085    INFO.  If SGOTP is non-NULL, it is filled in with the GOT
2086    section.  */
2087 
2088 static struct mips_got_info *
mips_elf_got_info(bfd * abfd,asection ** sgotp)2089 mips_elf_got_info (bfd *abfd, asection **sgotp)
2090 {
2091   asection *sgot;
2092   struct mips_got_info *g;
2093 
2094   sgot = mips_elf_got_section (abfd, TRUE);
2095   BFD_ASSERT (sgot != NULL);
2096   BFD_ASSERT (mips_elf_section_data (sgot) != NULL);
2097   g = mips_elf_section_data (sgot)->u.got_info;
2098   BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
2099 
2100   if (sgotp)
2101     *sgotp = (sgot->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) == 0 ? sgot : NULL;
2102 
2103   return g;
2104 }
2105 
2106 /* Count the number of relocations needed for a TLS GOT entry, with
2107    access types from TLS_TYPE, and symbol H (or a local symbol if H
2108    is NULL).  */
2109 
2110 static int
mips_tls_got_relocs(struct bfd_link_info * info,unsigned char tls_type,struct elf_link_hash_entry * h)2111 mips_tls_got_relocs (struct bfd_link_info *info, unsigned char tls_type,
2112 		     struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
2113 {
2114   int indx = 0;
2115   int ret = 0;
2116   bfd_boolean need_relocs = FALSE;
2117   bfd_boolean dyn = elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created;
2118 
2119   if (h && WILL_CALL_FINISH_DYNAMIC_SYMBOL (dyn, info->shared, h)
2120       && (!info->shared || !SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h)))
2121     indx = h->dynindx;
2122 
2123   if ((info->shared || indx != 0)
2124       && (h == NULL
2125 	  || ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) == STV_DEFAULT
2126 	  || h->root.type != bfd_link_hash_undefweak))
2127     need_relocs = TRUE;
2128 
2129   if (!need_relocs)
2130     return FALSE;
2131 
2132   if (tls_type & GOT_TLS_GD)
2133     {
2134       ret++;
2135       if (indx != 0)
2136 	ret++;
2137     }
2138 
2139   if (tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE)
2140     ret++;
2141 
2142   if ((tls_type & GOT_TLS_LDM) && info->shared)
2143     ret++;
2144 
2145   return ret;
2146 }
2147 
2148 /* Count the number of TLS relocations required for the GOT entry in
2149    ARG1, if it describes a local symbol.  */
2150 
2151 static int
mips_elf_count_local_tls_relocs(void ** arg1,void * arg2)2152 mips_elf_count_local_tls_relocs (void **arg1, void *arg2)
2153 {
2154   struct mips_got_entry *entry = * (struct mips_got_entry **) arg1;
2155   struct mips_elf_count_tls_arg *arg = arg2;
2156 
2157   if (entry->abfd != NULL && entry->symndx != -1)
2158     arg->needed += mips_tls_got_relocs (arg->info, entry->tls_type, NULL);
2159 
2160   return 1;
2161 }
2162 
2163 /* Count the number of TLS GOT entries required for the global (or
2164    forced-local) symbol in ARG1.  */
2165 
2166 static int
mips_elf_count_global_tls_entries(void * arg1,void * arg2)2167 mips_elf_count_global_tls_entries (void *arg1, void *arg2)
2168 {
2169   struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hm
2170     = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) arg1;
2171   struct mips_elf_count_tls_arg *arg = arg2;
2172 
2173   if (hm->tls_type & GOT_TLS_GD)
2174     arg->needed += 2;
2175   if (hm->tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE)
2176     arg->needed += 1;
2177 
2178   return 1;
2179 }
2180 
2181 /* Count the number of TLS relocations required for the global (or
2182    forced-local) symbol in ARG1.  */
2183 
2184 static int
mips_elf_count_global_tls_relocs(void * arg1,void * arg2)2185 mips_elf_count_global_tls_relocs (void *arg1, void *arg2)
2186 {
2187   struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hm
2188     = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) arg1;
2189   struct mips_elf_count_tls_arg *arg = arg2;
2190 
2191   arg->needed += mips_tls_got_relocs (arg->info, hm->tls_type, &hm->root);
2192 
2193   return 1;
2194 }
2195 
2196 /* Output a simple dynamic relocation into SRELOC.  */
2197 
2198 static void
mips_elf_output_dynamic_relocation(bfd * output_bfd,asection * sreloc,unsigned long indx,int r_type,bfd_vma offset)2199 mips_elf_output_dynamic_relocation (bfd *output_bfd,
2200 				    asection *sreloc,
2201 				    unsigned long indx,
2202 				    int r_type,
2203 				    bfd_vma offset)
2204 {
2205   Elf_Internal_Rela rel[3];
2206 
2207   memset (rel, 0, sizeof (rel));
2208 
2209   rel[0].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, indx, r_type);
2210   rel[0].r_offset = rel[1].r_offset = rel[2].r_offset = offset;
2211 
2212   if (ABI_64_P (output_bfd))
2213     {
2214       (*get_elf_backend_data (output_bfd)->s->swap_reloc_out)
2215 	(output_bfd, &rel[0],
2216 	 (sreloc->contents
2217 	  + sreloc->reloc_count * sizeof (Elf64_Mips_External_Rel)));
2218     }
2219   else
2220     bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out
2221       (output_bfd, &rel[0],
2222        (sreloc->contents
2223 	+ sreloc->reloc_count * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rel)));
2224   ++sreloc->reloc_count;
2225 }
2226 
2227 /* Initialize a set of TLS GOT entries for one symbol.  */
2228 
2229 static void
mips_elf_initialize_tls_slots(bfd * abfd,bfd_vma got_offset,unsigned char * tls_type_p,struct bfd_link_info * info,struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry * h,bfd_vma value)2230 mips_elf_initialize_tls_slots (bfd *abfd, bfd_vma got_offset,
2231 			       unsigned char *tls_type_p,
2232 			       struct bfd_link_info *info,
2233 			       struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h,
2234 			       bfd_vma value)
2235 {
2236   int indx;
2237   asection *sreloc, *sgot;
2238   bfd_vma offset, offset2;
2239   bfd *dynobj;
2240   bfd_boolean need_relocs = FALSE;
2241 
2242   dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
2243   sgot = mips_elf_got_section (dynobj, FALSE);
2244 
2245   indx = 0;
2246   if (h != NULL)
2247     {
2248       bfd_boolean dyn = elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created;
2249 
2250       if (WILL_CALL_FINISH_DYNAMIC_SYMBOL (dyn, info->shared, &h->root)
2251 	  && (!info->shared || !SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &h->root)))
2252 	indx = h->root.dynindx;
2253     }
2254 
2255   if (*tls_type_p & GOT_TLS_DONE)
2256     return;
2257 
2258   if ((info->shared || indx != 0)
2259       && (h == NULL
2260 	  || ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->root.other) == STV_DEFAULT
2261 	  || h->root.type != bfd_link_hash_undefweak))
2262     need_relocs = TRUE;
2263 
2264   /* MINUS_ONE means the symbol is not defined in this object.  It may not
2265      be defined at all; assume that the value doesn't matter in that
2266      case.  Otherwise complain if we would use the value.  */
2267   BFD_ASSERT (value != MINUS_ONE || (indx != 0 && need_relocs)
2268 	      || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak);
2269 
2270   /* Emit necessary relocations.  */
2271   sreloc = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
2272 
2273   /* General Dynamic.  */
2274   if (*tls_type_p & GOT_TLS_GD)
2275     {
2276       offset = got_offset;
2277       offset2 = offset + MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd);
2278 
2279       if (need_relocs)
2280 	{
2281 	  mips_elf_output_dynamic_relocation
2282 	    (abfd, sreloc, indx,
2283 	     ABI_64_P (abfd) ? R_MIPS_TLS_DTPMOD64 : R_MIPS_TLS_DTPMOD32,
2284 	     sgot->output_offset + sgot->output_section->vma + offset);
2285 
2286 	  if (indx)
2287 	    mips_elf_output_dynamic_relocation
2288 	      (abfd, sreloc, indx,
2289 	       ABI_64_P (abfd) ? R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL64 : R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL32,
2290 	       sgot->output_offset + sgot->output_section->vma + offset2);
2291 	  else
2292 	    MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, value - dtprel_base (info),
2293 			       sgot->contents + offset2);
2294 	}
2295       else
2296 	{
2297 	  MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, 1,
2298 			     sgot->contents + offset);
2299 	  MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, value - dtprel_base (info),
2300 			     sgot->contents + offset2);
2301 	}
2302 
2303       got_offset += 2 * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd);
2304     }
2305 
2306   /* Initial Exec model.  */
2307   if (*tls_type_p & GOT_TLS_IE)
2308     {
2309       offset = got_offset;
2310 
2311       if (need_relocs)
2312 	{
2313 	  if (indx == 0)
2314 	    MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, value - elf_hash_table (info)->tls_sec->vma,
2315 			       sgot->contents + offset);
2316 	  else
2317 	    MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, 0,
2318 			       sgot->contents + offset);
2319 
2320 	  mips_elf_output_dynamic_relocation
2321 	    (abfd, sreloc, indx,
2322 	     ABI_64_P (abfd) ? R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL64 : R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL32,
2323 	     sgot->output_offset + sgot->output_section->vma + offset);
2324 	}
2325       else
2326 	MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, value - tprel_base (info),
2327 			   sgot->contents + offset);
2328     }
2329 
2330   if (*tls_type_p & GOT_TLS_LDM)
2331     {
2332       /* The initial offset is zero, and the LD offsets will include the
2333 	 bias by DTP_OFFSET.  */
2334       MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, 0,
2335 			 sgot->contents + got_offset
2336 			 + MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd));
2337 
2338       if (!info->shared)
2339 	MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, 1,
2340 			   sgot->contents + got_offset);
2341       else
2342 	mips_elf_output_dynamic_relocation
2343 	  (abfd, sreloc, indx,
2344 	   ABI_64_P (abfd) ? R_MIPS_TLS_DTPMOD64 : R_MIPS_TLS_DTPMOD32,
2345 	   sgot->output_offset + sgot->output_section->vma + got_offset);
2346     }
2347 
2348   *tls_type_p |= GOT_TLS_DONE;
2349 }
2350 
2351 /* Return the GOT index to use for a relocation of type R_TYPE against
2352    a symbol accessed using TLS_TYPE models.  The GOT entries for this
2353    symbol in this GOT start at GOT_INDEX.  This function initializes the
2354    GOT entries and corresponding relocations.  */
2355 
2356 static bfd_vma
mips_tls_got_index(bfd * abfd,bfd_vma got_index,unsigned char * tls_type,int r_type,struct bfd_link_info * info,struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry * h,bfd_vma symbol)2357 mips_tls_got_index (bfd *abfd, bfd_vma got_index, unsigned char *tls_type,
2358 		    int r_type, struct bfd_link_info *info,
2359 		    struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h, bfd_vma symbol)
2360 {
2361   BFD_ASSERT (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_GD
2362 	      || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_LDM);
2363 
2364   mips_elf_initialize_tls_slots (abfd, got_index, tls_type, info, h, symbol);
2365 
2366   if (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL)
2367     {
2368       BFD_ASSERT (*tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE);
2369       if (*tls_type & GOT_TLS_GD)
2370 	return got_index + 2 * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd);
2371       else
2372 	return got_index;
2373     }
2374 
2375   if (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_GD)
2376     {
2377       BFD_ASSERT (*tls_type & GOT_TLS_GD);
2378       return got_index;
2379     }
2380 
2381   if (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_LDM)
2382     {
2383       BFD_ASSERT (*tls_type & GOT_TLS_LDM);
2384       return got_index;
2385     }
2386 
2387   return got_index;
2388 }
2389 
2390 /* Return the offset from _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ of the .got.plt entry
2391    for global symbol H.  .got.plt comes before the GOT, so the offset
2392    will be negative.  */
2393 
2394 static bfd_vma
mips_elf_gotplt_index(struct bfd_link_info * info,struct elf_link_hash_entry * h)2395 mips_elf_gotplt_index (struct bfd_link_info *info,
2396 		       struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
2397 {
2398   bfd_vma plt_index, got_address, got_value;
2399   struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
2400 
2401   htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
2402   BFD_ASSERT (h->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1);
2403 
2404   /* Calculate the index of the symbol's PLT entry.  */
2405   plt_index = (h->plt.offset - htab->plt_header_size) / htab->plt_entry_size;
2406 
2407   /* Calculate the address of the associated .got.plt entry.  */
2408   got_address = (htab->sgotplt->output_section->vma
2409 		 + htab->sgotplt->output_offset
2410 		 + plt_index * 4);
2411 
2412   /* Calculate the value of _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_.  */
2413   got_value = (htab->root.hgot->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma
2414 	       + htab->root.hgot->root.u.def.section->output_offset
2415 	       + htab->root.hgot->root.u.def.value);
2416 
2417   return got_address - got_value;
2418 }
2419 
2420 /* Return the GOT offset for address VALUE.   If there is not yet a GOT
2421    entry for this value, create one.  If R_SYMNDX refers to a TLS symbol,
2422    create a TLS GOT entry instead.  Return -1 if no satisfactory GOT
2423    offset can be found.  */
2424 
2425 static bfd_vma
mips_elf_local_got_index(bfd * abfd,bfd * ibfd,struct bfd_link_info * info,bfd_vma value,unsigned long r_symndx,struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry * h,int r_type)2426 mips_elf_local_got_index (bfd *abfd, bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
2427 			  bfd_vma value, unsigned long r_symndx,
2428 			  struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h, int r_type)
2429 {
2430   asection *sgot;
2431   struct mips_got_info *g;
2432   struct mips_got_entry *entry;
2433 
2434   g = mips_elf_got_info (elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj, &sgot);
2435 
2436   entry = mips_elf_create_local_got_entry (abfd, info, ibfd, g, sgot,
2437 					   value, r_symndx, h, r_type);
2438   if (!entry)
2439     return MINUS_ONE;
2440 
2441   if (TLS_RELOC_P (r_type))
2442     {
2443       if (entry->symndx == -1 && g->next == NULL)
2444 	/* A type (3) entry in the single-GOT case.  We use the symbol's
2445 	   hash table entry to track the index.  */
2446 	return mips_tls_got_index (abfd, h->tls_got_offset, &h->tls_type,
2447 				   r_type, info, h, value);
2448       else
2449 	return mips_tls_got_index (abfd, entry->gotidx, &entry->tls_type,
2450 				   r_type, info, h, value);
2451     }
2452   else
2453     return entry->gotidx;
2454 }
2455 
2456 /* Returns the GOT index for the global symbol indicated by H.  */
2457 
2458 static bfd_vma
mips_elf_global_got_index(bfd * abfd,bfd * ibfd,struct elf_link_hash_entry * h,int r_type,struct bfd_link_info * info)2459 mips_elf_global_got_index (bfd *abfd, bfd *ibfd, struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
2460 			   int r_type, struct bfd_link_info *info)
2461 {
2462   bfd_vma index;
2463   asection *sgot;
2464   struct mips_got_info *g, *gg;
2465   long global_got_dynindx = 0;
2466 
2467   gg = g = mips_elf_got_info (abfd, &sgot);
2468   if (g->bfd2got && ibfd)
2469     {
2470       struct mips_got_entry e, *p;
2471 
2472       BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx >= 0);
2473 
2474       g = mips_elf_got_for_ibfd (g, ibfd);
2475       if (g->next != gg || TLS_RELOC_P (r_type))
2476 	{
2477 	  e.abfd = ibfd;
2478 	  e.symndx = -1;
2479 	  e.d.h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)h;
2480 	  e.tls_type = 0;
2481 
2482 	  p = htab_find (g->got_entries, &e);
2483 
2484 	  BFD_ASSERT (p->gotidx > 0);
2485 
2486 	  if (TLS_RELOC_P (r_type))
2487 	    {
2488 	      bfd_vma value = MINUS_ONE;
2489 	      if ((h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
2490 		   || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
2491 		  && h->root.u.def.section->output_section)
2492 		value = (h->root.u.def.value
2493 			 + h->root.u.def.section->output_offset
2494 			 + h->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma);
2495 
2496 	      return mips_tls_got_index (abfd, p->gotidx, &p->tls_type, r_type,
2497 					 info, e.d.h, value);
2498 	    }
2499 	  else
2500 	    return p->gotidx;
2501 	}
2502     }
2503 
2504   if (gg->global_gotsym != NULL)
2505     global_got_dynindx = gg->global_gotsym->dynindx;
2506 
2507   if (TLS_RELOC_P (r_type))
2508     {
2509       struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hm
2510 	= (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
2511       bfd_vma value = MINUS_ONE;
2512 
2513       if ((h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
2514 	   || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
2515 	  && h->root.u.def.section->output_section)
2516 	value = (h->root.u.def.value
2517 		 + h->root.u.def.section->output_offset
2518 		 + h->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma);
2519 
2520       index = mips_tls_got_index (abfd, hm->tls_got_offset, &hm->tls_type,
2521 				  r_type, info, hm, value);
2522     }
2523   else
2524     {
2525       /* Once we determine the global GOT entry with the lowest dynamic
2526 	 symbol table index, we must put all dynamic symbols with greater
2527 	 indices into the GOT.  That makes it easy to calculate the GOT
2528 	 offset.  */
2529       BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx >= global_got_dynindx);
2530       index = ((h->dynindx - global_got_dynindx + g->local_gotno)
2531 	       * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd));
2532     }
2533   BFD_ASSERT (index < sgot->size);
2534 
2535   return index;
2536 }
2537 
2538 /* Find a GOT page entry that points to within 32KB of VALUE.  These
2539    entries are supposed to be placed at small offsets in the GOT, i.e.,
2540    within 32KB of GP.  Return the index of the GOT entry, or -1 if no
2541    entry could be created.  If OFFSETP is nonnull, use it to return the
2542    offset of the GOT entry from VALUE.  */
2543 
2544 static bfd_vma
mips_elf_got_page(bfd * abfd,bfd * ibfd,struct bfd_link_info * info,bfd_vma value,bfd_vma * offsetp)2545 mips_elf_got_page (bfd *abfd, bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
2546 		   bfd_vma value, bfd_vma *offsetp)
2547 {
2548   asection *sgot;
2549   struct mips_got_info *g;
2550   bfd_vma page, index;
2551   struct mips_got_entry *entry;
2552 
2553   g = mips_elf_got_info (elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj, &sgot);
2554 
2555   page = (value + 0x8000) & ~(bfd_vma) 0xffff;
2556   entry = mips_elf_create_local_got_entry (abfd, info, ibfd, g, sgot,
2557 					   page, 0, NULL, R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE);
2558 
2559   if (!entry)
2560     return MINUS_ONE;
2561 
2562   index = entry->gotidx;
2563 
2564   if (offsetp)
2565     *offsetp = value - entry->d.address;
2566 
2567   return index;
2568 }
2569 
2570 /* Find a local GOT entry for an R_MIPS_GOT16 relocation against VALUE.
2571    EXTERNAL is true if the relocation was against a global symbol
2572    that has been forced local.  */
2573 
2574 static bfd_vma
mips_elf_got16_entry(bfd * abfd,bfd * ibfd,struct bfd_link_info * info,bfd_vma value,bfd_boolean external)2575 mips_elf_got16_entry (bfd *abfd, bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
2576 		      bfd_vma value, bfd_boolean external)
2577 {
2578   asection *sgot;
2579   struct mips_got_info *g;
2580   struct mips_got_entry *entry;
2581 
2582   /* GOT16 relocations against local symbols are followed by a LO16
2583      relocation; those against global symbols are not.  Thus if the
2584      symbol was originally local, the GOT16 relocation should load the
2585      equivalent of %hi(VALUE), otherwise it should load VALUE itself.  */
2586   if (! external)
2587     value = mips_elf_high (value) << 16;
2588 
2589   g = mips_elf_got_info (elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj, &sgot);
2590 
2591   entry = mips_elf_create_local_got_entry (abfd, info, ibfd, g, sgot,
2592 					   value, 0, NULL, R_MIPS_GOT16);
2593   if (entry)
2594     return entry->gotidx;
2595   else
2596     return MINUS_ONE;
2597 }
2598 
2599 /* Returns the offset for the entry at the INDEXth position
2600    in the GOT.  */
2601 
2602 static bfd_vma
mips_elf_got_offset_from_index(bfd * dynobj,bfd * output_bfd,bfd * input_bfd,bfd_vma index)2603 mips_elf_got_offset_from_index (bfd *dynobj, bfd *output_bfd,
2604 				bfd *input_bfd, bfd_vma index)
2605 {
2606   asection *sgot;
2607   bfd_vma gp;
2608   struct mips_got_info *g;
2609 
2610   g = mips_elf_got_info (dynobj, &sgot);
2611   gp = _bfd_get_gp_value (output_bfd)
2612     + mips_elf_adjust_gp (output_bfd, g, input_bfd);
2613 
2614   return sgot->output_section->vma + sgot->output_offset + index - gp;
2615 }
2616 
2617 /* Create and return a local GOT entry for VALUE, which was calculated
2618    from a symbol belonging to INPUT_SECTON.  Return NULL if it could not
2619    be created.  If R_SYMNDX refers to a TLS symbol, create a TLS entry
2620    instead.  */
2621 
2622 static struct mips_got_entry *
mips_elf_create_local_got_entry(bfd * abfd,struct bfd_link_info * info,bfd * ibfd,struct mips_got_info * gg,asection * sgot,bfd_vma value,unsigned long r_symndx,struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry * h,int r_type)2623 mips_elf_create_local_got_entry (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
2624 				 bfd *ibfd, struct mips_got_info *gg,
2625 				 asection *sgot, bfd_vma value,
2626 				 unsigned long r_symndx,
2627 				 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h,
2628 				 int r_type)
2629 {
2630   struct mips_got_entry entry, **loc;
2631   struct mips_got_info *g;
2632   struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
2633 
2634   htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
2635 
2636   entry.abfd = NULL;
2637   entry.symndx = -1;
2638   entry.d.address = value;
2639   entry.tls_type = 0;
2640 
2641   g = mips_elf_got_for_ibfd (gg, ibfd);
2642   if (g == NULL)
2643     {
2644       g = mips_elf_got_for_ibfd (gg, abfd);
2645       BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
2646     }
2647 
2648   /* We might have a symbol, H, if it has been forced local.  Use the
2649      global entry then.  It doesn't matter whether an entry is local
2650      or global for TLS, since the dynamic linker does not
2651      automatically relocate TLS GOT entries.  */
2652   BFD_ASSERT (h == NULL || h->root.forced_local);
2653   if (TLS_RELOC_P (r_type))
2654     {
2655       struct mips_got_entry *p;
2656 
2657       entry.abfd = ibfd;
2658       if (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_LDM)
2659 	{
2660 	  entry.tls_type = GOT_TLS_LDM;
2661 	  entry.symndx = 0;
2662 	  entry.d.addend = 0;
2663 	}
2664       else if (h == NULL)
2665 	{
2666 	  entry.symndx = r_symndx;
2667 	  entry.d.addend = 0;
2668 	}
2669       else
2670 	entry.d.h = h;
2671 
2672       p = (struct mips_got_entry *)
2673 	htab_find (g->got_entries, &entry);
2674 
2675       BFD_ASSERT (p);
2676       return p;
2677     }
2678 
2679   loc = (struct mips_got_entry **) htab_find_slot (g->got_entries, &entry,
2680 						   INSERT);
2681   if (*loc)
2682     return *loc;
2683 
2684   entry.gotidx = MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd) * g->assigned_gotno++;
2685   entry.tls_type = 0;
2686 
2687   *loc = (struct mips_got_entry *)bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof entry);
2688 
2689   if (! *loc)
2690     return NULL;
2691 
2692   memcpy (*loc, &entry, sizeof entry);
2693 
2694   if (g->assigned_gotno >= g->local_gotno)
2695     {
2696       (*loc)->gotidx = -1;
2697       /* We didn't allocate enough space in the GOT.  */
2698       (*_bfd_error_handler)
2699 	(_("not enough GOT space for local GOT entries"));
2700       bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
2701       return NULL;
2702     }
2703 
2704   MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, value,
2705 		     (sgot->contents + entry.gotidx));
2706 
2707   /* These GOT entries need a dynamic relocation on VxWorks.  */
2708   if (htab->is_vxworks)
2709     {
2710       Elf_Internal_Rela outrel;
2711       asection *s;
2712       bfd_byte *loc;
2713       bfd_vma got_address;
2714 
2715       s = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
2716       got_address = (sgot->output_section->vma
2717 		     + sgot->output_offset
2718 		     + entry.gotidx);
2719 
2720       loc = s->contents + (s->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
2721       outrel.r_offset = got_address;
2722       outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_MIPS_32);
2723       outrel.r_addend = value;
2724       bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (abfd, &outrel, loc);
2725     }
2726 
2727   return *loc;
2728 }
2729 
2730 /* Sort the dynamic symbol table so that symbols that need GOT entries
2731    appear towards the end.  This reduces the amount of GOT space
2732    required.  MAX_LOCAL is used to set the number of local symbols
2733    known to be in the dynamic symbol table.  During
2734    _bfd_mips_elf_size_dynamic_sections, this value is 1.  Afterward, the
2735    section symbols are added and the count is higher.  */
2736 
2737 static bfd_boolean
mips_elf_sort_hash_table(struct bfd_link_info * info,unsigned long max_local)2738 mips_elf_sort_hash_table (struct bfd_link_info *info, unsigned long max_local)
2739 {
2740   struct mips_elf_hash_sort_data hsd;
2741   struct mips_got_info *g;
2742   bfd *dynobj;
2743 
2744   dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
2745 
2746   g = mips_elf_got_info (dynobj, NULL);
2747 
2748   hsd.low = NULL;
2749   hsd.max_unref_got_dynindx =
2750   hsd.min_got_dynindx = elf_hash_table (info)->dynsymcount
2751     /* In the multi-got case, assigned_gotno of the master got_info
2752        indicate the number of entries that aren't referenced in the
2753        primary GOT, but that must have entries because there are
2754        dynamic relocations that reference it.  Since they aren't
2755        referenced, we move them to the end of the GOT, so that they
2756        don't prevent other entries that are referenced from getting
2757        too large offsets.  */
2758     - (g->next ? g->assigned_gotno : 0);
2759   hsd.max_non_got_dynindx = max_local;
2760   mips_elf_link_hash_traverse (((struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *)
2761 				elf_hash_table (info)),
2762 			       mips_elf_sort_hash_table_f,
2763 			       &hsd);
2764 
2765   /* There should have been enough room in the symbol table to
2766      accommodate both the GOT and non-GOT symbols.  */
2767   BFD_ASSERT (hsd.max_non_got_dynindx <= hsd.min_got_dynindx);
2768   BFD_ASSERT ((unsigned long)hsd.max_unref_got_dynindx
2769 	      <= elf_hash_table (info)->dynsymcount);
2770 
2771   /* Now we know which dynamic symbol has the lowest dynamic symbol
2772      table index in the GOT.  */
2773   g->global_gotsym = hsd.low;
2774 
2775   return TRUE;
2776 }
2777 
2778 /* If H needs a GOT entry, assign it the highest available dynamic
2779    index.  Otherwise, assign it the lowest available dynamic
2780    index.  */
2781 
2782 static bfd_boolean
mips_elf_sort_hash_table_f(struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry * h,void * data)2783 mips_elf_sort_hash_table_f (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *data)
2784 {
2785   struct mips_elf_hash_sort_data *hsd = data;
2786 
2787   if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
2788     h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
2789 
2790   /* Symbols without dynamic symbol table entries aren't interesting
2791      at all.  */
2792   if (h->root.dynindx == -1)
2793     return TRUE;
2794 
2795   /* Global symbols that need GOT entries that are not explicitly
2796      referenced are marked with got offset 2.  Those that are
2797      referenced get a 1, and those that don't need GOT entries get
2798      -1.  */
2799   if (h->root.got.offset == 2)
2800     {
2801       BFD_ASSERT (h->tls_type == GOT_NORMAL);
2802 
2803       if (hsd->max_unref_got_dynindx == hsd->min_got_dynindx)
2804 	hsd->low = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
2805       h->root.dynindx = hsd->max_unref_got_dynindx++;
2806     }
2807   else if (h->root.got.offset != 1)
2808     h->root.dynindx = hsd->max_non_got_dynindx++;
2809   else
2810     {
2811       BFD_ASSERT (h->tls_type == GOT_NORMAL);
2812 
2813       h->root.dynindx = --hsd->min_got_dynindx;
2814       hsd->low = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
2815     }
2816 
2817   return TRUE;
2818 }
2819 
2820 /* If H is a symbol that needs a global GOT entry, but has a dynamic
2821    symbol table index lower than any we've seen to date, record it for
2822    posterity.  */
2823 
2824 static bfd_boolean
mips_elf_record_global_got_symbol(struct elf_link_hash_entry * h,bfd * abfd,struct bfd_link_info * info,struct mips_got_info * g,unsigned char tls_flag)2825 mips_elf_record_global_got_symbol (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
2826 				   bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
2827 				   struct mips_got_info *g,
2828 				   unsigned char tls_flag)
2829 {
2830   struct mips_got_entry entry, **loc;
2831 
2832   /* A global symbol in the GOT must also be in the dynamic symbol
2833      table.  */
2834   if (h->dynindx == -1)
2835     {
2836       switch (ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other))
2837 	{
2838 	case STV_INTERNAL:
2839 	case STV_HIDDEN:
2840 	  _bfd_mips_elf_hide_symbol (info, h, TRUE);
2841 	  break;
2842 	}
2843       if (!bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
2844 	return FALSE;
2845     }
2846 
2847   /* Make sure we have a GOT to put this entry into.  */
2848   BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
2849 
2850   entry.abfd = abfd;
2851   entry.symndx = -1;
2852   entry.d.h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
2853   entry.tls_type = 0;
2854 
2855   loc = (struct mips_got_entry **) htab_find_slot (g->got_entries, &entry,
2856 						   INSERT);
2857 
2858   /* If we've already marked this entry as needing GOT space, we don't
2859      need to do it again.  */
2860   if (*loc)
2861     {
2862       (*loc)->tls_type |= tls_flag;
2863       return TRUE;
2864     }
2865 
2866   *loc = (struct mips_got_entry *)bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof entry);
2867 
2868   if (! *loc)
2869     return FALSE;
2870 
2871   entry.gotidx = -1;
2872   entry.tls_type = tls_flag;
2873 
2874   memcpy (*loc, &entry, sizeof entry);
2875 
2876   if (h->got.offset != MINUS_ONE)
2877     return TRUE;
2878 
2879   /* By setting this to a value other than -1, we are indicating that
2880      there needs to be a GOT entry for H.  Avoid using zero, as the
2881      generic ELF copy_indirect_symbol tests for <= 0.  */
2882   if (tls_flag == 0)
2883     h->got.offset = 1;
2884 
2885   return TRUE;
2886 }
2887 
2888 /* Reserve space in G for a GOT entry containing the value of symbol
2889    SYMNDX in input bfd ABDF, plus ADDEND.  */
2890 
2891 static bfd_boolean
mips_elf_record_local_got_symbol(bfd * abfd,long symndx,bfd_vma addend,struct mips_got_info * g,unsigned char tls_flag)2892 mips_elf_record_local_got_symbol (bfd *abfd, long symndx, bfd_vma addend,
2893 				  struct mips_got_info *g,
2894 				  unsigned char tls_flag)
2895 {
2896   struct mips_got_entry entry, **loc;
2897 
2898   entry.abfd = abfd;
2899   entry.symndx = symndx;
2900   entry.d.addend = addend;
2901   entry.tls_type = tls_flag;
2902   loc = (struct mips_got_entry **)
2903     htab_find_slot (g->got_entries, &entry, INSERT);
2904 
2905   if (*loc)
2906     {
2907       if (tls_flag == GOT_TLS_GD && !((*loc)->tls_type & GOT_TLS_GD))
2908 	{
2909 	  g->tls_gotno += 2;
2910 	  (*loc)->tls_type |= tls_flag;
2911 	}
2912       else if (tls_flag == GOT_TLS_IE && !((*loc)->tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE))
2913 	{
2914 	  g->tls_gotno += 1;
2915 	  (*loc)->tls_type |= tls_flag;
2916 	}
2917       return TRUE;
2918     }
2919 
2920   if (tls_flag != 0)
2921     {
2922       entry.gotidx = -1;
2923       entry.tls_type = tls_flag;
2924       if (tls_flag == GOT_TLS_IE)
2925 	g->tls_gotno += 1;
2926       else if (tls_flag == GOT_TLS_GD)
2927 	g->tls_gotno += 2;
2928       else if (g->tls_ldm_offset == MINUS_ONE)
2929 	{
2930 	  g->tls_ldm_offset = MINUS_TWO;
2931 	  g->tls_gotno += 2;
2932 	}
2933     }
2934   else
2935     {
2936       entry.gotidx = g->local_gotno++;
2937       entry.tls_type = 0;
2938     }
2939 
2940   *loc = (struct mips_got_entry *)bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof entry);
2941 
2942   if (! *loc)
2943     return FALSE;
2944 
2945   memcpy (*loc, &entry, sizeof entry);
2946 
2947   return TRUE;
2948 }
2949 
2950 /* Compute the hash value of the bfd in a bfd2got hash entry.  */
2951 
2952 static hashval_t
mips_elf_bfd2got_entry_hash(const void * entry_)2953 mips_elf_bfd2got_entry_hash (const void *entry_)
2954 {
2955   const struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *entry
2956     = (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)entry_;
2957 
2958   return entry->bfd->id;
2959 }
2960 
2961 /* Check whether two hash entries have the same bfd.  */
2962 
2963 static int
mips_elf_bfd2got_entry_eq(const void * entry1,const void * entry2)2964 mips_elf_bfd2got_entry_eq (const void *entry1, const void *entry2)
2965 {
2966   const struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *e1
2967     = (const struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)entry1;
2968   const struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *e2
2969     = (const struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)entry2;
2970 
2971   return e1->bfd == e2->bfd;
2972 }
2973 
2974 /* In a multi-got link, determine the GOT to be used for IBFD.  G must
2975    be the master GOT data.  */
2976 
2977 static struct mips_got_info *
mips_elf_got_for_ibfd(struct mips_got_info * g,bfd * ibfd)2978 mips_elf_got_for_ibfd (struct mips_got_info *g, bfd *ibfd)
2979 {
2980   struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash e, *p;
2981 
2982   if (! g->bfd2got)
2983     return g;
2984 
2985   e.bfd = ibfd;
2986   p = htab_find (g->bfd2got, &e);
2987   return p ? p->g : NULL;
2988 }
2989 
2990 /* Create one separate got for each bfd that has entries in the global
2991    got, such that we can tell how many local and global entries each
2992    bfd requires.  */
2993 
2994 static int
mips_elf_make_got_per_bfd(void ** entryp,void * p)2995 mips_elf_make_got_per_bfd (void **entryp, void *p)
2996 {
2997   struct mips_got_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_entry *)*entryp;
2998   struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg *arg = (struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg *)p;
2999   htab_t bfd2got = arg->bfd2got;
3000   struct mips_got_info *g;
3001   struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash bfdgot_entry, *bfdgot;
3002   void **bfdgotp;
3003 
3004   /* Find the got_info for this GOT entry's input bfd.  Create one if
3005      none exists.  */
3006   bfdgot_entry.bfd = entry->abfd;
3007   bfdgotp = htab_find_slot (bfd2got, &bfdgot_entry, INSERT);
3008   bfdgot = (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)*bfdgotp;
3009 
3010   if (bfdgot != NULL)
3011     g = bfdgot->g;
3012   else
3013     {
3014       bfdgot = (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)bfd_alloc
3015 	(arg->obfd, sizeof (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash));
3016 
3017       if (bfdgot == NULL)
3018 	{
3019 	  arg->obfd = 0;
3020 	  return 0;
3021 	}
3022 
3023       *bfdgotp = bfdgot;
3024 
3025       bfdgot->bfd = entry->abfd;
3026       bfdgot->g = g = (struct mips_got_info *)
3027 	bfd_alloc (arg->obfd, sizeof (struct mips_got_info));
3028       if (g == NULL)
3029 	{
3030 	  arg->obfd = 0;
3031 	  return 0;
3032 	}
3033 
3034       g->global_gotsym = NULL;
3035       g->global_gotno = 0;
3036       g->local_gotno = 0;
3037       g->assigned_gotno = -1;
3038       g->tls_gotno = 0;
3039       g->tls_assigned_gotno = 0;
3040       g->tls_ldm_offset = MINUS_ONE;
3041       g->got_entries = htab_try_create (1, mips_elf_multi_got_entry_hash,
3042 					mips_elf_multi_got_entry_eq, NULL);
3043       if (g->got_entries == NULL)
3044 	{
3045 	  arg->obfd = 0;
3046 	  return 0;
3047 	}
3048 
3049       g->bfd2got = NULL;
3050       g->next = NULL;
3051     }
3052 
3053   /* Insert the GOT entry in the bfd's got entry hash table.  */
3054   entryp = htab_find_slot (g->got_entries, entry, INSERT);
3055   if (*entryp != NULL)
3056     return 1;
3057 
3058   *entryp = entry;
3059 
3060   if (entry->tls_type)
3061     {
3062       if (entry->tls_type & (GOT_TLS_GD | GOT_TLS_LDM))
3063 	g->tls_gotno += 2;
3064       if (entry->tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE)
3065 	g->tls_gotno += 1;
3066     }
3067   else if (entry->symndx >= 0 || entry->d.h->forced_local)
3068     ++g->local_gotno;
3069   else
3070     ++g->global_gotno;
3071 
3072   return 1;
3073 }
3074 
3075 /* Attempt to merge gots of different input bfds.  Try to use as much
3076    as possible of the primary got, since it doesn't require explicit
3077    dynamic relocations, but don't use bfds that would reference global
3078    symbols out of the addressable range.  Failing the primary got,
3079    attempt to merge with the current got, or finish the current got
3080    and then make make the new got current.  */
3081 
3082 static int
mips_elf_merge_gots(void ** bfd2got_,void * p)3083 mips_elf_merge_gots (void **bfd2got_, void *p)
3084 {
3085   struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *bfd2got
3086     = (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)*bfd2got_;
3087   struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg *arg = (struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg *)p;
3088   unsigned int lcount = bfd2got->g->local_gotno;
3089   unsigned int gcount = bfd2got->g->global_gotno;
3090   unsigned int tcount = bfd2got->g->tls_gotno;
3091   unsigned int maxcnt = arg->max_count;
3092   bfd_boolean too_many_for_tls = FALSE;
3093 
3094   /* We place TLS GOT entries after both locals and globals.  The globals
3095      for the primary GOT may overflow the normal GOT size limit, so be
3096      sure not to merge a GOT which requires TLS with the primary GOT in that
3097      case.  This doesn't affect non-primary GOTs.  */
3098   if (tcount > 0)
3099     {
3100       unsigned int primary_total = lcount + tcount + arg->global_count;
3101       if (primary_total > maxcnt)
3102 	too_many_for_tls = TRUE;
3103     }
3104 
3105   /* If we don't have a primary GOT and this is not too big, use it as
3106      a starting point for the primary GOT.  */
3107   if (! arg->primary && lcount + gcount + tcount <= maxcnt
3108       && ! too_many_for_tls)
3109     {
3110       arg->primary = bfd2got->g;
3111       arg->primary_count = lcount + gcount;
3112     }
3113   /* If it looks like we can merge this bfd's entries with those of
3114      the primary, merge them.  The heuristics is conservative, but we
3115      don't have to squeeze it too hard.  */
3116   else if (arg->primary && ! too_many_for_tls
3117 	   && (arg->primary_count + lcount + gcount + tcount) <= maxcnt)
3118     {
3119       struct mips_got_info *g = bfd2got->g;
3120       int old_lcount = arg->primary->local_gotno;
3121       int old_gcount = arg->primary->global_gotno;
3122       int old_tcount = arg->primary->tls_gotno;
3123 
3124       bfd2got->g = arg->primary;
3125 
3126       htab_traverse (g->got_entries,
3127 		     mips_elf_make_got_per_bfd,
3128 		     arg);
3129       if (arg->obfd == NULL)
3130 	return 0;
3131 
3132       htab_delete (g->got_entries);
3133       /* We don't have to worry about releasing memory of the actual
3134 	 got entries, since they're all in the master got_entries hash
3135 	 table anyway.  */
3136 
3137       BFD_ASSERT (old_lcount + lcount >= arg->primary->local_gotno);
3138       BFD_ASSERT (old_gcount + gcount >= arg->primary->global_gotno);
3139       BFD_ASSERT (old_tcount + tcount >= arg->primary->tls_gotno);
3140 
3141       arg->primary_count = arg->primary->local_gotno
3142 	+ arg->primary->global_gotno + arg->primary->tls_gotno;
3143     }
3144   /* If we can merge with the last-created got, do it.  */
3145   else if (arg->current
3146 	   && arg->current_count + lcount + gcount + tcount <= maxcnt)
3147     {
3148       struct mips_got_info *g = bfd2got->g;
3149       int old_lcount = arg->current->local_gotno;
3150       int old_gcount = arg->current->global_gotno;
3151       int old_tcount = arg->current->tls_gotno;
3152 
3153       bfd2got->g = arg->current;
3154 
3155       htab_traverse (g->got_entries,
3156 		     mips_elf_make_got_per_bfd,
3157 		     arg);
3158       if (arg->obfd == NULL)
3159 	return 0;
3160 
3161       htab_delete (g->got_entries);
3162 
3163       BFD_ASSERT (old_lcount + lcount >= arg->current->local_gotno);
3164       BFD_ASSERT (old_gcount + gcount >= arg->current->global_gotno);
3165       BFD_ASSERT (old_tcount + tcount >= arg->current->tls_gotno);
3166 
3167       arg->current_count = arg->current->local_gotno
3168 	+ arg->current->global_gotno + arg->current->tls_gotno;
3169     }
3170   /* Well, we couldn't merge, so create a new GOT.  Don't check if it
3171      fits; if it turns out that it doesn't, we'll get relocation
3172      overflows anyway.  */
3173   else
3174     {
3175       bfd2got->g->next = arg->current;
3176       arg->current = bfd2got->g;
3177 
3178       arg->current_count = lcount + gcount + 2 * tcount;
3179     }
3180 
3181   return 1;
3182 }
3183 
3184 /* Set the TLS GOT index for the GOT entry in ENTRYP.  ENTRYP's NEXT field
3185    is null iff there is just a single GOT.  */
3186 
3187 static int
mips_elf_initialize_tls_index(void ** entryp,void * p)3188 mips_elf_initialize_tls_index (void **entryp, void *p)
3189 {
3190   struct mips_got_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_entry *)*entryp;
3191   struct mips_got_info *g = p;
3192   bfd_vma next_index;
3193   unsigned char tls_type;
3194 
3195   /* We're only interested in TLS symbols.  */
3196   if (entry->tls_type == 0)
3197     return 1;
3198 
3199   next_index = MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (entry->abfd) * (long) g->tls_assigned_gotno;
3200 
3201   if (entry->symndx == -1 && g->next == NULL)
3202     {
3203       /* A type (3) got entry in the single-GOT case.  We use the symbol's
3204 	 hash table entry to track its index.  */
3205       if (entry->d.h->tls_type & GOT_TLS_OFFSET_DONE)
3206 	return 1;
3207       entry->d.h->tls_type |= GOT_TLS_OFFSET_DONE;
3208       entry->d.h->tls_got_offset = next_index;
3209       tls_type = entry->d.h->tls_type;
3210     }
3211   else
3212     {
3213       if (entry->tls_type & GOT_TLS_LDM)
3214 	{
3215 	  /* There are separate mips_got_entry objects for each input bfd
3216 	     that requires an LDM entry.  Make sure that all LDM entries in
3217 	     a GOT resolve to the same index.  */
3218 	  if (g->tls_ldm_offset != MINUS_TWO && g->tls_ldm_offset != MINUS_ONE)
3219 	    {
3220 	      entry->gotidx = g->tls_ldm_offset;
3221 	      return 1;
3222 	    }
3223 	  g->tls_ldm_offset = next_index;
3224 	}
3225       entry->gotidx = next_index;
3226       tls_type = entry->tls_type;
3227     }
3228 
3229   /* Account for the entries we've just allocated.  */
3230   if (tls_type & (GOT_TLS_GD | GOT_TLS_LDM))
3231     g->tls_assigned_gotno += 2;
3232   if (tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE)
3233     g->tls_assigned_gotno += 1;
3234 
3235   return 1;
3236 }
3237 
3238 /* If passed a NULL mips_got_info in the argument, set the marker used
3239    to tell whether a global symbol needs a got entry (in the primary
3240    got) to the given VALUE.
3241 
3242    If passed a pointer G to a mips_got_info in the argument (it must
3243    not be the primary GOT), compute the offset from the beginning of
3244    the (primary) GOT section to the entry in G corresponding to the
3245    global symbol.  G's assigned_gotno must contain the index of the
3246    first available global GOT entry in G.  VALUE must contain the size
3247    of a GOT entry in bytes.  For each global GOT entry that requires a
3248    dynamic relocation, NEEDED_RELOCS is incremented, and the symbol is
3249    marked as not eligible for lazy resolution through a function
3250    stub.  */
3251 static int
mips_elf_set_global_got_offset(void ** entryp,void * p)3252 mips_elf_set_global_got_offset (void **entryp, void *p)
3253 {
3254   struct mips_got_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_entry *)*entryp;
3255   struct mips_elf_set_global_got_offset_arg *arg
3256     = (struct mips_elf_set_global_got_offset_arg *)p;
3257   struct mips_got_info *g = arg->g;
3258 
3259   if (g && entry->tls_type != GOT_NORMAL)
3260     arg->needed_relocs +=
3261       mips_tls_got_relocs (arg->info, entry->tls_type,
3262 			   entry->symndx == -1 ? &entry->d.h->root : NULL);
3263 
3264   if (entry->abfd != NULL && entry->symndx == -1
3265       && entry->d.h->root.dynindx != -1
3266       && entry->d.h->tls_type == GOT_NORMAL)
3267     {
3268       if (g)
3269 	{
3270 	  BFD_ASSERT (g->global_gotsym == NULL);
3271 
3272 	  entry->gotidx = arg->value * (long) g->assigned_gotno++;
3273 	  if (arg->info->shared
3274 	      || (elf_hash_table (arg->info)->dynamic_sections_created
3275 		  && entry->d.h->root.def_dynamic
3276 		  && !entry->d.h->root.def_regular))
3277 	    ++arg->needed_relocs;
3278 	}
3279       else
3280 	entry->d.h->root.got.offset = arg->value;
3281     }
3282 
3283   return 1;
3284 }
3285 
3286 /* Mark any global symbols referenced in the GOT we are iterating over
3287    as inelligible for lazy resolution stubs.  */
3288 static int
mips_elf_set_no_stub(void ** entryp,void * p ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)3289 mips_elf_set_no_stub (void **entryp, void *p ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3290 {
3291   struct mips_got_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_entry *)*entryp;
3292 
3293   if (entry->abfd != NULL
3294       && entry->symndx == -1
3295       && entry->d.h->root.dynindx != -1)
3296     entry->d.h->no_fn_stub = TRUE;
3297 
3298   return 1;
3299 }
3300 
3301 /* Follow indirect and warning hash entries so that each got entry
3302    points to the final symbol definition.  P must point to a pointer
3303    to the hash table we're traversing.  Since this traversal may
3304    modify the hash table, we set this pointer to NULL to indicate
3305    we've made a potentially-destructive change to the hash table, so
3306    the traversal must be restarted.  */
3307 static int
mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entry(void ** entryp,void * p)3308 mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entry (void **entryp, void *p)
3309 {
3310   struct mips_got_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_entry *)*entryp;
3311   htab_t got_entries = *(htab_t *)p;
3312 
3313   if (entry->abfd != NULL && entry->symndx == -1)
3314     {
3315       struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h = entry->d.h;
3316 
3317       while (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
3318  	     || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
3319 	h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
3320 
3321       if (entry->d.h == h)
3322 	return 1;
3323 
3324       entry->d.h = h;
3325 
3326       /* If we can't find this entry with the new bfd hash, re-insert
3327 	 it, and get the traversal restarted.  */
3328       if (! htab_find (got_entries, entry))
3329 	{
3330 	  htab_clear_slot (got_entries, entryp);
3331 	  entryp = htab_find_slot (got_entries, entry, INSERT);
3332 	  if (! *entryp)
3333 	    *entryp = entry;
3334 	  /* Abort the traversal, since the whole table may have
3335 	     moved, and leave it up to the parent to restart the
3336 	     process.  */
3337 	  *(htab_t *)p = NULL;
3338 	  return 0;
3339 	}
3340       /* We might want to decrement the global_gotno count, but it's
3341 	 either too early or too late for that at this point.  */
3342     }
3343 
3344   return 1;
3345 }
3346 
3347 /* Turn indirect got entries in a got_entries table into their final
3348    locations.  */
3349 static void
mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entries(struct mips_got_info * g)3350 mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entries (struct mips_got_info *g)
3351 {
3352   htab_t got_entries;
3353 
3354   do
3355     {
3356       got_entries = g->got_entries;
3357 
3358       htab_traverse (got_entries,
3359 		     mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entry,
3360 		     &got_entries);
3361     }
3362   while (got_entries == NULL);
3363 }
3364 
3365 /* Return the offset of an input bfd IBFD's GOT from the beginning of
3366    the primary GOT.  */
3367 static bfd_vma
mips_elf_adjust_gp(bfd * abfd,struct mips_got_info * g,bfd * ibfd)3368 mips_elf_adjust_gp (bfd *abfd, struct mips_got_info *g, bfd *ibfd)
3369 {
3370   if (g->bfd2got == NULL)
3371     return 0;
3372 
3373   g = mips_elf_got_for_ibfd (g, ibfd);
3374   if (! g)
3375     return 0;
3376 
3377   BFD_ASSERT (g->next);
3378 
3379   g = g->next;
3380 
3381   return (g->local_gotno + g->global_gotno + g->tls_gotno)
3382     * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd);
3383 }
3384 
3385 /* Turn a single GOT that is too big for 16-bit addressing into
3386    a sequence of GOTs, each one 16-bit addressable.  */
3387 
3388 static bfd_boolean
mips_elf_multi_got(bfd * abfd,struct bfd_link_info * info,struct mips_got_info * g,asection * got,bfd_size_type pages)3389 mips_elf_multi_got (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
3390 		    struct mips_got_info *g, asection *got,
3391 		    bfd_size_type pages)
3392 {
3393   struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg got_per_bfd_arg;
3394   struct mips_elf_set_global_got_offset_arg set_got_offset_arg;
3395   struct mips_got_info *gg;
3396   unsigned int assign;
3397 
3398   g->bfd2got = htab_try_create (1, mips_elf_bfd2got_entry_hash,
3399 				mips_elf_bfd2got_entry_eq, NULL);
3400   if (g->bfd2got == NULL)
3401     return FALSE;
3402 
3403   got_per_bfd_arg.bfd2got = g->bfd2got;
3404   got_per_bfd_arg.obfd = abfd;
3405   got_per_bfd_arg.info = info;
3406 
3407   /* Count how many GOT entries each input bfd requires, creating a
3408      map from bfd to got info while at that.  */
3409   htab_traverse (g->got_entries, mips_elf_make_got_per_bfd, &got_per_bfd_arg);
3410   if (got_per_bfd_arg.obfd == NULL)
3411     return FALSE;
3412 
3413   got_per_bfd_arg.current = NULL;
3414   got_per_bfd_arg.primary = NULL;
3415   /* Taking out PAGES entries is a worst-case estimate.  We could
3416      compute the maximum number of pages that each separate input bfd
3417      uses, but it's probably not worth it.  */
3418   got_per_bfd_arg.max_count = ((MIPS_ELF_GOT_MAX_SIZE (info)
3419 				/ MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd))
3420 			       - MIPS_RESERVED_GOTNO (info) - pages);
3421   /* The number of globals that will be included in the primary GOT.
3422      See the calls to mips_elf_set_global_got_offset below for more
3423      information.  */
3424   got_per_bfd_arg.global_count = g->global_gotno;
3425 
3426   /* Try to merge the GOTs of input bfds together, as long as they
3427      don't seem to exceed the maximum GOT size, choosing one of them
3428      to be the primary GOT.  */
3429   htab_traverse (g->bfd2got, mips_elf_merge_gots, &got_per_bfd_arg);
3430   if (got_per_bfd_arg.obfd == NULL)
3431     return FALSE;
3432 
3433   /* If we do not find any suitable primary GOT, create an empty one.  */
3434   if (got_per_bfd_arg.primary == NULL)
3435     {
3436       g->next = (struct mips_got_info *)
3437 	bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof (struct mips_got_info));
3438       if (g->next == NULL)
3439 	return FALSE;
3440 
3441       g->next->global_gotsym = NULL;
3442       g->next->global_gotno = 0;
3443       g->next->local_gotno = 0;
3444       g->next->tls_gotno = 0;
3445       g->next->assigned_gotno = 0;
3446       g->next->tls_assigned_gotno = 0;
3447       g->next->tls_ldm_offset = MINUS_ONE;
3448       g->next->got_entries = htab_try_create (1, mips_elf_multi_got_entry_hash,
3449 					      mips_elf_multi_got_entry_eq,
3450 					      NULL);
3451       if (g->next->got_entries == NULL)
3452 	return FALSE;
3453       g->next->bfd2got = NULL;
3454     }
3455   else
3456     g->next = got_per_bfd_arg.primary;
3457   g->next->next = got_per_bfd_arg.current;
3458 
3459   /* GG is now the master GOT, and G is the primary GOT.  */
3460   gg = g;
3461   g = g->next;
3462 
3463   /* Map the output bfd to the primary got.  That's what we're going
3464      to use for bfds that use GOT16 or GOT_PAGE relocations that we
3465      didn't mark in check_relocs, and we want a quick way to find it.
3466      We can't just use gg->next because we're going to reverse the
3467      list.  */
3468   {
3469     struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *bfdgot;
3470     void **bfdgotp;
3471 
3472     bfdgot = (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)bfd_alloc
3473       (abfd, sizeof (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash));
3474 
3475     if (bfdgot == NULL)
3476       return FALSE;
3477 
3478     bfdgot->bfd = abfd;
3479     bfdgot->g = g;
3480     bfdgotp = htab_find_slot (gg->bfd2got, bfdgot, INSERT);
3481 
3482     BFD_ASSERT (*bfdgotp == NULL);
3483     *bfdgotp = bfdgot;
3484   }
3485 
3486   /* The IRIX dynamic linker requires every symbol that is referenced
3487      in a dynamic relocation to be present in the primary GOT, so
3488      arrange for them to appear after those that are actually
3489      referenced.
3490 
3491      GNU/Linux could very well do without it, but it would slow down
3492      the dynamic linker, since it would have to resolve every dynamic
3493      symbol referenced in other GOTs more than once, without help from
3494      the cache.  Also, knowing that every external symbol has a GOT
3495      helps speed up the resolution of local symbols too, so GNU/Linux
3496      follows IRIX's practice.
3497 
3498      The number 2 is used by mips_elf_sort_hash_table_f to count
3499      global GOT symbols that are unreferenced in the primary GOT, with
3500      an initial dynamic index computed from gg->assigned_gotno, where
3501      the number of unreferenced global entries in the primary GOT is
3502      preserved.  */
3503   if (1)
3504     {
3505       gg->assigned_gotno = gg->global_gotno - g->global_gotno;
3506       g->global_gotno = gg->global_gotno;
3507       set_got_offset_arg.value = 2;
3508     }
3509   else
3510     {
3511       /* This could be used for dynamic linkers that don't optimize
3512 	 symbol resolution while applying relocations so as to use
3513 	 primary GOT entries or assuming the symbol is locally-defined.
3514 	 With this code, we assign lower dynamic indices to global
3515 	 symbols that are not referenced in the primary GOT, so that
3516 	 their entries can be omitted.  */
3517       gg->assigned_gotno = 0;
3518       set_got_offset_arg.value = -1;
3519     }
3520 
3521   /* Reorder dynamic symbols as described above (which behavior
3522      depends on the setting of VALUE).  */
3523   set_got_offset_arg.g = NULL;
3524   htab_traverse (gg->got_entries, mips_elf_set_global_got_offset,
3525 		 &set_got_offset_arg);
3526   set_got_offset_arg.value = 1;
3527   htab_traverse (g->got_entries, mips_elf_set_global_got_offset,
3528 		 &set_got_offset_arg);
3529   if (! mips_elf_sort_hash_table (info, 1))
3530     return FALSE;
3531 
3532   /* Now go through the GOTs assigning them offset ranges.
3533      [assigned_gotno, local_gotno[ will be set to the range of local
3534      entries in each GOT.  We can then compute the end of a GOT by
3535      adding local_gotno to global_gotno.  We reverse the list and make
3536      it circular since then we'll be able to quickly compute the
3537      beginning of a GOT, by computing the end of its predecessor.  To
3538      avoid special cases for the primary GOT, while still preserving
3539      assertions that are valid for both single- and multi-got links,
3540      we arrange for the main got struct to have the right number of
3541      global entries, but set its local_gotno such that the initial
3542      offset of the primary GOT is zero.  Remember that the primary GOT
3543      will become the last item in the circular linked list, so it
3544      points back to the master GOT.  */
3545   gg->local_gotno = -g->global_gotno;
3546   gg->global_gotno = g->global_gotno;
3547   gg->tls_gotno = 0;
3548   assign = 0;
3549   gg->next = gg;
3550 
3551   do
3552     {
3553       struct mips_got_info *gn;
3554 
3555       assign += MIPS_RESERVED_GOTNO (info);
3556       g->assigned_gotno = assign;
3557       g->local_gotno += assign + pages;
3558       assign = g->local_gotno + g->global_gotno + g->tls_gotno;
3559 
3560       /* Take g out of the direct list, and push it onto the reversed
3561 	 list that gg points to.  g->next is guaranteed to be nonnull after
3562 	 this operation, as required by mips_elf_initialize_tls_index. */
3563       gn = g->next;
3564       g->next = gg->next;
3565       gg->next = g;
3566 
3567       /* Set up any TLS entries.  We always place the TLS entries after
3568 	 all non-TLS entries.  */
3569       g->tls_assigned_gotno = g->local_gotno + g->global_gotno;
3570       htab_traverse (g->got_entries, mips_elf_initialize_tls_index, g);
3571 
3572       /* Move onto the next GOT.  It will be a secondary GOT if nonull.  */
3573       g = gn;
3574 
3575       /* Mark global symbols in every non-primary GOT as ineligible for
3576 	 stubs.  */
3577       if (g)
3578 	htab_traverse (g->got_entries, mips_elf_set_no_stub, NULL);
3579     }
3580   while (g);
3581 
3582   got->size = (gg->next->local_gotno
3583 		    + gg->next->global_gotno
3584 		    + gg->next->tls_gotno) * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd);
3585 
3586   return TRUE;
3587 }
3588 
3589 
3590 /* Returns the first relocation of type r_type found, beginning with
3591    RELOCATION.  RELEND is one-past-the-end of the relocation table.  */
3592 
3593 static const Elf_Internal_Rela *
mips_elf_next_relocation(bfd * abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,unsigned int r_type,const Elf_Internal_Rela * relocation,const Elf_Internal_Rela * relend)3594 mips_elf_next_relocation (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, unsigned int r_type,
3595 			  const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocation,
3596 			  const Elf_Internal_Rela *relend)
3597 {
3598   unsigned long r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (abfd, relocation->r_info);
3599 
3600   while (relocation < relend)
3601     {
3602       if (ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, relocation->r_info) == r_type
3603 	  && ELF_R_SYM (abfd, relocation->r_info) == r_symndx)
3604 	return relocation;
3605 
3606       ++relocation;
3607     }
3608 
3609   /* We didn't find it.  */
3610   return NULL;
3611 }
3612 
3613 /* Return whether a relocation is against a local symbol.  */
3614 
3615 static bfd_boolean
mips_elf_local_relocation_p(bfd * input_bfd,const Elf_Internal_Rela * relocation,asection ** local_sections,bfd_boolean check_forced)3616 mips_elf_local_relocation_p (bfd *input_bfd,
3617 			     const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocation,
3618 			     asection **local_sections,
3619 			     bfd_boolean check_forced)
3620 {
3621   unsigned long r_symndx;
3622   Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
3623   struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
3624   size_t extsymoff;
3625 
3626   r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (input_bfd, relocation->r_info);
3627   symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (input_bfd)->symtab_hdr;
3628   extsymoff = (elf_bad_symtab (input_bfd)) ? 0 : symtab_hdr->sh_info;
3629 
3630   if (r_symndx < extsymoff)
3631     return TRUE;
3632   if (elf_bad_symtab (input_bfd) && local_sections[r_symndx] != NULL)
3633     return TRUE;
3634 
3635   if (check_forced)
3636     {
3637       /* Look up the hash table to check whether the symbol
3638  	 was forced local.  */
3639       h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
3640 	elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd) [r_symndx - extsymoff];
3641       /* Find the real hash-table entry for this symbol.  */
3642       while (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
3643  	     || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
3644 	h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
3645       if (h->root.forced_local)
3646 	return TRUE;
3647     }
3648 
3649   return FALSE;
3650 }
3651 
3652 /* Sign-extend VALUE, which has the indicated number of BITS.  */
3653 
3654 bfd_vma
_bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend(bfd_vma value,int bits)3655 _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (bfd_vma value, int bits)
3656 {
3657   if (value & ((bfd_vma) 1 << (bits - 1)))
3658     /* VALUE is negative.  */
3659     value |= ((bfd_vma) - 1) << bits;
3660 
3661   return value;
3662 }
3663 
3664 /* Return non-zero if the indicated VALUE has overflowed the maximum
3665    range expressible by a signed number with the indicated number of
3666    BITS.  */
3667 
3668 static bfd_boolean
mips_elf_overflow_p(bfd_vma value,int bits)3669 mips_elf_overflow_p (bfd_vma value, int bits)
3670 {
3671   bfd_signed_vma svalue = (bfd_signed_vma) value;
3672 
3673   if (svalue > (1 << (bits - 1)) - 1)
3674     /* The value is too big.  */
3675     return TRUE;
3676   else if (svalue < -(1 << (bits - 1)))
3677     /* The value is too small.  */
3678     return TRUE;
3679 
3680   /* All is well.  */
3681   return FALSE;
3682 }
3683 
3684 /* Calculate the %high function.  */
3685 
3686 static bfd_vma
mips_elf_high(bfd_vma value)3687 mips_elf_high (bfd_vma value)
3688 {
3689   return ((value + (bfd_vma) 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
3690 }
3691 
3692 /* Calculate the %higher function.  */
3693 
3694 static bfd_vma
mips_elf_higher(bfd_vma value ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)3695 mips_elf_higher (bfd_vma value ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3696 {
3697 #ifdef BFD64
3698   return ((value + (bfd_vma) 0x80008000) >> 32) & 0xffff;
3699 #else
3700   abort ();
3701   return MINUS_ONE;
3702 #endif
3703 }
3704 
3705 /* Calculate the %highest function.  */
3706 
3707 static bfd_vma
mips_elf_highest(bfd_vma value ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)3708 mips_elf_highest (bfd_vma value ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3709 {
3710 #ifdef BFD64
3711   return ((value + (((bfd_vma) 0x8000 << 32) | 0x80008000)) >> 48) & 0xffff;
3712 #else
3713   abort ();
3714   return MINUS_ONE;
3715 #endif
3716 }
3717 
3718 /* Create the .compact_rel section.  */
3719 
3720 static bfd_boolean
mips_elf_create_compact_rel_section(bfd * abfd,struct bfd_link_info * info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)3721 mips_elf_create_compact_rel_section
3722   (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3723 {
3724   flagword flags;
3725   register asection *s;
3726 
3727   if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".compact_rel") == NULL)
3728     {
3729       flags = (SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED
3730 	       | SEC_READONLY);
3731 
3732       s = bfd_make_section_with_flags (abfd, ".compact_rel", flags);
3733       if (s == NULL
3734 	  || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s,
3735 					  MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd)))
3736 	return FALSE;
3737 
3738       s->size = sizeof (Elf32_External_compact_rel);
3739     }
3740 
3741   return TRUE;
3742 }
3743 
3744 /* Create the .got section to hold the global offset table.  */
3745 
3746 static bfd_boolean
mips_elf_create_got_section(bfd * abfd,struct bfd_link_info * info,bfd_boolean maybe_exclude)3747 mips_elf_create_got_section (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
3748 			     bfd_boolean maybe_exclude)
3749 {
3750   flagword flags;
3751   register asection *s;
3752   struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
3753   struct bfd_link_hash_entry *bh;
3754   struct mips_got_info *g;
3755   bfd_size_type amt;
3756   struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
3757 
3758   htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
3759 
3760   /* This function may be called more than once.  */
3761   s = mips_elf_got_section (abfd, TRUE);
3762   if (s)
3763     {
3764       if (! maybe_exclude)
3765 	s->flags &= ~SEC_EXCLUDE;
3766       return TRUE;
3767     }
3768 
3769   flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY
3770 	   | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
3771 
3772   if (maybe_exclude)
3773     flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
3774 
3775   /* We have to use an alignment of 2**4 here because this is hardcoded
3776      in the function stub generation and in the linker script.  */
3777   s = bfd_make_section_with_flags (abfd, ".got", flags);
3778   if (s == NULL
3779       || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, 4))
3780     return FALSE;
3781 
3782   /* Define the symbol _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_.  We don't do this in the
3783      linker script because we don't want to define the symbol if we
3784      are not creating a global offset table.  */
3785   bh = NULL;
3786   if (! (_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol
3787 	 (info, abfd, "_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_", BSF_GLOBAL, s,
3788 	  0, NULL, FALSE, get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->collect, &bh)))
3789     return FALSE;
3790 
3791   h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
3792   h->non_elf = 0;
3793   h->def_regular = 1;
3794   h->type = STT_OBJECT;
3795   elf_hash_table (info)->hgot = h;
3796 
3797   if (info->shared
3798       && ! bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
3799     return FALSE;
3800 
3801   amt = sizeof (struct mips_got_info);
3802   g = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
3803   if (g == NULL)
3804     return FALSE;
3805   g->global_gotsym = NULL;
3806   g->global_gotno = 0;
3807   g->tls_gotno = 0;
3808   g->local_gotno = MIPS_RESERVED_GOTNO (info);
3809   g->assigned_gotno = MIPS_RESERVED_GOTNO (info);
3810   g->bfd2got = NULL;
3811   g->next = NULL;
3812   g->tls_ldm_offset = MINUS_ONE;
3813   g->got_entries = htab_try_create (1, mips_elf_got_entry_hash,
3814 				    mips_elf_got_entry_eq, NULL);
3815   if (g->got_entries == NULL)
3816     return FALSE;
3817   mips_elf_section_data (s)->u.got_info = g;
3818   mips_elf_section_data (s)->elf.this_hdr.sh_flags
3819     |= SHF_ALLOC | SHF_WRITE | SHF_MIPS_GPREL;
3820 
3821   /* VxWorks also needs a .got.plt section.  */
3822   if (htab->is_vxworks)
3823     {
3824       s = bfd_make_section_with_flags (abfd, ".got.plt",
3825 				       SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
3826 				       | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
3827       if (s == NULL || !bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, 4))
3828 	return FALSE;
3829 
3830       htab->sgotplt = s;
3831     }
3832   return TRUE;
3833 }
3834 
3835 /* Return true if H refers to the special VxWorks __GOTT_BASE__ or
3836    __GOTT_INDEX__ symbols.  These symbols are only special for
3837    shared objects; they are not used in executables.  */
3838 
3839 static bfd_boolean
is_gott_symbol(struct bfd_link_info * info,struct elf_link_hash_entry * h)3840 is_gott_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info, struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
3841 {
3842   return (mips_elf_hash_table (info)->is_vxworks
3843 	  && info->shared
3844 	  && (strcmp (h->root.root.string, "__GOTT_BASE__") == 0
3845 	      || strcmp (h->root.root.string, "__GOTT_INDEX__") == 0));
3846 }
3847 
3848 /* Calculate the value produced by the RELOCATION (which comes from
3849    the INPUT_BFD).  The ADDEND is the addend to use for this
3850    RELOCATION; RELOCATION->R_ADDEND is ignored.
3851 
3852    The result of the relocation calculation is stored in VALUEP.
3853    REQUIRE_JALXP indicates whether or not the opcode used with this
3854    relocation must be JALX.
3855 
3856    This function returns bfd_reloc_continue if the caller need take no
3857    further action regarding this relocation, bfd_reloc_notsupported if
3858    something goes dramatically wrong, bfd_reloc_overflow if an
3859    overflow occurs, and bfd_reloc_ok to indicate success.  */
3860 
3861 static bfd_reloc_status_type
mips_elf_calculate_relocation(bfd * abfd,bfd * input_bfd,asection * input_section,struct bfd_link_info * info,const Elf_Internal_Rela * relocation,bfd_vma addend,reloc_howto_type * howto,Elf_Internal_Sym * local_syms,asection ** local_sections,bfd_vma * valuep,const char ** namep,bfd_boolean * require_jalxp,bfd_boolean save_addend)3862 mips_elf_calculate_relocation (bfd *abfd, bfd *input_bfd,
3863 			       asection *input_section,
3864 			       struct bfd_link_info *info,
3865 			       const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocation,
3866 			       bfd_vma addend, reloc_howto_type *howto,
3867 			       Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms,
3868 			       asection **local_sections, bfd_vma *valuep,
3869 			       const char **namep, bfd_boolean *require_jalxp,
3870 			       bfd_boolean save_addend)
3871 {
3872   /* The eventual value we will return.  */
3873   bfd_vma value;
3874   /* The address of the symbol against which the relocation is
3875      occurring.  */
3876   bfd_vma symbol = 0;
3877   /* The final GP value to be used for the relocatable, executable, or
3878      shared object file being produced.  */
3879   bfd_vma gp = MINUS_ONE;
3880   /* The place (section offset or address) of the storage unit being
3881      relocated.  */
3882   bfd_vma p;
3883   /* The value of GP used to create the relocatable object.  */
3884   bfd_vma gp0 = MINUS_ONE;
3885   /* The offset into the global offset table at which the address of
3886      the relocation entry symbol, adjusted by the addend, resides
3887      during execution.  */
3888   bfd_vma g = MINUS_ONE;
3889   /* The section in which the symbol referenced by the relocation is
3890      located.  */
3891   asection *sec = NULL;
3892   struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h = NULL;
3893   /* TRUE if the symbol referred to by this relocation is a local
3894      symbol.  */
3895   bfd_boolean local_p, was_local_p;
3896   /* TRUE if the symbol referred to by this relocation is "_gp_disp".  */
3897   bfd_boolean gp_disp_p = FALSE;
3898   /* TRUE if the symbol referred to by this relocation is
3899      "__gnu_local_gp".  */
3900   bfd_boolean gnu_local_gp_p = FALSE;
3901   Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
3902   size_t extsymoff;
3903   unsigned long r_symndx;
3904   int r_type;
3905   /* TRUE if overflow occurred during the calculation of the
3906      relocation value.  */
3907   bfd_boolean overflowed_p;
3908   /* TRUE if this relocation refers to a MIPS16 function.  */
3909   bfd_boolean target_is_16_bit_code_p = FALSE;
3910   struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
3911   bfd *dynobj;
3912 
3913   dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
3914   htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
3915 
3916   /* Parse the relocation.  */
3917   r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (input_bfd, relocation->r_info);
3918   r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (input_bfd, relocation->r_info);
3919   p = (input_section->output_section->vma
3920        + input_section->output_offset
3921        + relocation->r_offset);
3922 
3923   /* Assume that there will be no overflow.  */
3924   overflowed_p = FALSE;
3925 
3926   /* Figure out whether or not the symbol is local, and get the offset
3927      used in the array of hash table entries.  */
3928   symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (input_bfd)->symtab_hdr;
3929   local_p = mips_elf_local_relocation_p (input_bfd, relocation,
3930 					 local_sections, FALSE);
3931   was_local_p = local_p;
3932   if (! elf_bad_symtab (input_bfd))
3933     extsymoff = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
3934   else
3935     {
3936       /* The symbol table does not follow the rule that local symbols
3937 	 must come before globals.  */
3938       extsymoff = 0;
3939     }
3940 
3941   /* Figure out the value of the symbol.  */
3942   if (local_p)
3943     {
3944       Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
3945 
3946       sym = local_syms + r_symndx;
3947       sec = local_sections[r_symndx];
3948 
3949       symbol = sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
3950       if (ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) != STT_SECTION
3951 	  || (sec->flags & SEC_MERGE))
3952 	symbol += sym->st_value;
3953       if ((sec->flags & SEC_MERGE)
3954 	  && ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_SECTION)
3955 	{
3956 	  addend = _bfd_elf_rel_local_sym (abfd, sym, &sec, addend);
3957 	  addend -= symbol;
3958 	  addend += sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
3959 	}
3960 
3961       /* MIPS16 text labels should be treated as odd.  */
3962       if (sym->st_other == STO_MIPS16)
3963 	++symbol;
3964 
3965       /* Record the name of this symbol, for our caller.  */
3966       *namep = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (input_bfd,
3967 						symtab_hdr->sh_link,
3968 						sym->st_name);
3969       if (*namep == '\0')
3970 	*namep = bfd_section_name (input_bfd, sec);
3971 
3972       target_is_16_bit_code_p = (sym->st_other == STO_MIPS16);
3973     }
3974   else
3975     {
3976       /* ??? Could we use RELOC_FOR_GLOBAL_SYMBOL here ?  */
3977 
3978       /* For global symbols we look up the symbol in the hash-table.  */
3979       h = ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
3980 	   elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd) [r_symndx - extsymoff]);
3981       /* Find the real hash-table entry for this symbol.  */
3982       while (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
3983 	     || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
3984 	h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
3985 
3986       /* Record the name of this symbol, for our caller.  */
3987       *namep = h->root.root.root.string;
3988 
3989       /* See if this is the special _gp_disp symbol.  Note that such a
3990 	 symbol must always be a global symbol.  */
3991       if (strcmp (*namep, "_gp_disp") == 0
3992 	  && ! NEWABI_P (input_bfd))
3993 	{
3994 	  /* Relocations against _gp_disp are permitted only with
3995 	     R_MIPS_HI16 and R_MIPS_LO16 relocations.  */
3996 	  if (r_type != R_MIPS_HI16 && r_type != R_MIPS_LO16
3997 	      && r_type != R_MIPS16_HI16 && r_type != R_MIPS16_LO16)
3998 	    return bfd_reloc_notsupported;
3999 
4000 	  gp_disp_p = TRUE;
4001 	}
4002       /* See if this is the special _gp symbol.  Note that such a
4003 	 symbol must always be a global symbol.  */
4004       else if (strcmp (*namep, "__gnu_local_gp") == 0)
4005 	gnu_local_gp_p = TRUE;
4006 
4007 
4008       /* If this symbol is defined, calculate its address.  Note that
4009 	 _gp_disp is a magic symbol, always implicitly defined by the
4010 	 linker, so it's inappropriate to check to see whether or not
4011 	 its defined.  */
4012       else if ((h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
4013 		|| h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
4014 	       && h->root.root.u.def.section)
4015 	{
4016 	  sec = h->root.root.u.def.section;
4017 	  if (sec->output_section)
4018 	    symbol = (h->root.root.u.def.value
4019 		      + sec->output_section->vma
4020 		      + sec->output_offset);
4021 	  else
4022 	    symbol = h->root.root.u.def.value;
4023 	}
4024       else if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
4025 	/* We allow relocations against undefined weak symbols, giving
4026 	   it the value zero, so that you can undefined weak functions
4027 	   and check to see if they exist by looking at their
4028 	   addresses.  */
4029 	symbol = 0;
4030       else if (info->unresolved_syms_in_objects == RM_IGNORE
4031 	       && ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->root.other) == STV_DEFAULT)
4032 	symbol = 0;
4033       else if (strcmp (*namep, SGI_COMPAT (input_bfd)
4034 		       ? "_DYNAMIC_LINK" : "_DYNAMIC_LINKING") == 0)
4035 	{
4036 	  /* If this is a dynamic link, we should have created a
4037 	     _DYNAMIC_LINK symbol or _DYNAMIC_LINKING(for normal mips) symbol
4038 	     in in _bfd_mips_elf_create_dynamic_sections.
4039 	     Otherwise, we should define the symbol with a value of 0.
4040 	     FIXME: It should probably get into the symbol table
4041 	     somehow as well.  */
4042 	  BFD_ASSERT (! info->shared);
4043 	  BFD_ASSERT (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic") == NULL);
4044 	  symbol = 0;
4045 	}
4046       else if (ELF_MIPS_IS_OPTIONAL (h->root.other))
4047 	{
4048 	  /* This is an optional symbol - an Irix specific extension to the
4049 	     ELF spec.  Ignore it for now.
4050 	     XXX - FIXME - there is more to the spec for OPTIONAL symbols
4051 	     than simply ignoring them, but we do not handle this for now.
4052 	     For information see the "64-bit ELF Object File Specification"
4053 	     which is available from here:
4054 	     http://techpubs.sgi.com/library/manuals/4000/007-4658-001/pdf/007-4658-001.pdf  */
4055 	  symbol = 0;
4056 	}
4057       else
4058 	{
4059 	  if (! ((*info->callbacks->undefined_symbol)
4060 		 (info, h->root.root.root.string, input_bfd,
4061 		  input_section, relocation->r_offset,
4062 		  (info->unresolved_syms_in_objects == RM_GENERATE_ERROR)
4063 		   || ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->root.other))))
4064 	    return bfd_reloc_undefined;
4065 	  symbol = 0;
4066 	}
4067 
4068       target_is_16_bit_code_p = (h->root.other == STO_MIPS16);
4069     }
4070 
4071   /* If this is a 32- or 64-bit call to a 16-bit function with a stub, we
4072      need to redirect the call to the stub, unless we're already *in*
4073      a stub.  */
4074   if (r_type != R_MIPS16_26 && !info->relocatable
4075       && ((h != NULL && h->fn_stub != NULL)
4076 	  || (local_p
4077 	      && elf_tdata (input_bfd)->local_stubs != NULL
4078 	      && elf_tdata (input_bfd)->local_stubs[r_symndx] != NULL))
4079       && !mips16_stub_section_p (input_bfd, input_section))
4080     {
4081       /* This is a 32- or 64-bit call to a 16-bit function.  We should
4082 	 have already noticed that we were going to need the
4083 	 stub.  */
4084       if (local_p)
4085 	sec = elf_tdata (input_bfd)->local_stubs[r_symndx];
4086       else
4087 	{
4088 	  BFD_ASSERT (h->need_fn_stub);
4089 	  sec = h->fn_stub;
4090 	}
4091 
4092       symbol = sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
4093       /* The target is 16-bit, but the stub isn't.  */
4094       target_is_16_bit_code_p = FALSE;
4095     }
4096   /* If this is a 16-bit call to a 32- or 64-bit function with a stub, we
4097      need to redirect the call to the stub.  */
4098   else if (r_type == R_MIPS16_26 && !info->relocatable
4099 	   && ((h != NULL && (h->call_stub != NULL || h->call_fp_stub != NULL))
4100 	       || (local_p
4101 		   && elf_tdata (input_bfd)->local_call_stubs != NULL
4102 		   && elf_tdata (input_bfd)->local_call_stubs[r_symndx] != NULL))
4103 	   && !target_is_16_bit_code_p)
4104     {
4105       if (local_p)
4106 	sec = elf_tdata (input_bfd)->local_call_stubs[r_symndx];
4107       else
4108 	{
4109 	  /* If both call_stub and call_fp_stub are defined, we can figure
4110 	     out which one to use by checking which one appears in the input
4111 	     file.  */
4112 	  if (h->call_stub != NULL && h->call_fp_stub != NULL)
4113 	    {
4114 	      asection *o;
4115 
4116 	      sec = NULL;
4117 	      for (o = input_bfd->sections; o != NULL; o = o->next)
4118 		{
4119 		  if (CALL_FP_STUB_P (bfd_get_section_name (input_bfd, o)))
4120 		    {
4121 		      sec = h->call_fp_stub;
4122 		      break;
4123 		    }
4124 		}
4125 	      if (sec == NULL)
4126 		sec = h->call_stub;
4127 	    }
4128 	  else if (h->call_stub != NULL)
4129 	    sec = h->call_stub;
4130 	  else
4131 	    sec = h->call_fp_stub;
4132   	}
4133 
4134       BFD_ASSERT (sec->size > 0);
4135       symbol = sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
4136     }
4137 
4138   /* Calls from 16-bit code to 32-bit code and vice versa require the
4139      special jalx instruction.  */
4140   *require_jalxp = (!info->relocatable
4141                     && (((r_type == R_MIPS16_26) && !target_is_16_bit_code_p)
4142                         || ((r_type == R_MIPS_26) && target_is_16_bit_code_p)));
4143 
4144   local_p = mips_elf_local_relocation_p (input_bfd, relocation,
4145 					 local_sections, TRUE);
4146 
4147   /* If we haven't already determined the GOT offset, or the GP value,
4148      and we're going to need it, get it now.  */
4149   switch (r_type)
4150     {
4151     case R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE:
4152     case R_MIPS_GOT_OFST:
4153       /* We need to decay to GOT_DISP/addend if the symbol doesn't
4154 	 bind locally.  */
4155       local_p = local_p || _bfd_elf_symbol_refs_local_p (&h->root, info, 1);
4156       if (local_p || r_type == R_MIPS_GOT_OFST)
4157 	break;
4158       /* Fall through.  */
4159 
4160     case R_MIPS_CALL16:
4161     case R_MIPS_GOT16:
4162     case R_MIPS_GOT_DISP:
4163     case R_MIPS_GOT_HI16:
4164     case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
4165     case R_MIPS_GOT_LO16:
4166     case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
4167     case R_MIPS_TLS_GD:
4168     case R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL:
4169     case R_MIPS_TLS_LDM:
4170       /* Find the index into the GOT where this value is located.  */
4171       if (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_LDM)
4172 	{
4173 	  g = mips_elf_local_got_index (abfd, input_bfd, info,
4174 					0, 0, NULL, r_type);
4175 	  if (g == MINUS_ONE)
4176 	    return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
4177 	}
4178       else if (!local_p)
4179 	{
4180 	  /* On VxWorks, CALL relocations should refer to the .got.plt
4181 	     entry, which is initialized to point at the PLT stub.  */
4182 	  if (htab->is_vxworks
4183 	      && (r_type == R_MIPS_CALL_HI16
4184 		  || r_type == R_MIPS_CALL_LO16
4185 		  || r_type == R_MIPS_CALL16))
4186 	    {
4187 	      BFD_ASSERT (addend == 0);
4188 	      BFD_ASSERT (h->root.needs_plt);
4189 	      g = mips_elf_gotplt_index (info, &h->root);
4190 	    }
4191 	  else
4192 	    {
4193 	      /* GOT_PAGE may take a non-zero addend, that is ignored in a
4194 		 GOT_PAGE relocation that decays to GOT_DISP because the
4195 		 symbol turns out to be global.  The addend is then added
4196 		 as GOT_OFST.  */
4197 	      BFD_ASSERT (addend == 0 || r_type == R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE);
4198 	      g = mips_elf_global_got_index (dynobj, input_bfd,
4199 					     &h->root, r_type, info);
4200 	      if (h->tls_type == GOT_NORMAL
4201 		  && (! elf_hash_table(info)->dynamic_sections_created
4202 		      || (info->shared
4203 			  && (info->symbolic || h->root.forced_local)
4204 			  && h->root.def_regular)))
4205 		{
4206 		  /* This is a static link or a -Bsymbolic link.  The
4207 		     symbol is defined locally, or was forced to be local.
4208 		     We must initialize this entry in the GOT.  */
4209 		  asection *sgot = mips_elf_got_section (dynobj, FALSE);
4210 		  MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (dynobj, symbol, sgot->contents + g);
4211 		}
4212 	    }
4213 	}
4214       else if (!htab->is_vxworks
4215 	       && (r_type == R_MIPS_CALL16 || (r_type == R_MIPS_GOT16)))
4216 	/* The calculation below does not involve "g".  */
4217 	break;
4218       else
4219 	{
4220 	  g = mips_elf_local_got_index (abfd, input_bfd, info,
4221 					symbol + addend, r_symndx, h, r_type);
4222 	  if (g == MINUS_ONE)
4223 	    return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
4224 	}
4225 
4226       /* Convert GOT indices to actual offsets.  */
4227       g = mips_elf_got_offset_from_index (dynobj, abfd, input_bfd, g);
4228       break;
4229 
4230     case R_MIPS_HI16:
4231     case R_MIPS_LO16:
4232     case R_MIPS_GPREL16:
4233     case R_MIPS_GPREL32:
4234     case R_MIPS_LITERAL:
4235     case R_MIPS16_HI16:
4236     case R_MIPS16_LO16:
4237     case R_MIPS16_GPREL:
4238       gp0 = _bfd_get_gp_value (input_bfd);
4239       gp = _bfd_get_gp_value (abfd);
4240       if (dynobj)
4241 	gp += mips_elf_adjust_gp (abfd, mips_elf_got_info (dynobj, NULL),
4242 				  input_bfd);
4243       break;
4244 
4245     default:
4246       break;
4247     }
4248 
4249   if (gnu_local_gp_p)
4250     symbol = gp;
4251 
4252   /* Relocations against the VxWorks __GOTT_BASE__ and __GOTT_INDEX__
4253      symbols are resolved by the loader.  Add them to .rela.dyn.  */
4254   if (h != NULL && is_gott_symbol (info, &h->root))
4255     {
4256       Elf_Internal_Rela outrel;
4257       bfd_byte *loc;
4258       asection *s;
4259 
4260       s = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
4261       loc = s->contents + s->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
4262 
4263       outrel.r_offset = (input_section->output_section->vma
4264 			 + input_section->output_offset
4265 			 + relocation->r_offset);
4266       outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->root.dynindx, r_type);
4267       outrel.r_addend = addend;
4268       bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (abfd, &outrel, loc);
4269 
4270       /* If we've written this relocation for a readonly section,
4271 	 we need to set DF_TEXTREL again, so that we do not delete the
4272 	 DT_TEXTREL tag.  */
4273       if (MIPS_ELF_READONLY_SECTION (input_section))
4274 	info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
4275 
4276       *valuep = 0;
4277       return bfd_reloc_ok;
4278     }
4279 
4280   /* Figure out what kind of relocation is being performed.  */
4281   switch (r_type)
4282     {
4283     case R_MIPS_NONE:
4284       return bfd_reloc_continue;
4285 
4286     case R_MIPS_16:
4287       value = symbol + _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 16);
4288       overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
4289       break;
4290 
4291     case R_MIPS_32:
4292     case R_MIPS_REL32:
4293     case R_MIPS_64:
4294       if ((info->shared
4295 	   || (!htab->is_vxworks
4296 	       && htab->root.dynamic_sections_created
4297 	       && h != NULL
4298 	       && h->root.def_dynamic
4299 	       && !h->root.def_regular))
4300 	  && r_symndx != 0
4301 	  && (input_section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
4302 	{
4303 	  /* If we're creating a shared library, or this relocation is
4304 	     against a symbol in a shared library, then we can't know
4305 	     where the symbol will end up.  So, we create a relocation
4306 	     record in the output, and leave the job up to the dynamic
4307 	     linker.
4308 
4309 	     In VxWorks executables, references to external symbols
4310 	     are handled using copy relocs or PLT stubs, so there's
4311 	     no need to add a dynamic relocation here.  */
4312 	  value = addend;
4313 	  if (!mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation (abfd,
4314 						   info,
4315 						   relocation,
4316 						   h,
4317 						   sec,
4318 						   symbol,
4319 						   &value,
4320 						   input_section))
4321 	    return bfd_reloc_undefined;
4322 	}
4323       else
4324 	{
4325 	  if (r_type != R_MIPS_REL32)
4326 	    value = symbol + addend;
4327 	  else
4328 	    value = addend;
4329 	}
4330       value &= howto->dst_mask;
4331       break;
4332 
4333     case R_MIPS_PC32:
4334       value = symbol + addend - p;
4335       value &= howto->dst_mask;
4336       break;
4337 
4338     case R_MIPS16_26:
4339       /* The calculation for R_MIPS16_26 is just the same as for an
4340 	 R_MIPS_26.  It's only the storage of the relocated field into
4341 	 the output file that's different.  That's handled in
4342 	 mips_elf_perform_relocation.  So, we just fall through to the
4343 	 R_MIPS_26 case here.  */
4344     case R_MIPS_26:
4345       if (local_p)
4346 	value = ((addend | ((p + 4) & 0xf0000000)) + symbol) >> 2;
4347       else
4348 	{
4349 	  value = (_bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 28) + symbol) >> 2;
4350 	  if (h->root.root.type != bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
4351 	    overflowed_p = (value >> 26) != ((p + 4) >> 28);
4352 	}
4353       value &= howto->dst_mask;
4354       break;
4355 
4356     case R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL_HI16:
4357       value = (mips_elf_high (addend + symbol - dtprel_base (info))
4358 	       & howto->dst_mask);
4359       break;
4360 
4361     case R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL_LO16:
4362     case R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL32:
4363     case R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL64:
4364       value = (symbol + addend - dtprel_base (info)) & howto->dst_mask;
4365       break;
4366 
4367     case R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL_HI16:
4368       value = (mips_elf_high (addend + symbol - tprel_base (info))
4369 	       & howto->dst_mask);
4370       break;
4371 
4372     case R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL_LO16:
4373       value = (symbol + addend - tprel_base (info)) & howto->dst_mask;
4374       break;
4375 
4376     case R_MIPS_HI16:
4377     case R_MIPS16_HI16:
4378       if (!gp_disp_p)
4379 	{
4380 	  value = mips_elf_high (addend + symbol);
4381 	  value &= howto->dst_mask;
4382 	}
4383       else
4384 	{
4385 	  /* For MIPS16 ABI code we generate this sequence
4386 	        0: li      $v0,%hi(_gp_disp)
4387 	        4: addiupc $v1,%lo(_gp_disp)
4388 	        8: sll     $v0,16
4389 	       12: addu    $v0,$v1
4390 	       14: move    $gp,$v0
4391 	     So the offsets of hi and lo relocs are the same, but the
4392 	     $pc is four higher than $t9 would be, so reduce
4393 	     both reloc addends by 4. */
4394 	  if (r_type == R_MIPS16_HI16)
4395 	    value = mips_elf_high (addend + gp - p - 4);
4396 	  else
4397 	    value = mips_elf_high (addend + gp - p);
4398 	  overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
4399 	}
4400       break;
4401 
4402     case R_MIPS_LO16:
4403     case R_MIPS16_LO16:
4404       if (!gp_disp_p)
4405 	value = (symbol + addend) & howto->dst_mask;
4406       else
4407 	{
4408 	  /* See the comment for R_MIPS16_HI16 above for the reason
4409 	     for this conditional.  */
4410 	  if (r_type == R_MIPS16_LO16)
4411 	    value = addend + gp - p;
4412 	  else
4413 	    value = addend + gp - p + 4;
4414 	  /* The MIPS ABI requires checking the R_MIPS_LO16 relocation
4415 	     for overflow.  But, on, say, IRIX5, relocations against
4416 	     _gp_disp are normally generated from the .cpload
4417 	     pseudo-op.  It generates code that normally looks like
4418 	     this:
4419 
4420 	       lui    $gp,%hi(_gp_disp)
4421 	       addiu  $gp,$gp,%lo(_gp_disp)
4422 	       addu   $gp,$gp,$t9
4423 
4424 	     Here $t9 holds the address of the function being called,
4425 	     as required by the MIPS ELF ABI.  The R_MIPS_LO16
4426 	     relocation can easily overflow in this situation, but the
4427 	     R_MIPS_HI16 relocation will handle the overflow.
4428 	     Therefore, we consider this a bug in the MIPS ABI, and do
4429 	     not check for overflow here.  */
4430 	}
4431       break;
4432 
4433     case R_MIPS_LITERAL:
4434       /* Because we don't merge literal sections, we can handle this
4435 	 just like R_MIPS_GPREL16.  In the long run, we should merge
4436 	 shared literals, and then we will need to additional work
4437 	 here.  */
4438 
4439       /* Fall through.  */
4440 
4441     case R_MIPS16_GPREL:
4442       /* The R_MIPS16_GPREL performs the same calculation as
4443 	 R_MIPS_GPREL16, but stores the relocated bits in a different
4444 	 order.  We don't need to do anything special here; the
4445 	 differences are handled in mips_elf_perform_relocation.  */
4446     case R_MIPS_GPREL16:
4447       /* Only sign-extend the addend if it was extracted from the
4448 	 instruction.  If the addend was separate, leave it alone,
4449 	 otherwise we may lose significant bits.  */
4450       if (howto->partial_inplace)
4451 	addend = _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 16);
4452       value = symbol + addend - gp;
4453       /* If the symbol was local, any earlier relocatable links will
4454 	 have adjusted its addend with the gp offset, so compensate
4455 	 for that now.  Don't do it for symbols forced local in this
4456 	 link, though, since they won't have had the gp offset applied
4457 	 to them before.  */
4458       if (was_local_p)
4459 	value += gp0;
4460       overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
4461       break;
4462 
4463     case R_MIPS_GOT16:
4464     case R_MIPS_CALL16:
4465       /* VxWorks does not have separate local and global semantics for
4466 	 R_MIPS_GOT16; every relocation evaluates to "G".  */
4467       if (!htab->is_vxworks && local_p)
4468 	{
4469 	  bfd_boolean forced;
4470 
4471 	  forced = ! mips_elf_local_relocation_p (input_bfd, relocation,
4472 						  local_sections, FALSE);
4473 	  value = mips_elf_got16_entry (abfd, input_bfd, info,
4474 					symbol + addend, forced);
4475 	  if (value == MINUS_ONE)
4476 	    return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
4477 	  value
4478 	    = mips_elf_got_offset_from_index (dynobj, abfd, input_bfd, value);
4479 	  overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
4480 	  break;
4481 	}
4482 
4483       /* Fall through.  */
4484 
4485     case R_MIPS_TLS_GD:
4486     case R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL:
4487     case R_MIPS_TLS_LDM:
4488     case R_MIPS_GOT_DISP:
4489     got_disp:
4490       value = g;
4491       overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
4492       break;
4493 
4494     case R_MIPS_GPREL32:
4495       value = (addend + symbol + gp0 - gp);
4496       if (!save_addend)
4497 	value &= howto->dst_mask;
4498       break;
4499 
4500     case R_MIPS_PC16:
4501     case R_MIPS_GNU_REL16_S2:
4502       value = symbol + _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 18) - p;
4503       overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 18);
4504       value >>= howto->rightshift;
4505       value &= howto->dst_mask;
4506       break;
4507 
4508     case R_MIPS_GOT_HI16:
4509     case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
4510       /* We're allowed to handle these two relocations identically.
4511 	 The dynamic linker is allowed to handle the CALL relocations
4512 	 differently by creating a lazy evaluation stub.  */
4513       value = g;
4514       value = mips_elf_high (value);
4515       value &= howto->dst_mask;
4516       break;
4517 
4518     case R_MIPS_GOT_LO16:
4519     case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
4520       value = g & howto->dst_mask;
4521       break;
4522 
4523     case R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE:
4524       /* GOT_PAGE relocations that reference non-local symbols decay
4525 	 to GOT_DISP.  The corresponding GOT_OFST relocation decays to
4526 	 0.  */
4527       if (! local_p)
4528 	goto got_disp;
4529       value = mips_elf_got_page (abfd, input_bfd, info, symbol + addend, NULL);
4530       if (value == MINUS_ONE)
4531 	return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
4532       value = mips_elf_got_offset_from_index (dynobj, abfd, input_bfd, value);
4533       overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
4534       break;
4535 
4536     case R_MIPS_GOT_OFST:
4537       if (local_p)
4538 	mips_elf_got_page (abfd, input_bfd, info, symbol + addend, &value);
4539       else
4540 	value = addend;
4541       overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
4542       break;
4543 
4544     case R_MIPS_SUB:
4545       value = symbol - addend;
4546       value &= howto->dst_mask;
4547       break;
4548 
4549     case R_MIPS_HIGHER:
4550       value = mips_elf_higher (addend + symbol);
4551       value &= howto->dst_mask;
4552       break;
4553 
4554     case R_MIPS_HIGHEST:
4555       value = mips_elf_highest (addend + symbol);
4556       value &= howto->dst_mask;
4557       break;
4558 
4559     case R_MIPS_SCN_DISP:
4560       value = symbol + addend - sec->output_offset;
4561       value &= howto->dst_mask;
4562       break;
4563 
4564     case R_MIPS_JALR:
4565       /* This relocation is only a hint.  In some cases, we optimize
4566 	 it into a bal instruction.  But we don't try to optimize
4567 	 branches to the PLT; that will wind up wasting time.  */
4568       if (h != NULL && h->root.plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
4569 	return bfd_reloc_continue;
4570       value = symbol + addend;
4571       break;
4572 
4573     case R_MIPS_PJUMP:
4574     case R_MIPS_GNU_VTINHERIT:
4575     case R_MIPS_GNU_VTENTRY:
4576       /* We don't do anything with these at present.  */
4577       return bfd_reloc_continue;
4578 
4579     default:
4580       /* An unrecognized relocation type.  */
4581       return bfd_reloc_notsupported;
4582     }
4583 
4584   /* Store the VALUE for our caller.  */
4585   *valuep = value;
4586   return overflowed_p ? bfd_reloc_overflow : bfd_reloc_ok;
4587 }
4588 
4589 /* Obtain the field relocated by RELOCATION.  */
4590 
4591 static bfd_vma
mips_elf_obtain_contents(reloc_howto_type * howto,const Elf_Internal_Rela * relocation,bfd * input_bfd,bfd_byte * contents)4592 mips_elf_obtain_contents (reloc_howto_type *howto,
4593 			  const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocation,
4594 			  bfd *input_bfd, bfd_byte *contents)
4595 {
4596   bfd_vma x;
4597   bfd_byte *location = contents + relocation->r_offset;
4598 
4599   /* Obtain the bytes.  */
4600   x = bfd_get ((8 * bfd_get_reloc_size (howto)), input_bfd, location);
4601 
4602   return x;
4603 }
4604 
4605 /* It has been determined that the result of the RELOCATION is the
4606    VALUE.  Use HOWTO to place VALUE into the output file at the
4607    appropriate position.  The SECTION is the section to which the
4608    relocation applies.  If REQUIRE_JALX is TRUE, then the opcode used
4609    for the relocation must be either JAL or JALX, and it is
4610    unconditionally converted to JALX.
4611 
4612    Returns FALSE if anything goes wrong.  */
4613 
4614 static bfd_boolean
mips_elf_perform_relocation(struct bfd_link_info * info,reloc_howto_type * howto,const Elf_Internal_Rela * relocation,bfd_vma value,bfd * input_bfd,asection * input_section,bfd_byte * contents,bfd_boolean require_jalx)4615 mips_elf_perform_relocation (struct bfd_link_info *info,
4616 			     reloc_howto_type *howto,
4617 			     const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocation,
4618 			     bfd_vma value, bfd *input_bfd,
4619 			     asection *input_section, bfd_byte *contents,
4620 			     bfd_boolean require_jalx)
4621 {
4622   bfd_vma x;
4623   bfd_byte *location;
4624   int r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (input_bfd, relocation->r_info);
4625 
4626   /* Figure out where the relocation is occurring.  */
4627   location = contents + relocation->r_offset;
4628 
4629   _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_unshuffle (input_bfd, r_type, FALSE, location);
4630 
4631   /* Obtain the current value.  */
4632   x = mips_elf_obtain_contents (howto, relocation, input_bfd, contents);
4633 
4634   /* Clear the field we are setting.  */
4635   x &= ~howto->dst_mask;
4636 
4637   /* Set the field.  */
4638   x |= (value & howto->dst_mask);
4639 
4640   /* If required, turn JAL into JALX.  */
4641   if (require_jalx)
4642     {
4643       bfd_boolean ok;
4644       bfd_vma opcode = x >> 26;
4645       bfd_vma jalx_opcode;
4646 
4647       /* Check to see if the opcode is already JAL or JALX.  */
4648       if (r_type == R_MIPS16_26)
4649 	{
4650 	  ok = ((opcode == 0x6) || (opcode == 0x7));
4651 	  jalx_opcode = 0x7;
4652 	}
4653       else
4654 	{
4655 	  ok = ((opcode == 0x3) || (opcode == 0x1d));
4656 	  jalx_opcode = 0x1d;
4657 	}
4658 
4659       /* If the opcode is not JAL or JALX, there's a problem.  */
4660       if (!ok)
4661 	{
4662 	  (*_bfd_error_handler)
4663 	    (_("%B: %A+0x%lx: jump to stub routine which is not jal"),
4664 	     input_bfd,
4665 	     input_section,
4666 	     (unsigned long) relocation->r_offset);
4667 	  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
4668 	  return FALSE;
4669 	}
4670 
4671       /* Make this the JALX opcode.  */
4672       x = (x & ~(0x3f << 26)) | (jalx_opcode << 26);
4673     }
4674 
4675   /* On the RM9000, bal is faster than jal, because bal uses branch
4676      prediction hardware.  If we are linking for the RM9000, and we
4677      see jal, and bal fits, use it instead.  Note that this
4678      transformation should be safe for all architectures.  */
4679   if (bfd_get_mach (input_bfd) == bfd_mach_mips9000
4680       && !info->relocatable
4681       && !require_jalx
4682       && ((r_type == R_MIPS_26 && (x >> 26) == 0x3)	    /* jal addr */
4683 	  || (r_type == R_MIPS_JALR && x == 0x0320f809)))   /* jalr t9 */
4684     {
4685       bfd_vma addr;
4686       bfd_vma dest;
4687       bfd_signed_vma off;
4688 
4689       addr = (input_section->output_section->vma
4690 	      + input_section->output_offset
4691 	      + relocation->r_offset
4692 	      + 4);
4693       if (r_type == R_MIPS_26)
4694 	dest = (value << 2) | ((addr >> 28) << 28);
4695       else
4696 	dest = value;
4697       off = dest - addr;
4698       if (off <= 0x1ffff && off >= -0x20000)
4699 	x = 0x04110000 | (((bfd_vma) off >> 2) & 0xffff);   /* bal addr */
4700     }
4701 
4702   /* Put the value into the output.  */
4703   bfd_put (8 * bfd_get_reloc_size (howto), input_bfd, x, location);
4704 
4705   _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_shuffle(input_bfd, r_type, !info->relocatable,
4706 				location);
4707 
4708   return TRUE;
4709 }
4710 
4711 /* Returns TRUE if SECTION is a MIPS16 stub section.  */
4712 
4713 static bfd_boolean
mips16_stub_section_p(bfd * abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,asection * section)4714 mips16_stub_section_p (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, asection *section)
4715 {
4716   const char *name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, section);
4717 
4718   return FN_STUB_P (name) || CALL_STUB_P (name) || CALL_FP_STUB_P (name);
4719 }
4720 
4721 /* Add room for N relocations to the .rel(a).dyn section in ABFD.  */
4722 
4723 static void
mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations(bfd * abfd,struct bfd_link_info * info,unsigned int n)4724 mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
4725 				       unsigned int n)
4726 {
4727   asection *s;
4728   struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4729 
4730   htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
4731   s = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
4732   BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
4733 
4734   if (htab->is_vxworks)
4735     s->size += n * MIPS_ELF_RELA_SIZE (abfd);
4736   else
4737     {
4738       if (s->size == 0)
4739 	{
4740 	  /* Make room for a null element.  */
4741 	  s->size += MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (abfd);
4742 	  ++s->reloc_count;
4743 	}
4744       s->size += n * MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (abfd);
4745     }
4746 }
4747 
4748 /* Create a rel.dyn relocation for the dynamic linker to resolve.  REL
4749    is the original relocation, which is now being transformed into a
4750    dynamic relocation.  The ADDENDP is adjusted if necessary; the
4751    caller should store the result in place of the original addend.  */
4752 
4753 static bfd_boolean
mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation(bfd * output_bfd,struct bfd_link_info * info,const Elf_Internal_Rela * rel,struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry * h,asection * sec,bfd_vma symbol,bfd_vma * addendp,asection * input_section)4754 mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation (bfd *output_bfd,
4755 				    struct bfd_link_info *info,
4756 				    const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
4757 				    struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h,
4758 				    asection *sec, bfd_vma symbol,
4759 				    bfd_vma *addendp, asection *input_section)
4760 {
4761   Elf_Internal_Rela outrel[3];
4762   asection *sreloc;
4763   bfd *dynobj;
4764   int r_type;
4765   long indx;
4766   bfd_boolean defined_p;
4767   struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4768 
4769   htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
4770   r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (output_bfd, rel->r_info);
4771   dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
4772   sreloc = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
4773   BFD_ASSERT (sreloc != NULL);
4774   BFD_ASSERT (sreloc->contents != NULL);
4775   BFD_ASSERT (sreloc->reloc_count * MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (output_bfd)
4776 	      < sreloc->size);
4777 
4778   outrel[0].r_offset =
4779     _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info, input_section, rel[0].r_offset);
4780   if (ABI_64_P (output_bfd))
4781     {
4782       outrel[1].r_offset =
4783 	_bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info, input_section, rel[1].r_offset);
4784       outrel[2].r_offset =
4785 	_bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info, input_section, rel[2].r_offset);
4786     }
4787 
4788   if (outrel[0].r_offset == MINUS_ONE)
4789     /* The relocation field has been deleted.  */
4790     return TRUE;
4791 
4792   if (outrel[0].r_offset == MINUS_TWO)
4793     {
4794       /* The relocation field has been converted into a relative value of
4795 	 some sort.  Functions like _bfd_elf_write_section_eh_frame expect
4796 	 the field to be fully relocated, so add in the symbol's value.  */
4797       *addendp += symbol;
4798       return TRUE;
4799     }
4800 
4801   /* We must now calculate the dynamic symbol table index to use
4802      in the relocation.  */
4803   if (h != NULL
4804       && (!h->root.def_regular
4805 	  || (info->shared && !info->symbolic && !h->root.forced_local)))
4806     {
4807       indx = h->root.dynindx;
4808       if (SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd))
4809 	defined_p = h->root.def_regular;
4810       else
4811 	/* ??? glibc's ld.so just adds the final GOT entry to the
4812 	   relocation field.  It therefore treats relocs against
4813 	   defined symbols in the same way as relocs against
4814 	   undefined symbols.  */
4815 	defined_p = FALSE;
4816     }
4817   else
4818     {
4819       if (sec != NULL && bfd_is_abs_section (sec))
4820 	indx = 0;
4821       else if (sec == NULL || sec->owner == NULL)
4822 	{
4823 	  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
4824 	  return FALSE;
4825 	}
4826       else
4827 	{
4828 	  indx = elf_section_data (sec->output_section)->dynindx;
4829 	  if (indx == 0)
4830 	    {
4831 	      asection *osec = htab->root.text_index_section;
4832 	      indx = elf_section_data (osec)->dynindx;
4833 	    }
4834 	  if (indx == 0)
4835 	    abort ();
4836 	}
4837 
4838       /* Instead of generating a relocation using the section
4839 	 symbol, we may as well make it a fully relative
4840 	 relocation.  We want to avoid generating relocations to
4841 	 local symbols because we used to generate them
4842 	 incorrectly, without adding the original symbol value,
4843 	 which is mandated by the ABI for section symbols.  In
4844 	 order to give dynamic loaders and applications time to
4845 	 phase out the incorrect use, we refrain from emitting
4846 	 section-relative relocations.  It's not like they're
4847 	 useful, after all.  This should be a bit more efficient
4848 	 as well.  */
4849       /* ??? Although this behavior is compatible with glibc's ld.so,
4850 	 the ABI says that relocations against STN_UNDEF should have
4851 	 a symbol value of 0.  Irix rld honors this, so relocations
4852 	 against STN_UNDEF have no effect.  */
4853       if (!SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd))
4854 	indx = 0;
4855       defined_p = TRUE;
4856     }
4857 
4858   /* If the relocation was previously an absolute relocation and
4859      this symbol will not be referred to by the relocation, we must
4860      adjust it by the value we give it in the dynamic symbol table.
4861      Otherwise leave the job up to the dynamic linker.  */
4862   if (defined_p && r_type != R_MIPS_REL32)
4863     *addendp += symbol;
4864 
4865   if (htab->is_vxworks)
4866     /* VxWorks uses non-relative relocations for this.  */
4867     outrel[0].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_MIPS_32);
4868   else
4869     /* The relocation is always an REL32 relocation because we don't
4870        know where the shared library will wind up at load-time.  */
4871     outrel[0].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, (unsigned long) indx,
4872 				   R_MIPS_REL32);
4873 
4874   /* For strict adherence to the ABI specification, we should
4875      generate a R_MIPS_64 relocation record by itself before the
4876      _REL32/_64 record as well, such that the addend is read in as
4877      a 64-bit value (REL32 is a 32-bit relocation, after all).
4878      However, since none of the existing ELF64 MIPS dynamic
4879      loaders seems to care, we don't waste space with these
4880      artificial relocations.  If this turns out to not be true,
4881      mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocation() should be tweaked so
4882      as to make room for a pair of dynamic relocations per
4883      invocation if ABI_64_P, and here we should generate an
4884      additional relocation record with R_MIPS_64 by itself for a
4885      NULL symbol before this relocation record.  */
4886   outrel[1].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, 0,
4887 				 ABI_64_P (output_bfd)
4888 				 ? R_MIPS_64
4889 				 : R_MIPS_NONE);
4890   outrel[2].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, 0, R_MIPS_NONE);
4891 
4892   /* Adjust the output offset of the relocation to reference the
4893      correct location in the output file.  */
4894   outrel[0].r_offset += (input_section->output_section->vma
4895 			 + input_section->output_offset);
4896   outrel[1].r_offset += (input_section->output_section->vma
4897 			 + input_section->output_offset);
4898   outrel[2].r_offset += (input_section->output_section->vma
4899 			 + input_section->output_offset);
4900 
4901   /* Put the relocation back out.  We have to use the special
4902      relocation outputter in the 64-bit case since the 64-bit
4903      relocation format is non-standard.  */
4904   if (ABI_64_P (output_bfd))
4905     {
4906       (*get_elf_backend_data (output_bfd)->s->swap_reloc_out)
4907 	(output_bfd, &outrel[0],
4908 	 (sreloc->contents
4909 	  + sreloc->reloc_count * sizeof (Elf64_Mips_External_Rel)));
4910     }
4911   else if (htab->is_vxworks)
4912     {
4913       /* VxWorks uses RELA rather than REL dynamic relocations.  */
4914       outrel[0].r_addend = *addendp;
4915       bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out
4916 	(output_bfd, &outrel[0],
4917 	 (sreloc->contents
4918 	  + sreloc->reloc_count * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela)));
4919     }
4920   else
4921     bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out
4922       (output_bfd, &outrel[0],
4923        (sreloc->contents + sreloc->reloc_count * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rel)));
4924 
4925   /* We've now added another relocation.  */
4926   ++sreloc->reloc_count;
4927 
4928   /* Make sure the output section is writable.  The dynamic linker
4929      will be writing to it.  */
4930   elf_section_data (input_section->output_section)->this_hdr.sh_flags
4931     |= SHF_WRITE;
4932 
4933   /* On IRIX5, make an entry of compact relocation info.  */
4934   if (IRIX_COMPAT (output_bfd) == ict_irix5)
4935     {
4936       asection *scpt = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".compact_rel");
4937       bfd_byte *cr;
4938 
4939       if (scpt)
4940 	{
4941 	  Elf32_crinfo cptrel;
4942 
4943 	  mips_elf_set_cr_format (cptrel, CRF_MIPS_LONG);
4944 	  cptrel.vaddr = (rel->r_offset
4945 			  + input_section->output_section->vma
4946 			  + input_section->output_offset);
4947 	  if (r_type == R_MIPS_REL32)
4948 	    mips_elf_set_cr_type (cptrel, CRT_MIPS_REL32);
4949 	  else
4950 	    mips_elf_set_cr_type (cptrel, CRT_MIPS_WORD);
4951 	  mips_elf_set_cr_dist2to (cptrel, 0);
4952 	  cptrel.konst = *addendp;
4953 
4954 	  cr = (scpt->contents
4955 		+ sizeof (Elf32_External_compact_rel));
4956 	  mips_elf_set_cr_relvaddr (cptrel, 0);
4957 	  bfd_elf32_swap_crinfo_out (output_bfd, &cptrel,
4958 				     ((Elf32_External_crinfo *) cr
4959 				      + scpt->reloc_count));
4960 	  ++scpt->reloc_count;
4961 	}
4962     }
4963 
4964   /* If we've written this relocation for a readonly section,
4965      we need to set DF_TEXTREL again, so that we do not delete the
4966      DT_TEXTREL tag.  */
4967   if (MIPS_ELF_READONLY_SECTION (input_section))
4968     info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
4969 
4970   return TRUE;
4971 }
4972 
4973 /* Return the MACH for a MIPS e_flags value.  */
4974 
4975 unsigned long
_bfd_elf_mips_mach(flagword flags)4976 _bfd_elf_mips_mach (flagword flags)
4977 {
4978   switch (flags & EF_MIPS_MACH)
4979     {
4980     case E_MIPS_MACH_3900:
4981       return bfd_mach_mips3900;
4982 
4983     case E_MIPS_MACH_4010:
4984       return bfd_mach_mips4010;
4985 
4986     case E_MIPS_MACH_4100:
4987       return bfd_mach_mips4100;
4988 
4989     case E_MIPS_MACH_4111:
4990       return bfd_mach_mips4111;
4991 
4992     case E_MIPS_MACH_4120:
4993       return bfd_mach_mips4120;
4994 
4995     case E_MIPS_MACH_4650:
4996       return bfd_mach_mips4650;
4997 
4998     case E_MIPS_MACH_5400:
4999       return bfd_mach_mips5400;
5000 
5001     case E_MIPS_MACH_5500:
5002       return bfd_mach_mips5500;
5003 
5004     case E_MIPS_MACH_9000:
5005       return bfd_mach_mips9000;
5006 
5007     case E_MIPS_MACH_OCTEON:
5008       return bfd_mach_mips_octeon;
5009 
5010     case E_MIPS_MACH_SB1:
5011       return bfd_mach_mips_sb1;
5012 
5013     default:
5014       switch (flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH)
5015 	{
5016 	default:
5017 	case E_MIPS_ARCH_1:
5018 	  return bfd_mach_mips3000;
5019 
5020 	case E_MIPS_ARCH_2:
5021 	  return bfd_mach_mips6000;
5022 
5023 	case E_MIPS_ARCH_3:
5024 	  return bfd_mach_mips4000;
5025 
5026 	case E_MIPS_ARCH_4:
5027 	  return bfd_mach_mips8000;
5028 
5029 	case E_MIPS_ARCH_5:
5030 	  return bfd_mach_mips5;
5031 
5032 	case E_MIPS_ARCH_32:
5033 	  return bfd_mach_mipsisa32;
5034 
5035 	case E_MIPS_ARCH_64:
5036 	  return bfd_mach_mipsisa64;
5037 
5038 	case E_MIPS_ARCH_32R2:
5039 	  return bfd_mach_mipsisa32r2;
5040 
5041 	case E_MIPS_ARCH_64R2:
5042 	  return bfd_mach_mipsisa64r2;
5043 	}
5044     }
5045 
5046   return 0;
5047 }
5048 
5049 /* Return printable name for ABI.  */
5050 
5051 static INLINE char *
elf_mips_abi_name(bfd * abfd)5052 elf_mips_abi_name (bfd *abfd)
5053 {
5054   flagword flags;
5055 
5056   flags = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags;
5057   switch (flags & EF_MIPS_ABI)
5058     {
5059     case 0:
5060       if (ABI_N32_P (abfd))
5061 	return "N32";
5062       else if (ABI_64_P (abfd))
5063 	return "64";
5064       else
5065 	return "none";
5066     case E_MIPS_ABI_O32:
5067       return "O32";
5068     case E_MIPS_ABI_O64:
5069       return "O64";
5070     case E_MIPS_ABI_EABI32:
5071       return "EABI32";
5072     case E_MIPS_ABI_EABI64:
5073       return "EABI64";
5074     default:
5075       return "unknown abi";
5076     }
5077 }
5078 
5079 /* MIPS ELF uses two common sections.  One is the usual one, and the
5080    other is for small objects.  All the small objects are kept
5081    together, and then referenced via the gp pointer, which yields
5082    faster assembler code.  This is what we use for the small common
5083    section.  This approach is copied from ecoff.c.  */
5084 static asection mips_elf_scom_section;
5085 static asymbol mips_elf_scom_symbol;
5086 static asymbol *mips_elf_scom_symbol_ptr;
5087 
5088 /* MIPS ELF also uses an acommon section, which represents an
5089    allocated common symbol which may be overridden by a
5090    definition in a shared library.  */
5091 static asection mips_elf_acom_section;
5092 static asymbol mips_elf_acom_symbol;
5093 static asymbol *mips_elf_acom_symbol_ptr;
5094 
5095 /* Handle the special MIPS section numbers that a symbol may use.
5096    This is used for both the 32-bit and the 64-bit ABI.  */
5097 
5098 void
_bfd_mips_elf_symbol_processing(bfd * abfd,asymbol * asym)5099 _bfd_mips_elf_symbol_processing (bfd *abfd, asymbol *asym)
5100 {
5101   elf_symbol_type *elfsym;
5102 
5103   elfsym = (elf_symbol_type *) asym;
5104   switch (elfsym->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx)
5105     {
5106     case SHN_MIPS_ACOMMON:
5107       /* This section is used in a dynamically linked executable file.
5108 	 It is an allocated common section.  The dynamic linker can
5109 	 either resolve these symbols to something in a shared
5110 	 library, or it can just leave them here.  For our purposes,
5111 	 we can consider these symbols to be in a new section.  */
5112       if (mips_elf_acom_section.name == NULL)
5113 	{
5114 	  /* Initialize the acommon section.  */
5115 	  mips_elf_acom_section.name = ".acommon";
5116 	  mips_elf_acom_section.flags = SEC_ALLOC;
5117 	  mips_elf_acom_section.output_section = &mips_elf_acom_section;
5118 	  mips_elf_acom_section.symbol = &mips_elf_acom_symbol;
5119 	  mips_elf_acom_section.symbol_ptr_ptr = &mips_elf_acom_symbol_ptr;
5120 	  mips_elf_acom_symbol.name = ".acommon";
5121 	  mips_elf_acom_symbol.flags = BSF_SECTION_SYM;
5122 	  mips_elf_acom_symbol.section = &mips_elf_acom_section;
5123 	  mips_elf_acom_symbol_ptr = &mips_elf_acom_symbol;
5124 	}
5125       asym->section = &mips_elf_acom_section;
5126       break;
5127 
5128     case SHN_COMMON:
5129       /* Common symbols less than the GP size are automatically
5130 	 treated as SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON symbols on IRIX5.  */
5131       if (asym->value > elf_gp_size (abfd)
5132 	  || ELF_ST_TYPE (elfsym->internal_elf_sym.st_info) == STT_TLS
5133 	  || IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix6)
5134 	break;
5135       /* Fall through.  */
5136     case SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON:
5137       if (mips_elf_scom_section.name == NULL)
5138 	{
5139 	  /* Initialize the small common section.  */
5140 	  mips_elf_scom_section.name = ".scommon";
5141 	  mips_elf_scom_section.flags = SEC_IS_COMMON;
5142 	  mips_elf_scom_section.output_section = &mips_elf_scom_section;
5143 	  mips_elf_scom_section.symbol = &mips_elf_scom_symbol;
5144 	  mips_elf_scom_section.symbol_ptr_ptr = &mips_elf_scom_symbol_ptr;
5145 	  mips_elf_scom_symbol.name = ".scommon";
5146 	  mips_elf_scom_symbol.flags = BSF_SECTION_SYM;
5147 	  mips_elf_scom_symbol.section = &mips_elf_scom_section;
5148 	  mips_elf_scom_symbol_ptr = &mips_elf_scom_symbol;
5149 	}
5150       asym->section = &mips_elf_scom_section;
5151       asym->value = elfsym->internal_elf_sym.st_size;
5152       break;
5153 
5154     case SHN_MIPS_SUNDEFINED:
5155       asym->section = bfd_und_section_ptr;
5156       break;
5157 
5158     case SHN_MIPS_TEXT:
5159       {
5160 	asection *section = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".text");
5161 
5162 	BFD_ASSERT (SGI_COMPAT (abfd));
5163 	if (section != NULL)
5164 	  {
5165 	    asym->section = section;
5166 	    /* MIPS_TEXT is a bit special, the address is not an offset
5167 	       to the base of the .text section.  So substract the section
5168 	       base address to make it an offset.  */
5169 	    asym->value -= section->vma;
5170 	  }
5171       }
5172       break;
5173 
5174     case SHN_MIPS_DATA:
5175       {
5176 	asection *section = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".data");
5177 
5178 	BFD_ASSERT (SGI_COMPAT (abfd));
5179 	if (section != NULL)
5180 	  {
5181 	    asym->section = section;
5182 	    /* MIPS_DATA is a bit special, the address is not an offset
5183 	       to the base of the .data section.  So substract the section
5184 	       base address to make it an offset.  */
5185 	    asym->value -= section->vma;
5186 	  }
5187       }
5188       break;
5189     }
5190 }
5191 
5192 /* Implement elf_backend_eh_frame_address_size.  This differs from
5193    the default in the way it handles EABI64.
5194 
5195    EABI64 was originally specified as an LP64 ABI, and that is what
5196    -mabi=eabi normally gives on a 64-bit target.  However, gcc has
5197    historically accepted the combination of -mabi=eabi and -mlong32,
5198    and this ILP32 variation has become semi-official over time.
5199    Both forms use elf32 and have pointer-sized FDE addresses.
5200 
5201    If an EABI object was generated by GCC 4.0 or above, it will have
5202    an empty .gcc_compiled_longXX section, where XX is the size of longs
5203    in bits.  Unfortunately, ILP32 objects generated by earlier compilers
5204    have no special marking to distinguish them from LP64 objects.
5205 
5206    We don't want users of the official LP64 ABI to be punished for the
5207    existence of the ILP32 variant, but at the same time, we don't want
5208    to mistakenly interpret pre-4.0 ILP32 objects as being LP64 objects.
5209    We therefore take the following approach:
5210 
5211       - If ABFD contains a .gcc_compiled_longXX section, use it to
5212         determine the pointer size.
5213 
5214       - Otherwise check the type of the first relocation.  Assume that
5215         the LP64 ABI is being used if the relocation is of type R_MIPS_64.
5216 
5217       - Otherwise punt.
5218 
5219    The second check is enough to detect LP64 objects generated by pre-4.0
5220    compilers because, in the kind of output generated by those compilers,
5221    the first relocation will be associated with either a CIE personality
5222    routine or an FDE start address.  Furthermore, the compilers never
5223    used a special (non-pointer) encoding for this ABI.
5224 
5225    Checking the relocation type should also be safe because there is no
5226    reason to use R_MIPS_64 in an ILP32 object.  Pre-4.0 compilers never
5227    did so.  */
5228 
5229 unsigned int
_bfd_mips_elf_eh_frame_address_size(bfd * abfd,asection * sec)5230 _bfd_mips_elf_eh_frame_address_size (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
5231 {
5232   if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS] == ELFCLASS64)
5233     return 8;
5234   if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_EABI64)
5235     {
5236       bfd_boolean long32_p, long64_p;
5237 
5238       long32_p = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".gcc_compiled_long32") != 0;
5239       long64_p = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".gcc_compiled_long64") != 0;
5240       if (long32_p && long64_p)
5241 	return 0;
5242       if (long32_p)
5243 	return 4;
5244       if (long64_p)
5245 	return 8;
5246 
5247       if (sec->reloc_count > 0
5248 	  && elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != NULL
5249 	  && (ELF32_R_TYPE (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs[0].r_info)
5250 	      == R_MIPS_64))
5251 	return 8;
5252 
5253       return 0;
5254     }
5255   return 4;
5256 }
5257 
5258 /* There appears to be a bug in the MIPSpro linker that causes GOT_DISP
5259    relocations against two unnamed section symbols to resolve to the
5260    same address.  For example, if we have code like:
5261 
5262 	lw	$4,%got_disp(.data)($gp)
5263 	lw	$25,%got_disp(.text)($gp)
5264 	jalr	$25
5265 
5266    then the linker will resolve both relocations to .data and the program
5267    will jump there rather than to .text.
5268 
5269    We can work around this problem by giving names to local section symbols.
5270    This is also what the MIPSpro tools do.  */
5271 
5272 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_name_local_section_symbols(bfd * abfd)5273 _bfd_mips_elf_name_local_section_symbols (bfd *abfd)
5274 {
5275   return SGI_COMPAT (abfd);
5276 }
5277 
5278 /* Work over a section just before writing it out.  This routine is
5279    used by both the 32-bit and the 64-bit ABI.  FIXME: We recognize
5280    sections that need the SHF_MIPS_GPREL flag by name; there has to be
5281    a better way.  */
5282 
5283 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_section_processing(bfd * abfd,Elf_Internal_Shdr * hdr)5284 _bfd_mips_elf_section_processing (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr)
5285 {
5286   if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_MIPS_REGINFO
5287       && hdr->sh_size > 0)
5288     {
5289       bfd_byte buf[4];
5290 
5291       BFD_ASSERT (hdr->sh_size == sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo));
5292       BFD_ASSERT (hdr->contents == NULL);
5293 
5294       if (bfd_seek (abfd,
5295 		    hdr->sh_offset + sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo) - 4,
5296 		    SEEK_SET) != 0)
5297 	return FALSE;
5298       H_PUT_32 (abfd, elf_gp (abfd), buf);
5299       if (bfd_bwrite (buf, 4, abfd) != 4)
5300 	return FALSE;
5301     }
5302 
5303   if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS
5304       && hdr->bfd_section != NULL
5305       && mips_elf_section_data (hdr->bfd_section) != NULL
5306       && mips_elf_section_data (hdr->bfd_section)->u.tdata != NULL)
5307     {
5308       bfd_byte *contents, *l, *lend;
5309 
5310       /* We stored the section contents in the tdata field in the
5311 	 set_section_contents routine.  We save the section contents
5312 	 so that we don't have to read them again.
5313 	 At this point we know that elf_gp is set, so we can look
5314 	 through the section contents to see if there is an
5315 	 ODK_REGINFO structure.  */
5316 
5317       contents = mips_elf_section_data (hdr->bfd_section)->u.tdata;
5318       l = contents;
5319       lend = contents + hdr->sh_size;
5320       while (l + sizeof (Elf_External_Options) <= lend)
5321 	{
5322 	  Elf_Internal_Options intopt;
5323 
5324 	  bfd_mips_elf_swap_options_in (abfd, (Elf_External_Options *) l,
5325 					&intopt);
5326 	  if (intopt.size < sizeof (Elf_External_Options))
5327 	    {
5328 	      (*_bfd_error_handler)
5329 		(_("%B: Warning: bad `%s' option size %u smaller than its header"),
5330 		abfd, MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME (abfd), intopt.size);
5331 	      break;
5332 	    }
5333 	  if (ABI_64_P (abfd) && intopt.kind == ODK_REGINFO)
5334 	    {
5335 	      bfd_byte buf[8];
5336 
5337 	      if (bfd_seek (abfd,
5338 			    (hdr->sh_offset
5339 			     + (l - contents)
5340 			     + sizeof (Elf_External_Options)
5341 			     + (sizeof (Elf64_External_RegInfo) - 8)),
5342 			     SEEK_SET) != 0)
5343 		return FALSE;
5344 	      H_PUT_64 (abfd, elf_gp (abfd), buf);
5345 	      if (bfd_bwrite (buf, 8, abfd) != 8)
5346 		return FALSE;
5347 	    }
5348 	  else if (intopt.kind == ODK_REGINFO)
5349 	    {
5350 	      bfd_byte buf[4];
5351 
5352 	      if (bfd_seek (abfd,
5353 			    (hdr->sh_offset
5354 			     + (l - contents)
5355 			     + sizeof (Elf_External_Options)
5356 			     + (sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo) - 4)),
5357 			    SEEK_SET) != 0)
5358 		return FALSE;
5359 	      H_PUT_32 (abfd, elf_gp (abfd), buf);
5360 	      if (bfd_bwrite (buf, 4, abfd) != 4)
5361 		return FALSE;
5362 	    }
5363 	  l += intopt.size;
5364 	}
5365     }
5366 
5367   if (hdr->bfd_section != NULL)
5368     {
5369       const char *name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, hdr->bfd_section);
5370 
5371       if (strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
5372 	  || strcmp (name, ".lit8") == 0
5373 	  || strcmp (name, ".lit4") == 0)
5374 	{
5375 	  hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_ALLOC | SHF_WRITE | SHF_MIPS_GPREL;
5376 	  hdr->sh_type = SHT_PROGBITS;
5377 	}
5378       else if (strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0)
5379 	{
5380 	  hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_ALLOC | SHF_WRITE | SHF_MIPS_GPREL;
5381 	  hdr->sh_type = SHT_NOBITS;
5382 	}
5383       else if (strcmp (name, ".srdata") == 0)
5384 	{
5385 	  hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_ALLOC | SHF_MIPS_GPREL;
5386 	  hdr->sh_type = SHT_PROGBITS;
5387 	}
5388       else if (strcmp (name, ".compact_rel") == 0)
5389 	{
5390 	  hdr->sh_flags = 0;
5391 	  hdr->sh_type = SHT_PROGBITS;
5392 	}
5393       else if (strcmp (name, ".rtproc") == 0)
5394 	{
5395 	  if (hdr->sh_addralign != 0 && hdr->sh_entsize == 0)
5396 	    {
5397 	      unsigned int adjust;
5398 
5399 	      adjust = hdr->sh_size % hdr->sh_addralign;
5400 	      if (adjust != 0)
5401 		hdr->sh_size += hdr->sh_addralign - adjust;
5402 	    }
5403 	}
5404     }
5405 
5406   return TRUE;
5407 }
5408 
5409 /* Handle a MIPS specific section when reading an object file.  This
5410    is called when elfcode.h finds a section with an unknown type.
5411    This routine supports both the 32-bit and 64-bit ELF ABI.
5412 
5413    FIXME: We need to handle the SHF_MIPS_GPREL flag, but I'm not sure
5414    how to.  */
5415 
5416 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_section_from_shdr(bfd * abfd,Elf_Internal_Shdr * hdr,const char * name,int shindex)5417 _bfd_mips_elf_section_from_shdr (bfd *abfd,
5418 				 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr,
5419 				 const char *name,
5420 				 int shindex)
5421 {
5422   flagword flags = 0;
5423 
5424   /* There ought to be a place to keep ELF backend specific flags, but
5425      at the moment there isn't one.  We just keep track of the
5426      sections by their name, instead.  Fortunately, the ABI gives
5427      suggested names for all the MIPS specific sections, so we will
5428      probably get away with this.  */
5429   switch (hdr->sh_type)
5430     {
5431     case SHT_MIPS_LIBLIST:
5432       if (strcmp (name, ".liblist") != 0)
5433 	return FALSE;
5434       break;
5435     case SHT_MIPS_MSYM:
5436       if (strcmp (name, ".msym") != 0)
5437 	return FALSE;
5438       break;
5439     case SHT_MIPS_CONFLICT:
5440       if (strcmp (name, ".conflict") != 0)
5441 	return FALSE;
5442       break;
5443     case SHT_MIPS_GPTAB:
5444       if (! CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".gptab."))
5445 	return FALSE;
5446       break;
5447     case SHT_MIPS_UCODE:
5448       if (strcmp (name, ".ucode") != 0)
5449 	return FALSE;
5450       break;
5451     case SHT_MIPS_DEBUG:
5452       if (strcmp (name, ".mdebug") != 0)
5453 	return FALSE;
5454       flags = SEC_DEBUGGING;
5455       break;
5456     case SHT_MIPS_REGINFO:
5457       if (strcmp (name, ".reginfo") != 0
5458 	  || hdr->sh_size != sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo))
5459 	return FALSE;
5460       flags = (SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES_SAME_SIZE);
5461       break;
5462     case SHT_MIPS_IFACE:
5463       if (strcmp (name, ".MIPS.interfaces") != 0)
5464 	return FALSE;
5465       break;
5466     case SHT_MIPS_CONTENT:
5467       if (! CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.content"))
5468 	return FALSE;
5469       break;
5470     case SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS:
5471       if (!MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME_P (name))
5472 	return FALSE;
5473       break;
5474     case SHT_MIPS_DWARF:
5475       if (! CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".debug_"))
5476 	return FALSE;
5477       break;
5478     case SHT_MIPS_SYMBOL_LIB:
5479       if (strcmp (name, ".MIPS.symlib") != 0)
5480 	return FALSE;
5481       break;
5482     case SHT_MIPS_EVENTS:
5483       if (! CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.events")
5484 	  && ! CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.post_rel"))
5485 	return FALSE;
5486       break;
5487     default:
5488       break;
5489     }
5490 
5491   if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
5492     return FALSE;
5493 
5494   if (flags)
5495     {
5496       if (! bfd_set_section_flags (abfd, hdr->bfd_section,
5497 				   (bfd_get_section_flags (abfd,
5498 							   hdr->bfd_section)
5499 				    | flags)))
5500 	return FALSE;
5501     }
5502 
5503   /* FIXME: We should record sh_info for a .gptab section.  */
5504 
5505   /* For a .reginfo section, set the gp value in the tdata information
5506      from the contents of this section.  We need the gp value while
5507      processing relocs, so we just get it now.  The .reginfo section
5508      is not used in the 64-bit MIPS ELF ABI.  */
5509   if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_MIPS_REGINFO)
5510     {
5511       Elf32_External_RegInfo ext;
5512       Elf32_RegInfo s;
5513 
5514       if (! bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, hdr->bfd_section,
5515 				      &ext, 0, sizeof ext))
5516 	return FALSE;
5517       bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_in (abfd, &ext, &s);
5518       elf_gp (abfd) = s.ri_gp_value;
5519     }
5520 
5521   /* For a SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS section, look for a ODK_REGINFO entry, and
5522      set the gp value based on what we find.  We may see both
5523      SHT_MIPS_REGINFO and SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS/ODK_REGINFO; in that case,
5524      they should agree.  */
5525   if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS)
5526     {
5527       bfd_byte *contents, *l, *lend;
5528 
5529       contents = bfd_malloc (hdr->sh_size);
5530       if (contents == NULL)
5531 	return FALSE;
5532       if (! bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, hdr->bfd_section, contents,
5533 				      0, hdr->sh_size))
5534 	{
5535 	  free (contents);
5536 	  return FALSE;
5537 	}
5538       l = contents;
5539       lend = contents + hdr->sh_size;
5540       while (l + sizeof (Elf_External_Options) <= lend)
5541 	{
5542 	  Elf_Internal_Options intopt;
5543 
5544 	  bfd_mips_elf_swap_options_in (abfd, (Elf_External_Options *) l,
5545 					&intopt);
5546 	  if (intopt.size < sizeof (Elf_External_Options))
5547 	    {
5548 	      (*_bfd_error_handler)
5549 		(_("%B: Warning: bad `%s' option size %u smaller than its header"),
5550 		abfd, MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME (abfd), intopt.size);
5551 	      break;
5552 	    }
5553 	  if (ABI_64_P (abfd) && intopt.kind == ODK_REGINFO)
5554 	    {
5555 	      Elf64_Internal_RegInfo intreg;
5556 
5557 	      bfd_mips_elf64_swap_reginfo_in
5558 		(abfd,
5559 		 ((Elf64_External_RegInfo *)
5560 		  (l + sizeof (Elf_External_Options))),
5561 		 &intreg);
5562 	      elf_gp (abfd) = intreg.ri_gp_value;
5563 	    }
5564 	  else if (intopt.kind == ODK_REGINFO)
5565 	    {
5566 	      Elf32_RegInfo intreg;
5567 
5568 	      bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_in
5569 		(abfd,
5570 		 ((Elf32_External_RegInfo *)
5571 		  (l + sizeof (Elf_External_Options))),
5572 		 &intreg);
5573 	      elf_gp (abfd) = intreg.ri_gp_value;
5574 	    }
5575 	  l += intopt.size;
5576 	}
5577       free (contents);
5578     }
5579 
5580   return TRUE;
5581 }
5582 
5583 /* Set the correct type for a MIPS ELF section.  We do this by the
5584    section name, which is a hack, but ought to work.  This routine is
5585    used by both the 32-bit and the 64-bit ABI.  */
5586 
5587 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_fake_sections(bfd * abfd,Elf_Internal_Shdr * hdr,asection * sec)5588 _bfd_mips_elf_fake_sections (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr, asection *sec)
5589 {
5590   const char *name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, sec);
5591 
5592   if (strcmp (name, ".liblist") == 0)
5593     {
5594       hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_LIBLIST;
5595       hdr->sh_info = sec->size / sizeof (Elf32_Lib);
5596       /* The sh_link field is set in final_write_processing.  */
5597     }
5598   else if (strcmp (name, ".conflict") == 0)
5599     hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_CONFLICT;
5600   else if (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".gptab."))
5601     {
5602       hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_GPTAB;
5603       hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab);
5604       /* The sh_info field is set in final_write_processing.  */
5605     }
5606   else if (strcmp (name, ".ucode") == 0)
5607     hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_UCODE;
5608   else if (strcmp (name, ".mdebug") == 0)
5609     {
5610       hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_DEBUG;
5611       /* In a shared object on IRIX 5.3, the .mdebug section has an
5612          entsize of 0.  FIXME: Does this matter?  */
5613       if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd) && (abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0)
5614 	hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
5615       else
5616 	hdr->sh_entsize = 1;
5617     }
5618   else if (strcmp (name, ".reginfo") == 0)
5619     {
5620       hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_REGINFO;
5621       /* In a shared object on IRIX 5.3, the .reginfo section has an
5622          entsize of 0x18.  FIXME: Does this matter?  */
5623       if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd))
5624 	{
5625 	  if ((abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0)
5626 	    hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo);
5627 	  else
5628 	    hdr->sh_entsize = 1;
5629 	}
5630       else
5631 	hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo);
5632     }
5633   else if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd)
5634 	   && (strcmp (name, ".hash") == 0
5635 	       || strcmp (name, ".dynamic") == 0
5636 	       || strcmp (name, ".dynstr") == 0))
5637     {
5638       if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd))
5639 	hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
5640 #if 0
5641       /* This isn't how the IRIX6 linker behaves.  */
5642       hdr->sh_info = SIZEOF_MIPS_DYNSYM_SECNAMES;
5643 #endif
5644     }
5645   else if (strcmp (name, ".got") == 0
5646 	   || strcmp (name, ".srdata") == 0
5647 	   || strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
5648 	   || strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0
5649 	   || strcmp (name, ".lit4") == 0
5650 	   || strcmp (name, ".lit8") == 0)
5651     hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MIPS_GPREL;
5652   else if (strcmp (name, ".MIPS.interfaces") == 0)
5653     {
5654       hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_IFACE;
5655       hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MIPS_NOSTRIP;
5656     }
5657   else if (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.content"))
5658     {
5659       hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_CONTENT;
5660       hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MIPS_NOSTRIP;
5661       /* The sh_info field is set in final_write_processing.  */
5662     }
5663   else if (MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME_P (name))
5664     {
5665       hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS;
5666       hdr->sh_entsize = 1;
5667       hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MIPS_NOSTRIP;
5668     }
5669   else if (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".debug_"))
5670     hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_DWARF;
5671   else if (strcmp (name, ".MIPS.symlib") == 0)
5672     {
5673       hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_SYMBOL_LIB;
5674       /* The sh_link and sh_info fields are set in
5675          final_write_processing.  */
5676     }
5677   else if (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.events")
5678 	   || CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.post_rel"))
5679     {
5680       hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_EVENTS;
5681       hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MIPS_NOSTRIP;
5682       /* The sh_link field is set in final_write_processing.  */
5683     }
5684   else if (strcmp (name, ".msym") == 0)
5685     {
5686       hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_MSYM;
5687       hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_ALLOC;
5688       hdr->sh_entsize = 8;
5689     }
5690 
5691   /* The generic elf_fake_sections will set up REL_HDR using the default
5692    kind of relocations.  We used to set up a second header for the
5693    non-default kind of relocations here, but only NewABI would use
5694    these, and the IRIX ld doesn't like resulting empty RELA sections.
5695    Thus we create those header only on demand now.  */
5696 
5697   return TRUE;
5698 }
5699 
5700 /* Given a BFD section, try to locate the corresponding ELF section
5701    index.  This is used by both the 32-bit and the 64-bit ABI.
5702    Actually, it's not clear to me that the 64-bit ABI supports these,
5703    but for non-PIC objects we will certainly want support for at least
5704    the .scommon section.  */
5705 
5706 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_section_from_bfd_section(bfd * abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,asection * sec,int * retval)5707 _bfd_mips_elf_section_from_bfd_section (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
5708 					asection *sec, int *retval)
5709 {
5710   if (strcmp (bfd_get_section_name (abfd, sec), ".scommon") == 0)
5711     {
5712       *retval = SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON;
5713       return TRUE;
5714     }
5715   if (strcmp (bfd_get_section_name (abfd, sec), ".acommon") == 0)
5716     {
5717       *retval = SHN_MIPS_ACOMMON;
5718       return TRUE;
5719     }
5720   return FALSE;
5721 }
5722 
5723 /* Hook called by the linker routine which adds symbols from an object
5724    file.  We must handle the special MIPS section numbers here.  */
5725 
5726 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_add_symbol_hook(bfd * abfd,struct bfd_link_info * info,Elf_Internal_Sym * sym,const char ** namep,flagword * flagsp ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,asection ** secp,bfd_vma * valp)5727 _bfd_mips_elf_add_symbol_hook (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
5728 			       Elf_Internal_Sym *sym, const char **namep,
5729 			       flagword *flagsp ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
5730 			       asection **secp, bfd_vma *valp)
5731 {
5732   if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd)
5733       && (abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0
5734       && strcmp (*namep, "_rld_new_interface") == 0)
5735     {
5736       /* Skip IRIX5 rld entry name.  */
5737       *namep = NULL;
5738       return TRUE;
5739     }
5740 
5741   /* Shared objects may have a dynamic symbol '_gp_disp' defined as
5742      a SECTION *ABS*.  This causes ld to think it can resolve _gp_disp
5743      by setting a DT_NEEDED for the shared object.  Since _gp_disp is
5744      a magic symbol resolved by the linker, we ignore this bogus definition
5745      of _gp_disp.  New ABI objects do not suffer from this problem so this
5746      is not done for them. */
5747   if (!NEWABI_P(abfd)
5748       && (sym->st_shndx == SHN_ABS)
5749       && (strcmp (*namep, "_gp_disp") == 0))
5750     {
5751       *namep = NULL;
5752       return TRUE;
5753     }
5754 
5755   switch (sym->st_shndx)
5756     {
5757     case SHN_COMMON:
5758       /* Common symbols less than the GP size are automatically
5759 	 treated as SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON symbols.  */
5760       if (sym->st_size > elf_gp_size (abfd)
5761 	  || ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_TLS
5762 	  || IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix6)
5763 	break;
5764       /* Fall through.  */
5765     case SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON:
5766       *secp = bfd_make_section_old_way (abfd, ".scommon");
5767       (*secp)->flags |= SEC_IS_COMMON;
5768       *valp = sym->st_size;
5769       break;
5770 
5771     case SHN_MIPS_TEXT:
5772       /* This section is used in a shared object.  */
5773       if (elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_text_section == NULL)
5774 	{
5775 	  asymbol *elf_text_symbol;
5776 	  asection *elf_text_section;
5777 	  bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (asection);
5778 
5779 	  elf_text_section = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5780 	  if (elf_text_section == NULL)
5781 	    return FALSE;
5782 
5783 	  amt = sizeof (asymbol);
5784 	  elf_text_symbol = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5785 	  if (elf_text_symbol == NULL)
5786 	    return FALSE;
5787 
5788 	  /* Initialize the section.  */
5789 
5790 	  elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_text_section = elf_text_section;
5791 	  elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_text_symbol = elf_text_symbol;
5792 
5793 	  elf_text_section->symbol = elf_text_symbol;
5794 	  elf_text_section->symbol_ptr_ptr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_text_symbol;
5795 
5796 	  elf_text_section->name = ".text";
5797 	  elf_text_section->flags = SEC_NO_FLAGS;
5798 	  elf_text_section->output_section = NULL;
5799 	  elf_text_section->owner = abfd;
5800 	  elf_text_symbol->name = ".text";
5801 	  elf_text_symbol->flags = BSF_SECTION_SYM | BSF_DYNAMIC;
5802 	  elf_text_symbol->section = elf_text_section;
5803 	}
5804       /* This code used to do *secp = bfd_und_section_ptr if
5805          info->shared.  I don't know why, and that doesn't make sense,
5806          so I took it out.  */
5807       *secp = elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_text_section;
5808       break;
5809 
5810     case SHN_MIPS_ACOMMON:
5811       /* Fall through. XXX Can we treat this as allocated data?  */
5812     case SHN_MIPS_DATA:
5813       /* This section is used in a shared object.  */
5814       if (elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_data_section == NULL)
5815 	{
5816 	  asymbol *elf_data_symbol;
5817 	  asection *elf_data_section;
5818 	  bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (asection);
5819 
5820 	  elf_data_section = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5821 	  if (elf_data_section == NULL)
5822 	    return FALSE;
5823 
5824 	  amt = sizeof (asymbol);
5825 	  elf_data_symbol = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5826 	  if (elf_data_symbol == NULL)
5827 	    return FALSE;
5828 
5829 	  /* Initialize the section.  */
5830 
5831 	  elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_data_section = elf_data_section;
5832 	  elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_data_symbol = elf_data_symbol;
5833 
5834 	  elf_data_section->symbol = elf_data_symbol;
5835 	  elf_data_section->symbol_ptr_ptr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_data_symbol;
5836 
5837 	  elf_data_section->name = ".data";
5838 	  elf_data_section->flags = SEC_NO_FLAGS;
5839 	  elf_data_section->output_section = NULL;
5840 	  elf_data_section->owner = abfd;
5841 	  elf_data_symbol->name = ".data";
5842 	  elf_data_symbol->flags = BSF_SECTION_SYM | BSF_DYNAMIC;
5843 	  elf_data_symbol->section = elf_data_section;
5844 	}
5845       /* This code used to do *secp = bfd_und_section_ptr if
5846          info->shared.  I don't know why, and that doesn't make sense,
5847          so I took it out.  */
5848       *secp = elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_data_section;
5849       break;
5850 
5851     case SHN_MIPS_SUNDEFINED:
5852       *secp = bfd_und_section_ptr;
5853       break;
5854     }
5855 
5856   if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd)
5857       && ! info->shared
5858       && info->hash->creator == abfd->xvec
5859       && strcmp (*namep, "__rld_obj_head") == 0)
5860     {
5861       struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
5862       struct bfd_link_hash_entry *bh;
5863 
5864       /* Mark __rld_obj_head as dynamic.  */
5865       bh = NULL;
5866       if (! (_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol
5867 	     (info, abfd, *namep, BSF_GLOBAL, *secp, *valp, NULL, FALSE,
5868 	      get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->collect, &bh)))
5869 	return FALSE;
5870 
5871       h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
5872       h->non_elf = 0;
5873       h->def_regular = 1;
5874       h->type = STT_OBJECT;
5875 
5876       if (! bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
5877 	return FALSE;
5878 
5879       mips_elf_hash_table (info)->use_rld_obj_head = TRUE;
5880     }
5881 
5882   /* If this is a mips16 text symbol, add 1 to the value to make it
5883      odd.  This will cause something like .word SYM to come up with
5884      the right value when it is loaded into the PC.  */
5885   if (sym->st_other == STO_MIPS16)
5886     ++*valp;
5887 
5888   return TRUE;
5889 }
5890 
5891 /* This hook function is called before the linker writes out a global
5892    symbol.  We mark symbols as small common if appropriate.  This is
5893    also where we undo the increment of the value for a mips16 symbol.  */
5894 
5895 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_link_output_symbol_hook(struct bfd_link_info * info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,const char * name ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,Elf_Internal_Sym * sym,asection * input_sec,struct elf_link_hash_entry * h ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)5896 _bfd_mips_elf_link_output_symbol_hook
5897   (struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
5898    const char *name ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
5899    asection *input_sec, struct elf_link_hash_entry *h ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
5900 {
5901   /* If we see a common symbol, which implies a relocatable link, then
5902      if a symbol was small common in an input file, mark it as small
5903      common in the output file.  */
5904   if (sym->st_shndx == SHN_COMMON
5905       && strcmp (input_sec->name, ".scommon") == 0)
5906     sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON;
5907 
5908   if (sym->st_other == STO_MIPS16)
5909     sym->st_value &= ~1;
5910 
5911   return TRUE;
5912 }
5913 
5914 /* Functions for the dynamic linker.  */
5915 
5916 /* Create dynamic sections when linking against a dynamic object.  */
5917 
5918 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_create_dynamic_sections(bfd * abfd,struct bfd_link_info * info)5919 _bfd_mips_elf_create_dynamic_sections (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
5920 {
5921   struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
5922   struct bfd_link_hash_entry *bh;
5923   flagword flags;
5924   register asection *s;
5925   const char * const *namep;
5926   struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
5927 
5928   htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
5929   flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY
5930 	   | SEC_LINKER_CREATED | SEC_READONLY);
5931 
5932   /* The psABI requires a read-only .dynamic section, but the VxWorks
5933      EABI doesn't.  */
5934   if (!htab->is_vxworks)
5935     {
5936       s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
5937       if (s != NULL)
5938 	{
5939 	  if (! bfd_set_section_flags (abfd, s, flags))
5940 	    return FALSE;
5941 	}
5942     }
5943 
5944   /* We need to create .got section.  */
5945   if (! mips_elf_create_got_section (abfd, info, FALSE))
5946     return FALSE;
5947 
5948   if (! mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, TRUE))
5949     return FALSE;
5950 
5951   /* Create .stub section.  */
5952   if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd,
5953 			       MIPS_ELF_STUB_SECTION_NAME (abfd)) == NULL)
5954     {
5955       s = bfd_make_section_with_flags (abfd,
5956 				       MIPS_ELF_STUB_SECTION_NAME (abfd),
5957 				       flags | SEC_CODE);
5958       if (s == NULL
5959 	  || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s,
5960 					  MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd)))
5961 	return FALSE;
5962     }
5963 
5964   if ((IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix5 || IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_none)
5965       && !info->shared
5966       && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rld_map") == NULL)
5967     {
5968       s = bfd_make_section_with_flags (abfd, ".rld_map",
5969 				       flags &~ (flagword) SEC_READONLY);
5970       if (s == NULL
5971 	  || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s,
5972 					  MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd)))
5973 	return FALSE;
5974     }
5975 
5976   /* On IRIX5, we adjust add some additional symbols and change the
5977      alignments of several sections.  There is no ABI documentation
5978      indicating that this is necessary on IRIX6, nor any evidence that
5979      the linker takes such action.  */
5980   if (IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix5)
5981     {
5982       for (namep = mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names; *namep != NULL; namep++)
5983 	{
5984 	  bh = NULL;
5985 	  if (! (_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol
5986 		 (info, abfd, *namep, BSF_GLOBAL, bfd_und_section_ptr, 0,
5987 		  NULL, FALSE, get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->collect, &bh)))
5988 	    return FALSE;
5989 
5990 	  h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
5991 	  h->non_elf = 0;
5992 	  h->def_regular = 1;
5993 	  h->type = STT_SECTION;
5994 
5995 	  if (! bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
5996 	    return FALSE;
5997 	}
5998 
5999       /* We need to create a .compact_rel section.  */
6000       if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd))
6001 	{
6002 	  if (!mips_elf_create_compact_rel_section (abfd, info))
6003 	    return FALSE;
6004 	}
6005 
6006       /* Change alignments of some sections.  */
6007       s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".hash");
6008       if (s != NULL)
6009 	bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd));
6010       s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynsym");
6011       if (s != NULL)
6012 	bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd));
6013       s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynstr");
6014       if (s != NULL)
6015 	bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd));
6016       s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".reginfo");
6017       if (s != NULL)
6018 	bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd));
6019       s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
6020       if (s != NULL)
6021 	bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd));
6022     }
6023 
6024   if (!info->shared)
6025     {
6026       const char *name;
6027 
6028       name = SGI_COMPAT (abfd) ? "_DYNAMIC_LINK" : "_DYNAMIC_LINKING";
6029       bh = NULL;
6030       if (!(_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol
6031 	    (info, abfd, name, BSF_GLOBAL, bfd_abs_section_ptr, 0,
6032 	     NULL, FALSE, get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->collect, &bh)))
6033 	return FALSE;
6034 
6035       h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
6036       h->non_elf = 0;
6037       h->def_regular = 1;
6038       h->type = STT_SECTION;
6039 
6040       if (! bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
6041 	return FALSE;
6042 
6043       if (! mips_elf_hash_table (info)->use_rld_obj_head)
6044 	{
6045 	  /* __rld_map is a four byte word located in the .data section
6046 	     and is filled in by the rtld to contain a pointer to
6047 	     the _r_debug structure. Its symbol value will be set in
6048 	     _bfd_mips_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol.  */
6049 	  s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rld_map");
6050 	  BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
6051 
6052 	  name = SGI_COMPAT (abfd) ? "__rld_map" : "__RLD_MAP";
6053 	  bh = NULL;
6054 	  if (!(_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol
6055 		(info, abfd, name, BSF_GLOBAL, s, 0, NULL, FALSE,
6056 		 get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->collect, &bh)))
6057 	    return FALSE;
6058 
6059 	  h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
6060 	  h->non_elf = 0;
6061 	  h->def_regular = 1;
6062 	  h->type = STT_OBJECT;
6063 
6064 	  if (! bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
6065 	    return FALSE;
6066 	}
6067     }
6068 
6069   if (htab->is_vxworks)
6070     {
6071       /* Create the .plt, .rela.plt, .dynbss and .rela.bss sections.
6072 	 Also create the _PROCEDURE_LINKAGE_TABLE symbol.  */
6073       if (!_bfd_elf_create_dynamic_sections (abfd, info))
6074 	return FALSE;
6075 
6076       /* Cache the sections created above.  */
6077       htab->sdynbss = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynbss");
6078       htab->srelbss = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rela.bss");
6079       htab->srelplt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rela.plt");
6080       htab->splt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".plt");
6081       if (!htab->sdynbss
6082 	  || (!htab->srelbss && !info->shared)
6083 	  || !htab->srelplt
6084 	  || !htab->splt)
6085 	abort ();
6086 
6087       /* Do the usual VxWorks handling.  */
6088       if (!elf_vxworks_create_dynamic_sections (abfd, info, &htab->srelplt2))
6089 	return FALSE;
6090 
6091       /* Work out the PLT sizes.  */
6092       if (info->shared)
6093 	{
6094 	  htab->plt_header_size
6095 	    = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (mips_vxworks_shared_plt0_entry);
6096 	  htab->plt_entry_size
6097 	    = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (mips_vxworks_shared_plt_entry);
6098 	}
6099       else
6100 	{
6101 	  htab->plt_header_size
6102 	    = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (mips_vxworks_exec_plt0_entry);
6103 	  htab->plt_entry_size
6104 	    = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (mips_vxworks_exec_plt_entry);
6105 	}
6106     }
6107 
6108   return TRUE;
6109 }
6110 
6111 /* Look through the relocs for a section during the first phase, and
6112    allocate space in the global offset table.  */
6113 
6114 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_check_relocs(bfd * abfd,struct bfd_link_info * info,asection * sec,const Elf_Internal_Rela * relocs)6115 _bfd_mips_elf_check_relocs (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
6116 			    asection *sec, const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs)
6117 {
6118   const char *name;
6119   bfd *dynobj;
6120   Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
6121   struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
6122   struct mips_got_info *g;
6123   size_t extsymoff;
6124   const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
6125   const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel_end;
6126   asection *sgot;
6127   asection *sreloc;
6128   const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
6129   struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
6130 
6131   if (info->relocatable)
6132     return TRUE;
6133 
6134   htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
6135   dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
6136   symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
6137   sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (abfd);
6138   extsymoff = (elf_bad_symtab (abfd)) ? 0 : symtab_hdr->sh_info;
6139 
6140   /* Check for the mips16 stub sections.  */
6141 
6142   name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, sec);
6143   if (FN_STUB_P (name))
6144     {
6145       unsigned long r_symndx;
6146 
6147       /* Look at the relocation information to figure out which symbol
6148          this is for.  */
6149 
6150       r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (abfd, relocs->r_info);
6151 
6152       if (r_symndx < extsymoff
6153 	  || sym_hashes[r_symndx - extsymoff] == NULL)
6154 	{
6155 	  asection *o;
6156 
6157 	  /* This stub is for a local symbol.  This stub will only be
6158              needed if there is some relocation in this BFD, other
6159              than a 16 bit function call, which refers to this symbol.  */
6160 	  for (o = abfd->sections; o != NULL; o = o->next)
6161 	    {
6162 	      Elf_Internal_Rela *sec_relocs;
6163 	      const Elf_Internal_Rela *r, *rend;
6164 
6165 	      /* We can ignore stub sections when looking for relocs.  */
6166 	      if ((o->flags & SEC_RELOC) == 0
6167 		  || o->reloc_count == 0
6168 		  || mips16_stub_section_p (abfd, o))
6169 		continue;
6170 
6171 	      sec_relocs
6172 		= _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (abfd, o, NULL, NULL,
6173 					     info->keep_memory);
6174 	      if (sec_relocs == NULL)
6175 		return FALSE;
6176 
6177 	      rend = sec_relocs + o->reloc_count;
6178 	      for (r = sec_relocs; r < rend; r++)
6179 		if (ELF_R_SYM (abfd, r->r_info) == r_symndx
6180 		    && ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, r->r_info) != R_MIPS16_26)
6181 		  break;
6182 
6183 	      if (elf_section_data (o)->relocs != sec_relocs)
6184 		free (sec_relocs);
6185 
6186 	      if (r < rend)
6187 		break;
6188 	    }
6189 
6190 	  if (o == NULL)
6191 	    {
6192 	      /* There is no non-call reloc for this stub, so we do
6193                  not need it.  Since this function is called before
6194                  the linker maps input sections to output sections, we
6195                  can easily discard it by setting the SEC_EXCLUDE
6196                  flag.  */
6197 	      sec->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
6198 	      return TRUE;
6199 	    }
6200 
6201 	  /* Record this stub in an array of local symbol stubs for
6202              this BFD.  */
6203 	  if (elf_tdata (abfd)->local_stubs == NULL)
6204 	    {
6205 	      unsigned long symcount;
6206 	      asection **n;
6207 	      bfd_size_type amt;
6208 
6209 	      if (elf_bad_symtab (abfd))
6210 		symcount = NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (symtab_hdr);
6211 	      else
6212 		symcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
6213 	      amt = symcount * sizeof (asection *);
6214 	      n = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
6215 	      if (n == NULL)
6216 		return FALSE;
6217 	      elf_tdata (abfd)->local_stubs = n;
6218 	    }
6219 
6220 	  sec->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
6221 	  elf_tdata (abfd)->local_stubs[r_symndx] = sec;
6222 
6223 	  /* We don't need to set mips16_stubs_seen in this case.
6224              That flag is used to see whether we need to look through
6225              the global symbol table for stubs.  We don't need to set
6226              it here, because we just have a local stub.  */
6227 	}
6228       else
6229 	{
6230 	  struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
6231 
6232 	  h = ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
6233 	       sym_hashes[r_symndx - extsymoff]);
6234 
6235 	  while (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
6236 		 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
6237 	    h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
6238 
6239 	  /* H is the symbol this stub is for.  */
6240 
6241 	  /* If we already have an appropriate stub for this function, we
6242 	     don't need another one, so we can discard this one.  Since
6243 	     this function is called before the linker maps input sections
6244 	     to output sections, we can easily discard it by setting the
6245 	     SEC_EXCLUDE flag.  */
6246 	  if (h->fn_stub != NULL)
6247 	    {
6248 	      sec->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
6249 	      return TRUE;
6250 	    }
6251 
6252 	  sec->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
6253 	  h->fn_stub = sec;
6254 	  mips_elf_hash_table (info)->mips16_stubs_seen = TRUE;
6255 	}
6256     }
6257   else if (CALL_STUB_P (name) || CALL_FP_STUB_P (name))
6258     {
6259       unsigned long r_symndx;
6260       struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
6261       asection **loc;
6262 
6263       /* Look at the relocation information to figure out which symbol
6264          this is for.  */
6265 
6266       r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (abfd, relocs->r_info);
6267 
6268       if (r_symndx < extsymoff
6269 	  || sym_hashes[r_symndx - extsymoff] == NULL)
6270 	{
6271 	  asection *o;
6272 
6273 	  /* This stub is for a local symbol.  This stub will only be
6274              needed if there is some relocation (R_MIPS16_26) in this BFD
6275              that refers to this symbol.  */
6276 	  for (o = abfd->sections; o != NULL; o = o->next)
6277 	    {
6278 	      Elf_Internal_Rela *sec_relocs;
6279 	      const Elf_Internal_Rela *r, *rend;
6280 
6281 	      /* We can ignore stub sections when looking for relocs.  */
6282 	      if ((o->flags & SEC_RELOC) == 0
6283 		  || o->reloc_count == 0
6284 		  || mips16_stub_section_p (abfd, o))
6285 		continue;
6286 
6287 	      sec_relocs
6288 		= _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (abfd, o, NULL, NULL,
6289 					     info->keep_memory);
6290 	      if (sec_relocs == NULL)
6291 		return FALSE;
6292 
6293 	      rend = sec_relocs + o->reloc_count;
6294 	      for (r = sec_relocs; r < rend; r++)
6295 		if (ELF_R_SYM (abfd, r->r_info) == r_symndx
6296 		    && ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, r->r_info) == R_MIPS16_26)
6297 		    break;
6298 
6299 	      if (elf_section_data (o)->relocs != sec_relocs)
6300 		free (sec_relocs);
6301 
6302 	      if (r < rend)
6303 		break;
6304 	    }
6305 
6306 	  if (o == NULL)
6307 	    {
6308 	      /* There is no non-call reloc for this stub, so we do
6309                  not need it.  Since this function is called before
6310                  the linker maps input sections to output sections, we
6311                  can easily discard it by setting the SEC_EXCLUDE
6312                  flag.  */
6313 	      sec->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
6314 	      return TRUE;
6315 	    }
6316 
6317 	  /* Record this stub in an array of local symbol call_stubs for
6318              this BFD.  */
6319 	  if (elf_tdata (abfd)->local_call_stubs == NULL)
6320 	    {
6321 	      unsigned long symcount;
6322 	      asection **n;
6323 	      bfd_size_type amt;
6324 
6325 	      if (elf_bad_symtab (abfd))
6326 		symcount = NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (symtab_hdr);
6327 	      else
6328 		symcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
6329 	      amt = symcount * sizeof (asection *);
6330 	      n = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
6331 	      if (n == NULL)
6332 		return FALSE;
6333 	      elf_tdata (abfd)->local_call_stubs = n;
6334 	    }
6335 
6336 	  sec->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
6337 	  elf_tdata (abfd)->local_call_stubs[r_symndx] = sec;
6338 
6339 	  /* We don't need to set mips16_stubs_seen in this case.
6340              That flag is used to see whether we need to look through
6341              the global symbol table for stubs.  We don't need to set
6342              it here, because we just have a local stub.  */
6343 	}
6344       else
6345 	{
6346 	  h = ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
6347 	       sym_hashes[r_symndx - extsymoff]);
6348 
6349 	  /* H is the symbol this stub is for.  */
6350 
6351 	  if (CALL_FP_STUB_P (name))
6352 	    loc = &h->call_fp_stub;
6353 	  else
6354 	    loc = &h->call_stub;
6355 
6356 	  /* If we already have an appropriate stub for this function, we
6357 	     don't need another one, so we can discard this one.  Since
6358 	     this function is called before the linker maps input sections
6359 	     to output sections, we can easily discard it by setting the
6360 	     SEC_EXCLUDE flag.  */
6361 	  if (*loc != NULL)
6362 	    {
6363 	      sec->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
6364 	      return TRUE;
6365 	    }
6366 
6367 	  sec->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
6368 	  *loc = sec;
6369 	  mips_elf_hash_table (info)->mips16_stubs_seen = TRUE;
6370 	}
6371     }
6372 
6373   if (dynobj == NULL)
6374     {
6375       sgot = NULL;
6376       g = NULL;
6377     }
6378   else
6379     {
6380       sgot = mips_elf_got_section (dynobj, FALSE);
6381       if (sgot == NULL)
6382 	g = NULL;
6383       else
6384 	{
6385 	  BFD_ASSERT (mips_elf_section_data (sgot) != NULL);
6386 	  g = mips_elf_section_data (sgot)->u.got_info;
6387 	  BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
6388 	}
6389     }
6390 
6391   sreloc = NULL;
6392   bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6393   rel_end = relocs + sec->reloc_count * bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel;
6394   for (rel = relocs; rel < rel_end; ++rel)
6395     {
6396       unsigned long r_symndx;
6397       unsigned int r_type;
6398       struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
6399 
6400       r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (abfd, rel->r_info);
6401       r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, rel->r_info);
6402 
6403       if (r_symndx < extsymoff)
6404 	h = NULL;
6405       else if (r_symndx >= extsymoff + NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (symtab_hdr))
6406 	{
6407 	  (*_bfd_error_handler)
6408 	    (_("%B: Malformed reloc detected for section %s"),
6409 	     abfd, name);
6410 	  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
6411 	  return FALSE;
6412 	}
6413       else
6414 	{
6415 	  h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - extsymoff];
6416 
6417 	  /* This may be an indirect symbol created because of a version.  */
6418 	  if (h != NULL)
6419 	    {
6420 	      while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
6421 		h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
6422 	    }
6423 	}
6424 
6425       /* Some relocs require a global offset table.  */
6426       if (dynobj == NULL || sgot == NULL)
6427 	{
6428 	  switch (r_type)
6429 	    {
6430 	    case R_MIPS_GOT16:
6431 	    case R_MIPS_CALL16:
6432 	    case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
6433 	    case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
6434 	    case R_MIPS_GOT_HI16:
6435 	    case R_MIPS_GOT_LO16:
6436 	    case R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE:
6437 	    case R_MIPS_GOT_OFST:
6438 	    case R_MIPS_GOT_DISP:
6439 	    case R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL:
6440 	    case R_MIPS_TLS_GD:
6441 	    case R_MIPS_TLS_LDM:
6442 	      if (dynobj == NULL)
6443 		elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj = dynobj = abfd;
6444 	      if (! mips_elf_create_got_section (dynobj, info, FALSE))
6445 		return FALSE;
6446 	      g = mips_elf_got_info (dynobj, &sgot);
6447 	      if (htab->is_vxworks && !info->shared)
6448 		{
6449 		  (*_bfd_error_handler)
6450 		    (_("%B: GOT reloc at 0x%lx not expected in executables"),
6451 		     abfd, (unsigned long) rel->r_offset);
6452 		  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
6453 		  return FALSE;
6454 		}
6455 	      break;
6456 
6457 	    case R_MIPS_32:
6458 	    case R_MIPS_REL32:
6459 	    case R_MIPS_64:
6460 	      /* In VxWorks executables, references to external symbols
6461 		 are handled using copy relocs or PLT stubs, so there's
6462 		 no need to add a dynamic relocation here.  */
6463 	      if (dynobj == NULL
6464 		  && (info->shared || (h != NULL && !htab->is_vxworks))
6465 		  && (sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
6466 		elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj = dynobj = abfd;
6467 	      break;
6468 
6469 	    default:
6470 	      break;
6471 	    }
6472 	}
6473 
6474       if (h)
6475 	{
6476 	  ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h)->is_relocation_target = TRUE;
6477 
6478 	  /* Relocations against the special VxWorks __GOTT_BASE__ and
6479 	     __GOTT_INDEX__ symbols must be left to the loader.  Allocate
6480 	     room for them in .rela.dyn.  */
6481 	  if (is_gott_symbol (info, h))
6482 	    {
6483 	      if (sreloc == NULL)
6484 		{
6485 		  sreloc = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, TRUE);
6486 		  if (sreloc == NULL)
6487 		    return FALSE;
6488 		}
6489 	      mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations (dynobj, info, 1);
6490 	      if (MIPS_ELF_READONLY_SECTION (sec))
6491 		/* We tell the dynamic linker that there are
6492 		   relocations against the text segment.  */
6493 		info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
6494 	    }
6495 	}
6496       else if (r_type == R_MIPS_CALL_LO16
6497 	       || r_type == R_MIPS_GOT_LO16
6498 	       || r_type == R_MIPS_GOT_DISP
6499 	       || (r_type == R_MIPS_GOT16 && htab->is_vxworks))
6500 	{
6501 	  /* We may need a local GOT entry for this relocation.  We
6502 	     don't count R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE because we can estimate the
6503 	     maximum number of pages needed by looking at the size of
6504 	     the segment.  Similar comments apply to R_MIPS_GOT16 and
6505 	     R_MIPS_CALL16, except on VxWorks, where GOT relocations
6506 	     always evaluate to "G".  We don't count R_MIPS_GOT_HI16, or
6507 	     R_MIPS_CALL_HI16 because these are always followed by an
6508 	     R_MIPS_GOT_LO16 or R_MIPS_CALL_LO16.  */
6509 	  if (! mips_elf_record_local_got_symbol (abfd, r_symndx,
6510 						  rel->r_addend, g, 0))
6511 	    return FALSE;
6512 	}
6513 
6514       switch (r_type)
6515 	{
6516 	case R_MIPS_CALL16:
6517 	  if (h == NULL)
6518 	    {
6519 	      (*_bfd_error_handler)
6520 		(_("%B: CALL16 reloc at 0x%lx not against global symbol"),
6521 		 abfd, (unsigned long) rel->r_offset);
6522 	      bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
6523 	      return FALSE;
6524 	    }
6525 	  /* Fall through.  */
6526 
6527 	case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
6528 	case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
6529 	  if (h != NULL)
6530 	    {
6531 	      /* VxWorks call relocations point the function's .got.plt
6532 		 entry, which will be allocated by adjust_dynamic_symbol.
6533 		 Otherwise, this symbol requires a global GOT entry.  */
6534 	      if (!htab->is_vxworks
6535 		  && !mips_elf_record_global_got_symbol (h, abfd, info, g, 0))
6536 		return FALSE;
6537 
6538 	      /* We need a stub, not a plt entry for the undefined
6539 		 function.  But we record it as if it needs plt.  See
6540 		 _bfd_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol.  */
6541 	      h->needs_plt = 1;
6542 	      h->type = STT_FUNC;
6543 	    }
6544 	  break;
6545 
6546 	case R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE:
6547 	  /* If this is a global, overridable symbol, GOT_PAGE will
6548 	     decay to GOT_DISP, so we'll need a GOT entry for it.  */
6549 	  if (h == NULL)
6550 	    break;
6551 	  else
6552 	    {
6553 	      struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hmips =
6554 		(struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
6555 
6556 	      while (hmips->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
6557 		     || hmips->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
6558 		hmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
6559 		  hmips->root.root.u.i.link;
6560 
6561 	      if (hmips->root.def_regular
6562 		  && ! (info->shared && ! info->symbolic
6563 			&& ! hmips->root.forced_local))
6564 		break;
6565 	    }
6566 	  /* Fall through.  */
6567 
6568 	case R_MIPS_GOT16:
6569 	case R_MIPS_GOT_HI16:
6570 	case R_MIPS_GOT_LO16:
6571 	case R_MIPS_GOT_DISP:
6572 	  if (h && ! mips_elf_record_global_got_symbol (h, abfd, info, g, 0))
6573 	    return FALSE;
6574 	  break;
6575 
6576 	case R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL:
6577 	  if (info->shared)
6578 	    info->flags |= DF_STATIC_TLS;
6579 	  /* Fall through */
6580 
6581 	case R_MIPS_TLS_LDM:
6582 	  if (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_LDM)
6583 	    {
6584 	      r_symndx = 0;
6585 	      h = NULL;
6586 	    }
6587 	  /* Fall through */
6588 
6589 	case R_MIPS_TLS_GD:
6590 	  /* This symbol requires a global offset table entry, or two
6591 	     for TLS GD relocations.  */
6592 	  {
6593 	    unsigned char flag = (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_GD
6594 				  ? GOT_TLS_GD
6595 				  : r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_LDM
6596 				  ? GOT_TLS_LDM
6597 				  : GOT_TLS_IE);
6598 	    if (h != NULL)
6599 	      {
6600 		struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hmips =
6601 		  (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
6602 		hmips->tls_type |= flag;
6603 
6604 		if (h && ! mips_elf_record_global_got_symbol (h, abfd, info, g, flag))
6605 		  return FALSE;
6606 	      }
6607 	    else
6608 	      {
6609 		BFD_ASSERT (flag == GOT_TLS_LDM || r_symndx != 0);
6610 
6611 		if (! mips_elf_record_local_got_symbol (abfd, r_symndx,
6612 							rel->r_addend, g, flag))
6613 		  return FALSE;
6614 	      }
6615 	  }
6616 	  break;
6617 
6618 	case R_MIPS_32:
6619 	case R_MIPS_REL32:
6620 	case R_MIPS_64:
6621 	  /* In VxWorks executables, references to external symbols
6622 	     are handled using copy relocs or PLT stubs, so there's
6623 	     no need to add a .rela.dyn entry for this relocation.  */
6624 	  if ((info->shared || (h != NULL && !htab->is_vxworks))
6625 	      && (sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
6626 	    {
6627 	      if (sreloc == NULL)
6628 		{
6629 		  sreloc = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, TRUE);
6630 		  if (sreloc == NULL)
6631 		    return FALSE;
6632 		}
6633 	      if (info->shared)
6634 		{
6635 		  /* When creating a shared object, we must copy these
6636 		     reloc types into the output file as R_MIPS_REL32
6637 		     relocs.  Make room for this reloc in .rel(a).dyn.  */
6638 		  mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations (dynobj, info, 1);
6639 		  if (MIPS_ELF_READONLY_SECTION (sec))
6640 		    /* We tell the dynamic linker that there are
6641 		       relocations against the text segment.  */
6642 		    info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
6643 		}
6644 	      else
6645 		{
6646 		  struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hmips;
6647 
6648 		  /* We only need to copy this reloc if the symbol is
6649                      defined in a dynamic object.  */
6650 		  hmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
6651 		  ++hmips->possibly_dynamic_relocs;
6652 		  if (MIPS_ELF_READONLY_SECTION (sec))
6653 		    /* We need it to tell the dynamic linker if there
6654 		       are relocations against the text segment.  */
6655 		    hmips->readonly_reloc = TRUE;
6656 		}
6657 
6658 	      /* Even though we don't directly need a GOT entry for
6659 		 this symbol, a symbol must have a dynamic symbol
6660 		 table index greater that DT_MIPS_GOTSYM if there are
6661 		 dynamic relocations against it.  This does not apply
6662 		 to VxWorks, which does not have the usual coupling
6663 		 between global GOT entries and .dynsym entries.  */
6664 	      if (h != NULL && !htab->is_vxworks)
6665 		{
6666 		  if (dynobj == NULL)
6667 		    elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj = dynobj = abfd;
6668 		  if (! mips_elf_create_got_section (dynobj, info, TRUE))
6669 		    return FALSE;
6670 		  g = mips_elf_got_info (dynobj, &sgot);
6671 		  if (! mips_elf_record_global_got_symbol (h, abfd, info, g, 0))
6672 		    return FALSE;
6673 		}
6674 	    }
6675 
6676 	  if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd))
6677 	    mips_elf_hash_table (info)->compact_rel_size +=
6678 	      sizeof (Elf32_External_crinfo);
6679 	  break;
6680 
6681 	case R_MIPS_PC16:
6682 	  if (h)
6683 	    ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h)->is_branch_target = TRUE;
6684 	  break;
6685 
6686 	case R_MIPS_26:
6687 	  if (h)
6688 	    ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h)->is_branch_target = TRUE;
6689 	  /* Fall through.  */
6690 
6691 	case R_MIPS_GPREL16:
6692 	case R_MIPS_LITERAL:
6693 	case R_MIPS_GPREL32:
6694 	  if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd))
6695 	    mips_elf_hash_table (info)->compact_rel_size +=
6696 	      sizeof (Elf32_External_crinfo);
6697 	  break;
6698 
6699 	  /* This relocation describes the C++ object vtable hierarchy.
6700 	     Reconstruct it for later use during GC.  */
6701 	case R_MIPS_GNU_VTINHERIT:
6702 	  if (!bfd_elf_gc_record_vtinherit (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_offset))
6703 	    return FALSE;
6704 	  break;
6705 
6706 	  /* This relocation describes which C++ vtable entries are actually
6707 	     used.  Record for later use during GC.  */
6708 	case R_MIPS_GNU_VTENTRY:
6709 	  if (!bfd_elf_gc_record_vtentry (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_offset))
6710 	    return FALSE;
6711 	  break;
6712 
6713 	default:
6714 	  break;
6715 	}
6716 
6717       /* We must not create a stub for a symbol that has relocations
6718 	 related to taking the function's address.  This doesn't apply to
6719 	 VxWorks, where CALL relocs refer to a .got.plt entry instead of
6720 	 a normal .got entry.  */
6721       if (!htab->is_vxworks && h != NULL)
6722 	switch (r_type)
6723 	  {
6724 	  default:
6725 	    ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h)->no_fn_stub = TRUE;
6726 	    break;
6727 	  case R_MIPS_CALL16:
6728 	  case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
6729 	  case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
6730 	  case R_MIPS_JALR:
6731 	    break;
6732 	  }
6733 
6734       /* If this reloc is not a 16 bit call, and it has a global
6735          symbol, then we will need the fn_stub if there is one.
6736          References from a stub section do not count.  */
6737       if (h != NULL
6738 	  && r_type != R_MIPS16_26
6739 	  && !mips16_stub_section_p (abfd, sec))
6740 	{
6741 	  struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *mh;
6742 
6743 	  mh = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
6744 	  mh->need_fn_stub = TRUE;
6745 	}
6746     }
6747 
6748   return TRUE;
6749 }
6750 
6751 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_relax_section(bfd * abfd,asection * sec,struct bfd_link_info * link_info,bfd_boolean * again)6752 _bfd_mips_relax_section (bfd *abfd, asection *sec,
6753 			 struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
6754 			 bfd_boolean *again)
6755 {
6756   Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs;
6757   Elf_Internal_Rela *irel, *irelend;
6758   Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
6759   bfd_byte *contents = NULL;
6760   size_t extsymoff;
6761   bfd_boolean changed_contents = FALSE;
6762   bfd_vma sec_start = sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
6763   Elf_Internal_Sym *isymbuf = NULL;
6764 
6765   /* We are not currently changing any sizes, so only one pass.  */
6766   *again = FALSE;
6767 
6768   if (link_info->relocatable)
6769     return TRUE;
6770 
6771   internal_relocs = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (abfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
6772 					       link_info->keep_memory);
6773   if (internal_relocs == NULL)
6774     return TRUE;
6775 
6776   irelend = internal_relocs + sec->reloc_count
6777     * get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel;
6778   symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
6779   extsymoff = (elf_bad_symtab (abfd)) ? 0 : symtab_hdr->sh_info;
6780 
6781   for (irel = internal_relocs; irel < irelend; irel++)
6782     {
6783       bfd_vma symval;
6784       bfd_signed_vma sym_offset;
6785       unsigned int r_type;
6786       unsigned long r_symndx;
6787       asection *sym_sec;
6788       unsigned long instruction;
6789 
6790       /* Turn jalr into bgezal, and jr into beq, if they're marked
6791 	 with a JALR relocation, that indicate where they jump to.
6792 	 This saves some pipeline bubbles.  */
6793       r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, irel->r_info);
6794       if (r_type != R_MIPS_JALR)
6795 	continue;
6796 
6797       r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (abfd, irel->r_info);
6798       /* Compute the address of the jump target.  */
6799       if (r_symndx >= extsymoff)
6800 	{
6801 	  struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h
6802 	    = ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
6803 	       elf_sym_hashes (abfd) [r_symndx - extsymoff]);
6804 
6805 	  while (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
6806 		 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
6807 	    h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
6808 
6809 	  /* If a symbol is undefined, or if it may be overridden,
6810 	     skip it.  */
6811 	  if (! ((h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
6812 		  || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
6813 		 && h->root.root.u.def.section)
6814 	      || (link_info->shared && ! link_info->symbolic
6815 		  && !h->root.forced_local))
6816 	    continue;
6817 
6818 	  sym_sec = h->root.root.u.def.section;
6819 	  if (sym_sec->output_section)
6820 	    symval = (h->root.root.u.def.value
6821 		      + sym_sec->output_section->vma
6822 		      + sym_sec->output_offset);
6823 	  else
6824 	    symval = h->root.root.u.def.value;
6825 	}
6826       else
6827 	{
6828 	  Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
6829 
6830 	  /* Read this BFD's symbols if we haven't done so already.  */
6831 	  if (isymbuf == NULL && symtab_hdr->sh_info != 0)
6832 	    {
6833 	      isymbuf = (Elf_Internal_Sym *) symtab_hdr->contents;
6834 	      if (isymbuf == NULL)
6835 		isymbuf = bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (abfd, symtab_hdr,
6836 						symtab_hdr->sh_info, 0,
6837 						NULL, NULL, NULL);
6838 	      if (isymbuf == NULL)
6839 		goto relax_return;
6840 	    }
6841 
6842 	  isym = isymbuf + r_symndx;
6843 	  if (isym->st_shndx == SHN_UNDEF)
6844 	    continue;
6845 	  else if (isym->st_shndx == SHN_ABS)
6846 	    sym_sec = bfd_abs_section_ptr;
6847 	  else if (isym->st_shndx == SHN_COMMON)
6848 	    sym_sec = bfd_com_section_ptr;
6849 	  else
6850 	    sym_sec
6851 	      = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, isym->st_shndx);
6852 	  symval = isym->st_value
6853 	    + sym_sec->output_section->vma
6854 	    + sym_sec->output_offset;
6855 	}
6856 
6857       /* Compute branch offset, from delay slot of the jump to the
6858 	 branch target.  */
6859       sym_offset = (symval + irel->r_addend)
6860 	- (sec_start + irel->r_offset + 4);
6861 
6862       /* Branch offset must be properly aligned.  */
6863       if ((sym_offset & 3) != 0)
6864 	continue;
6865 
6866       sym_offset >>= 2;
6867 
6868       /* Check that it's in range.  */
6869       if (sym_offset < -0x8000 || sym_offset >= 0x8000)
6870 	continue;
6871 
6872       /* Get the section contents if we haven't done so already.  */
6873       if (contents == NULL)
6874 	{
6875 	  /* Get cached copy if it exists.  */
6876 	  if (elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents != NULL)
6877 	    contents = elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents;
6878 	  else
6879 	    {
6880 	      if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, sec, &contents))
6881 		goto relax_return;
6882 	    }
6883 	}
6884 
6885       instruction = bfd_get_32 (abfd, contents + irel->r_offset);
6886 
6887       /* If it was jalr <reg>, turn it into bgezal $zero, <target>.  */
6888       if ((instruction & 0xfc1fffff) == 0x0000f809)
6889 	instruction = 0x04110000;
6890       /* If it was jr <reg>, turn it into b <target>.  */
6891       else if ((instruction & 0xfc1fffff) == 0x00000008)
6892 	instruction = 0x10000000;
6893       else
6894 	continue;
6895 
6896       instruction |= (sym_offset & 0xffff);
6897       bfd_put_32 (abfd, instruction, contents + irel->r_offset);
6898       changed_contents = TRUE;
6899     }
6900 
6901   if (contents != NULL
6902       && elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents != contents)
6903     {
6904       if (!changed_contents && !link_info->keep_memory)
6905         free (contents);
6906       else
6907         {
6908           /* Cache the section contents for elf_link_input_bfd.  */
6909           elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents = contents;
6910         }
6911     }
6912   return TRUE;
6913 
6914  relax_return:
6915   if (contents != NULL
6916       && elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents != contents)
6917     free (contents);
6918   return FALSE;
6919 }
6920 
6921 /* Adjust a symbol defined by a dynamic object and referenced by a
6922    regular object.  The current definition is in some section of the
6923    dynamic object, but we're not including those sections.  We have to
6924    change the definition to something the rest of the link can
6925    understand.  */
6926 
6927 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol(struct bfd_link_info * info,struct elf_link_hash_entry * h)6928 _bfd_mips_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
6929 				     struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
6930 {
6931   bfd *dynobj;
6932   struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hmips;
6933   asection *s;
6934   struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
6935 
6936   htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
6937   dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
6938 
6939   /* Make sure we know what is going on here.  */
6940   BFD_ASSERT (dynobj != NULL
6941 	      && (h->needs_plt
6942 		  || h->u.weakdef != NULL
6943 		  || (h->def_dynamic
6944 		      && h->ref_regular
6945 		      && !h->def_regular)));
6946 
6947   /* If this symbol is defined in a dynamic object, we need to copy
6948      any R_MIPS_32 or R_MIPS_REL32 relocs against it into the output
6949      file.  */
6950   hmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
6951   if (! info->relocatable
6952       && hmips->possibly_dynamic_relocs != 0
6953       && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak
6954 	  || !h->def_regular))
6955     {
6956       mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations
6957 	(dynobj, info, hmips->possibly_dynamic_relocs);
6958       if (hmips->readonly_reloc)
6959 	/* We tell the dynamic linker that there are relocations
6960 	   against the text segment.  */
6961 	info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
6962     }
6963 
6964   /* For a function, create a stub, if allowed.  */
6965   if (! hmips->no_fn_stub
6966       && h->needs_plt)
6967     {
6968       if (! elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
6969 	return TRUE;
6970 
6971       /* If this symbol is not defined in a regular file, then set
6972 	 the symbol to the stub location.  This is required to make
6973 	 function pointers compare as equal between the normal
6974 	 executable and the shared library.  */
6975       if (!h->def_regular)
6976 	{
6977 	  /* We need .stub section.  */
6978 	  s = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj,
6979 				       MIPS_ELF_STUB_SECTION_NAME (dynobj));
6980 	  BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
6981 
6982 	  h->root.u.def.section = s;
6983 	  h->root.u.def.value = s->size;
6984 
6985 	  /* XXX Write this stub address somewhere.  */
6986 	  h->plt.offset = s->size;
6987 
6988 	  /* Make room for this stub code.  */
6989 	  s->size += htab->function_stub_size;
6990 
6991 	  /* The last half word of the stub will be filled with the index
6992 	     of this symbol in .dynsym section.  */
6993 	  return TRUE;
6994 	}
6995     }
6996   else if ((h->type == STT_FUNC)
6997 	   && !h->needs_plt)
6998     {
6999       /* This will set the entry for this symbol in the GOT to 0, and
7000          the dynamic linker will take care of this.  */
7001       h->root.u.def.value = 0;
7002       return TRUE;
7003     }
7004 
7005   /* If this is a weak symbol, and there is a real definition, the
7006      processor independent code will have arranged for us to see the
7007      real definition first, and we can just use the same value.  */
7008   if (h->u.weakdef != NULL)
7009     {
7010       BFD_ASSERT (h->u.weakdef->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
7011 		  || h->u.weakdef->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak);
7012       h->root.u.def.section = h->u.weakdef->root.u.def.section;
7013       h->root.u.def.value = h->u.weakdef->root.u.def.value;
7014       return TRUE;
7015     }
7016 
7017   /* This is a reference to a symbol defined by a dynamic object which
7018      is not a function.  */
7019 
7020   return TRUE;
7021 }
7022 
7023 /* Likewise, for VxWorks.  */
7024 
7025 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_vxworks_adjust_dynamic_symbol(struct bfd_link_info * info,struct elf_link_hash_entry * h)7026 _bfd_mips_vxworks_adjust_dynamic_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
7027 					 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
7028 {
7029   bfd *dynobj;
7030   struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hmips;
7031   struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
7032 
7033   htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
7034   dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
7035   hmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
7036 
7037   /* Make sure we know what is going on here.  */
7038   BFD_ASSERT (dynobj != NULL
7039 	      && (h->needs_plt
7040 		  || h->needs_copy
7041 		  || h->u.weakdef != NULL
7042 		  || (h->def_dynamic
7043 		      && h->ref_regular
7044 		      && !h->def_regular)));
7045 
7046   /* If the symbol is defined by a dynamic object, we need a PLT stub if
7047      either (a) we want to branch to the symbol or (b) we're linking an
7048      executable that needs a canonical function address.  In the latter
7049      case, the canonical address will be the address of the executable's
7050      load stub.  */
7051   if ((hmips->is_branch_target
7052        || (!info->shared
7053 	   && h->type == STT_FUNC
7054 	   && hmips->is_relocation_target))
7055       && h->def_dynamic
7056       && h->ref_regular
7057       && !h->def_regular
7058       && !h->forced_local)
7059     h->needs_plt = 1;
7060 
7061   /* Locally-binding symbols do not need a PLT stub; we can refer to
7062      the functions directly.  */
7063   else if (h->needs_plt
7064 	   && (SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h)
7065 	       || (ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) != STV_DEFAULT
7066 		   && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)))
7067     {
7068       h->needs_plt = 0;
7069       return TRUE;
7070     }
7071 
7072   if (h->needs_plt)
7073     {
7074       /* If this is the first symbol to need a PLT entry, allocate room
7075 	 for the header, and for the header's .rela.plt.unloaded entries.  */
7076       if (htab->splt->size == 0)
7077 	{
7078 	  htab->splt->size += htab->plt_header_size;
7079 	  if (!info->shared)
7080 	    htab->srelplt2->size += 2 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
7081 	}
7082 
7083       /* Assign the next .plt entry to this symbol.  */
7084       h->plt.offset = htab->splt->size;
7085       htab->splt->size += htab->plt_entry_size;
7086 
7087       /* If the output file has no definition of the symbol, set the
7088 	 symbol's value to the address of the stub.  For executables,
7089 	 point at the PLT load stub rather than the lazy resolution stub;
7090 	 this stub will become the canonical function address.  */
7091       if (!h->def_regular)
7092 	{
7093 	  h->root.u.def.section = htab->splt;
7094 	  h->root.u.def.value = h->plt.offset;
7095 	  if (!info->shared)
7096 	    h->root.u.def.value += 8;
7097 	}
7098 
7099       /* Make room for the .got.plt entry and the R_JUMP_SLOT relocation.  */
7100       htab->sgotplt->size += 4;
7101       htab->srelplt->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
7102 
7103       /* Make room for the .rela.plt.unloaded relocations.  */
7104       if (!info->shared)
7105 	htab->srelplt2->size += 3 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
7106 
7107       return TRUE;
7108     }
7109 
7110   /* If a function symbol is defined by a dynamic object, and we do not
7111      need a PLT stub for it, the symbol's value should be zero.  */
7112   if (h->type == STT_FUNC
7113       && h->def_dynamic
7114       && h->ref_regular
7115       && !h->def_regular)
7116     {
7117       h->root.u.def.value = 0;
7118       return TRUE;
7119     }
7120 
7121   /* If this is a weak symbol, and there is a real definition, the
7122      processor independent code will have arranged for us to see the
7123      real definition first, and we can just use the same value.  */
7124   if (h->u.weakdef != NULL)
7125     {
7126       BFD_ASSERT (h->u.weakdef->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
7127 		  || h->u.weakdef->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak);
7128       h->root.u.def.section = h->u.weakdef->root.u.def.section;
7129       h->root.u.def.value = h->u.weakdef->root.u.def.value;
7130       return TRUE;
7131     }
7132 
7133   /* This is a reference to a symbol defined by a dynamic object which
7134      is not a function.  */
7135   if (info->shared)
7136     return TRUE;
7137 
7138   /* We must allocate the symbol in our .dynbss section, which will
7139      become part of the .bss section of the executable.  There will be
7140      an entry for this symbol in the .dynsym section.  The dynamic
7141      object will contain position independent code, so all references
7142      from the dynamic object to this symbol will go through the global
7143      offset table.  The dynamic linker will use the .dynsym entry to
7144      determine the address it must put in the global offset table, so
7145      both the dynamic object and the regular object will refer to the
7146      same memory location for the variable.  */
7147 
7148   if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
7149     {
7150       htab->srelbss->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
7151       h->needs_copy = 1;
7152     }
7153 
7154   return _bfd_elf_adjust_dynamic_copy (h, htab->sdynbss);
7155 }
7156 
7157 /* Return the number of dynamic section symbols required by OUTPUT_BFD.
7158    The number might be exact or a worst-case estimate, depending on how
7159    much information is available to elf_backend_omit_section_dynsym at
7160    the current linking stage.  */
7161 
7162 static bfd_size_type
count_section_dynsyms(bfd * output_bfd,struct bfd_link_info * info)7163 count_section_dynsyms (bfd *output_bfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
7164 {
7165   bfd_size_type count;
7166 
7167   count = 0;
7168   if (info->shared || elf_hash_table (info)->is_relocatable_executable)
7169     {
7170       asection *p;
7171       const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
7172 
7173       bed = get_elf_backend_data (output_bfd);
7174       for (p = output_bfd->sections; p ; p = p->next)
7175 	if ((p->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) == 0
7176 	    && (p->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
7177 	    && !(*bed->elf_backend_omit_section_dynsym) (output_bfd, info, p))
7178 	  ++count;
7179     }
7180   return count;
7181 }
7182 
7183 /* This function is called after all the input files have been read,
7184    and the input sections have been assigned to output sections.  We
7185    check for any mips16 stub sections that we can discard.  */
7186 
7187 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_always_size_sections(bfd * output_bfd,struct bfd_link_info * info)7188 _bfd_mips_elf_always_size_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
7189 				    struct bfd_link_info *info)
7190 {
7191   asection *ri;
7192 
7193   bfd *dynobj;
7194   asection *s;
7195   struct mips_got_info *g;
7196   int i;
7197   bfd_size_type loadable_size = 0;
7198   bfd_size_type local_gotno;
7199   bfd_size_type dynsymcount;
7200   bfd *sub;
7201   struct mips_elf_count_tls_arg count_tls_arg;
7202   struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
7203 
7204   htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
7205 
7206   /* The .reginfo section has a fixed size.  */
7207   ri = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, ".reginfo");
7208   if (ri != NULL)
7209     bfd_set_section_size (output_bfd, ri, sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo));
7210 
7211   if (! (info->relocatable
7212 	 || ! mips_elf_hash_table (info)->mips16_stubs_seen))
7213     mips_elf_link_hash_traverse (mips_elf_hash_table (info),
7214 				 mips_elf_check_mips16_stubs, NULL);
7215 
7216   dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
7217   if (dynobj == NULL)
7218     /* Relocatable links don't have it.  */
7219     return TRUE;
7220 
7221   g = mips_elf_got_info (dynobj, &s);
7222   if (s == NULL)
7223     return TRUE;
7224 
7225   /* Calculate the total loadable size of the output.  That
7226      will give us the maximum number of GOT_PAGE entries
7227      required.  */
7228   for (sub = info->input_bfds; sub; sub = sub->link_next)
7229     {
7230       asection *subsection;
7231 
7232       for (subsection = sub->sections;
7233 	   subsection;
7234 	   subsection = subsection->next)
7235 	{
7236 	  if ((subsection->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0)
7237 	    continue;
7238 	  loadable_size += ((subsection->size + 0xf)
7239 			    &~ (bfd_size_type) 0xf);
7240 	}
7241     }
7242 
7243   /* There has to be a global GOT entry for every symbol with
7244      a dynamic symbol table index of DT_MIPS_GOTSYM or
7245      higher.  Therefore, it make sense to put those symbols
7246      that need GOT entries at the end of the symbol table.  We
7247      do that here.  */
7248   if (! mips_elf_sort_hash_table (info, 1))
7249     return FALSE;
7250 
7251   if (g->global_gotsym != NULL)
7252     i = elf_hash_table (info)->dynsymcount - g->global_gotsym->dynindx;
7253   else
7254     /* If there are no global symbols, or none requiring
7255        relocations, then GLOBAL_GOTSYM will be NULL.  */
7256     i = 0;
7257 
7258   /* Get a worst-case estimate of the number of dynamic symbols needed.
7259      At this point, dynsymcount does not account for section symbols
7260      and count_section_dynsyms may overestimate the number that will
7261      be needed.  */
7262   dynsymcount = (elf_hash_table (info)->dynsymcount
7263 		 + count_section_dynsyms (output_bfd, info));
7264 
7265   /* Determine the size of one stub entry.  */
7266   htab->function_stub_size = (dynsymcount > 0x10000
7267 			      ? MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_BIG_SIZE
7268 			      : MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_NORMAL_SIZE);
7269 
7270   /* In the worst case, we'll get one stub per dynamic symbol, plus
7271      one to account for the dummy entry at the end required by IRIX
7272      rld.  */
7273   loadable_size += htab->function_stub_size * (i + 1);
7274 
7275   if (htab->is_vxworks)
7276     /* There's no need to allocate page entries for VxWorks; R_MIPS_GOT16
7277        relocations against local symbols evaluate to "G", and the EABI does
7278        not include R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE.  */
7279     local_gotno = 0;
7280   else
7281     /* Assume there are two loadable segments consisting of contiguous
7282        sections.  Is 5 enough?  */
7283     local_gotno = (loadable_size >> 16) + 5;
7284 
7285   g->local_gotno += local_gotno;
7286   s->size += g->local_gotno * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd);
7287 
7288   g->global_gotno = i;
7289   s->size += i * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd);
7290 
7291   /* We need to calculate tls_gotno for global symbols at this point
7292      instead of building it up earlier, to avoid doublecounting
7293      entries for one global symbol from multiple input files.  */
7294   count_tls_arg.info = info;
7295   count_tls_arg.needed = 0;
7296   elf_link_hash_traverse (elf_hash_table (info),
7297 			  mips_elf_count_global_tls_entries,
7298 			  &count_tls_arg);
7299   g->tls_gotno += count_tls_arg.needed;
7300   s->size += g->tls_gotno * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd);
7301 
7302   mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entries (g);
7303 
7304   /* VxWorks does not support multiple GOTs.  It initializes $gp to
7305      __GOTT_BASE__[__GOTT_INDEX__], the value of which is set by the
7306      dynamic loader.  */
7307   if (!htab->is_vxworks && s->size > MIPS_ELF_GOT_MAX_SIZE (info))
7308     {
7309       if (! mips_elf_multi_got (output_bfd, info, g, s, local_gotno))
7310 	return FALSE;
7311     }
7312   else
7313     {
7314       /* Set up TLS entries for the first GOT.  */
7315       g->tls_assigned_gotno = g->global_gotno + g->local_gotno;
7316       htab_traverse (g->got_entries, mips_elf_initialize_tls_index, g);
7317     }
7318 
7319   return TRUE;
7320 }
7321 
7322 /* Set the sizes of the dynamic sections.  */
7323 
7324 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_size_dynamic_sections(bfd * output_bfd,struct bfd_link_info * info)7325 _bfd_mips_elf_size_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
7326 				     struct bfd_link_info *info)
7327 {
7328   bfd *dynobj;
7329   asection *s, *sreldyn;
7330   bfd_boolean reltext;
7331   struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
7332 
7333   htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
7334   dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
7335   BFD_ASSERT (dynobj != NULL);
7336 
7337   if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
7338     {
7339       /* Set the contents of the .interp section to the interpreter.  */
7340       if (info->executable)
7341 	{
7342 	  s = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".interp");
7343 	  BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
7344 	  s->size
7345 	    = strlen (ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER (output_bfd)) + 1;
7346 	  s->contents
7347 	    = (bfd_byte *) ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER (output_bfd);
7348 	}
7349     }
7350 
7351   /* The check_relocs and adjust_dynamic_symbol entry points have
7352      determined the sizes of the various dynamic sections.  Allocate
7353      memory for them.  */
7354   reltext = FALSE;
7355   sreldyn = NULL;
7356   for (s = dynobj->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
7357     {
7358       const char *name;
7359 
7360       /* It's OK to base decisions on the section name, because none
7361 	 of the dynobj section names depend upon the input files.  */
7362       name = bfd_get_section_name (dynobj, s);
7363 
7364       if ((s->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) == 0)
7365 	continue;
7366 
7367       if (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".rel"))
7368 	{
7369 	  if (s->size != 0)
7370 	    {
7371 	      const char *outname;
7372 	      asection *target;
7373 
7374 	      /* If this relocation section applies to a read only
7375                  section, then we probably need a DT_TEXTREL entry.
7376                  If the relocation section is .rel(a).dyn, we always
7377                  assert a DT_TEXTREL entry rather than testing whether
7378                  there exists a relocation to a read only section or
7379                  not.  */
7380 	      outname = bfd_get_section_name (output_bfd,
7381 					      s->output_section);
7382 	      target = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, outname + 4);
7383 	      if ((target != NULL
7384 		   && (target->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0
7385 		   && (target->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
7386 		  || strcmp (outname, MIPS_ELF_REL_DYN_NAME (info)) == 0)
7387 		reltext = TRUE;
7388 
7389 	      /* We use the reloc_count field as a counter if we need
7390 		 to copy relocs into the output file.  */
7391 	      if (strcmp (name, MIPS_ELF_REL_DYN_NAME (info)) != 0)
7392 		s->reloc_count = 0;
7393 
7394 	      /* If combreloc is enabled, elf_link_sort_relocs() will
7395 		 sort relocations, but in a different way than we do,
7396 		 and before we're done creating relocations.  Also, it
7397 		 will move them around between input sections'
7398 		 relocation's contents, so our sorting would be
7399 		 broken, so don't let it run.  */
7400 	      info->combreloc = 0;
7401 	    }
7402 	}
7403       else if (htab->is_vxworks && strcmp (name, ".got") == 0)
7404 	{
7405 	  /* Executables do not need a GOT.  */
7406 	  if (info->shared)
7407 	    {
7408 	      /* Allocate relocations for all but the reserved entries.  */
7409 	      struct mips_got_info *g;
7410 	      unsigned int count;
7411 
7412 	      g = mips_elf_got_info (dynobj, NULL);
7413 	      count = (g->global_gotno
7414 		       + g->local_gotno
7415 		       - MIPS_RESERVED_GOTNO (info));
7416 	      mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations (dynobj, info, count);
7417 	    }
7418 	}
7419       else if (!htab->is_vxworks && CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".got"))
7420 	{
7421 	  /* _bfd_mips_elf_always_size_sections() has already done
7422 	     most of the work, but some symbols may have been mapped
7423 	     to versions that we must now resolve in the got_entries
7424 	     hash tables.  */
7425 	  struct mips_got_info *gg = mips_elf_got_info (dynobj, NULL);
7426 	  struct mips_got_info *g = gg;
7427 	  struct mips_elf_set_global_got_offset_arg set_got_offset_arg;
7428 	  unsigned int needed_relocs = 0;
7429 
7430 	  if (gg->next)
7431 	    {
7432 	      set_got_offset_arg.value = MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd);
7433 	      set_got_offset_arg.info = info;
7434 
7435 	      /* NOTE 2005-02-03: How can this call, or the next, ever
7436 		 find any indirect entries to resolve?  They were all
7437 		 resolved in mips_elf_multi_got.  */
7438 	      mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entries (gg);
7439 	      for (g = gg->next; g && g->next != gg; g = g->next)
7440 		{
7441 		  unsigned int save_assign;
7442 
7443 		  mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entries (g);
7444 
7445 		  /* Assign offsets to global GOT entries.  */
7446 		  save_assign = g->assigned_gotno;
7447 		  g->assigned_gotno = g->local_gotno;
7448 		  set_got_offset_arg.g = g;
7449 		  set_got_offset_arg.needed_relocs = 0;
7450 		  htab_traverse (g->got_entries,
7451 				 mips_elf_set_global_got_offset,
7452 				 &set_got_offset_arg);
7453 		  needed_relocs += set_got_offset_arg.needed_relocs;
7454 		  BFD_ASSERT (g->assigned_gotno - g->local_gotno
7455 			      <= g->global_gotno);
7456 
7457 		  g->assigned_gotno = save_assign;
7458 		  if (info->shared)
7459 		    {
7460 		      needed_relocs += g->local_gotno - g->assigned_gotno;
7461 		      BFD_ASSERT (g->assigned_gotno == g->next->local_gotno
7462 				  + g->next->global_gotno
7463 				  + g->next->tls_gotno
7464 				  + MIPS_RESERVED_GOTNO (info));
7465 		    }
7466 		}
7467 	    }
7468 	  else
7469 	    {
7470 	      struct mips_elf_count_tls_arg arg;
7471 	      arg.info = info;
7472 	      arg.needed = 0;
7473 
7474 	      htab_traverse (gg->got_entries, mips_elf_count_local_tls_relocs,
7475 			     &arg);
7476 	      elf_link_hash_traverse (elf_hash_table (info),
7477 				      mips_elf_count_global_tls_relocs,
7478 				      &arg);
7479 
7480 	      needed_relocs += arg.needed;
7481 	    }
7482 
7483 	  if (needed_relocs)
7484 	    mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations (dynobj, info,
7485 						   needed_relocs);
7486 	}
7487       else if (strcmp (name, MIPS_ELF_STUB_SECTION_NAME (output_bfd)) == 0)
7488 	{
7489 	  /* IRIX rld assumes that the function stub isn't at the end
7490 	     of .text section.  So put a dummy.  XXX  */
7491 	  s->size += htab->function_stub_size;
7492 	}
7493       else if (! info->shared
7494 	       && ! mips_elf_hash_table (info)->use_rld_obj_head
7495 	       && CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".rld_map"))
7496 	{
7497 	  /* We add a room for __rld_map.  It will be filled in by the
7498 	     rtld to contain a pointer to the _r_debug structure.  */
7499 	  s->size += MIPS_ELF_RLD_MAP_SIZE (output_bfd);
7500 	}
7501       else if (SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd)
7502 	       && CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".compact_rel"))
7503 	s->size += mips_elf_hash_table (info)->compact_rel_size;
7504       else if (! CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".init")
7505 	       && s != htab->sgotplt
7506 	       && s != htab->splt)
7507 	{
7508 	  /* It's not one of our sections, so don't allocate space.  */
7509 	  continue;
7510 	}
7511 
7512       if (s->size == 0)
7513 	{
7514 	  s->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
7515 	  continue;
7516 	}
7517 
7518       if ((s->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) == 0)
7519 	continue;
7520 
7521       /* Allocate memory for this section last, since we may increase its
7522 	 size above.  */
7523       if (strcmp (name, MIPS_ELF_REL_DYN_NAME (info)) == 0)
7524 	{
7525 	  sreldyn = s;
7526 	  continue;
7527 	}
7528 
7529       /* Allocate memory for the section contents.  */
7530       s->contents = bfd_zalloc (dynobj, s->size);
7531       if (s->contents == NULL)
7532 	{
7533 	  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_no_memory);
7534 	  return FALSE;
7535 	}
7536     }
7537 
7538   /* Allocate memory for the .rel(a).dyn section.  */
7539   if (sreldyn != NULL)
7540     {
7541       sreldyn->contents = bfd_zalloc (dynobj, sreldyn->size);
7542       if (sreldyn->contents == NULL)
7543 	{
7544 	  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_no_memory);
7545 	  return FALSE;
7546 	}
7547     }
7548 
7549   if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
7550     {
7551       /* Add some entries to the .dynamic section.  We fill in the
7552 	 values later, in _bfd_mips_elf_finish_dynamic_sections, but we
7553 	 must add the entries now so that we get the correct size for
7554 	 the .dynamic section.  */
7555 
7556       /* SGI object has the equivalence of DT_DEBUG in the
7557 	 DT_MIPS_RLD_MAP entry.  This must come first because glibc
7558 	 only fills in DT_MIPS_RLD_MAP (not DT_DEBUG) and GDB only
7559 	 looks at the first one it sees.  */
7560       if (!info->shared
7561 	  && !MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_RLD_MAP, 0))
7562 	return FALSE;
7563 
7564       /* The DT_DEBUG entry may be filled in by the dynamic linker and
7565 	 used by the debugger.  */
7566       if (info->executable
7567 	  && !SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd)
7568 	  && !MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_DEBUG, 0))
7569 	return FALSE;
7570 
7571       if (reltext && (SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd) || htab->is_vxworks))
7572 	info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
7573 
7574       if ((info->flags & DF_TEXTREL) != 0)
7575 	{
7576 	  if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_TEXTREL, 0))
7577 	    return FALSE;
7578 
7579 	  /* Clear the DF_TEXTREL flag.  It will be set again if we
7580 	     write out an actual text relocation; we may not, because
7581 	     at this point we do not know whether e.g. any .eh_frame
7582 	     absolute relocations have been converted to PC-relative.  */
7583 	  info->flags &= ~DF_TEXTREL;
7584 	}
7585 
7586       if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_PLTGOT, 0))
7587 	return FALSE;
7588 
7589       if (htab->is_vxworks)
7590 	{
7591 	  /* VxWorks uses .rela.dyn instead of .rel.dyn.  It does not
7592 	     use any of the DT_MIPS_* tags.  */
7593 	  if (mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE))
7594 	    {
7595 	      if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_RELA, 0))
7596 		return FALSE;
7597 
7598 	      if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_RELASZ, 0))
7599 		return FALSE;
7600 
7601 	      if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_RELAENT, 0))
7602 		return FALSE;
7603 	    }
7604 	  if (htab->splt->size > 0)
7605 	    {
7606 	      if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_PLTREL, 0))
7607 		return FALSE;
7608 
7609 	      if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_JMPREL, 0))
7610 		return FALSE;
7611 
7612 	      if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_PLTRELSZ, 0))
7613 		return FALSE;
7614 	    }
7615 	}
7616       else
7617 	{
7618 	  if (mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE))
7619 	    {
7620 	      if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_REL, 0))
7621 		return FALSE;
7622 
7623 	      if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_RELSZ, 0))
7624 		return FALSE;
7625 
7626 	      if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_RELENT, 0))
7627 		return FALSE;
7628 	    }
7629 
7630 	  if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_RLD_VERSION, 0))
7631 	    return FALSE;
7632 
7633 	  if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_FLAGS, 0))
7634 	    return FALSE;
7635 
7636 	  if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_BASE_ADDRESS, 0))
7637 	    return FALSE;
7638 
7639 	  if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_LOCAL_GOTNO, 0))
7640 	    return FALSE;
7641 
7642 	  if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_SYMTABNO, 0))
7643 	    return FALSE;
7644 
7645 	  if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_UNREFEXTNO, 0))
7646 	    return FALSE;
7647 
7648 	  if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_GOTSYM, 0))
7649 	    return FALSE;
7650 
7651 	  if (IRIX_COMPAT (dynobj) == ict_irix5
7652 	      && ! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_HIPAGENO, 0))
7653 	    return FALSE;
7654 
7655 	  if (IRIX_COMPAT (dynobj) == ict_irix6
7656 	      && (bfd_get_section_by_name
7657 		  (dynobj, MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME (dynobj)))
7658 	      && !MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_OPTIONS, 0))
7659 	    return FALSE;
7660 	}
7661     }
7662 
7663   return TRUE;
7664 }
7665 
7666 /* REL is a relocation in INPUT_BFD that is being copied to OUTPUT_BFD.
7667    Adjust its R_ADDEND field so that it is correct for the output file.
7668    LOCAL_SYMS and LOCAL_SECTIONS are arrays of INPUT_BFD's local symbols
7669    and sections respectively; both use symbol indexes.  */
7670 
7671 static void
mips_elf_adjust_addend(bfd * output_bfd,struct bfd_link_info * info,bfd * input_bfd,Elf_Internal_Sym * local_syms,asection ** local_sections,Elf_Internal_Rela * rel)7672 mips_elf_adjust_addend (bfd *output_bfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
7673 			bfd *input_bfd, Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms,
7674 			asection **local_sections, Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
7675 {
7676   unsigned int r_type, r_symndx;
7677   Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
7678   asection *sec;
7679 
7680   if (mips_elf_local_relocation_p (input_bfd, rel, local_sections, FALSE))
7681     {
7682       r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (output_bfd, rel->r_info);
7683       if (r_type == R_MIPS16_GPREL
7684 	  || r_type == R_MIPS_GPREL16
7685 	  || r_type == R_MIPS_GPREL32
7686 	  || r_type == R_MIPS_LITERAL)
7687 	{
7688 	  rel->r_addend += _bfd_get_gp_value (input_bfd);
7689 	  rel->r_addend -= _bfd_get_gp_value (output_bfd);
7690 	}
7691 
7692       r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (output_bfd, rel->r_info);
7693       sym = local_syms + r_symndx;
7694 
7695       /* Adjust REL's addend to account for section merging.  */
7696       if (!info->relocatable)
7697 	{
7698 	  sec = local_sections[r_symndx];
7699 	  _bfd_elf_rela_local_sym (output_bfd, sym, &sec, rel);
7700 	}
7701 
7702       /* This would normally be done by the rela_normal code in elflink.c.  */
7703       if (ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_SECTION)
7704 	rel->r_addend += local_sections[r_symndx]->output_offset;
7705     }
7706 }
7707 
7708 /* Relocate a MIPS ELF section.  */
7709 
7710 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_relocate_section(bfd * output_bfd,struct bfd_link_info * info,bfd * input_bfd,asection * input_section,bfd_byte * contents,Elf_Internal_Rela * relocs,Elf_Internal_Sym * local_syms,asection ** local_sections)7711 _bfd_mips_elf_relocate_section (bfd *output_bfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
7712 				bfd *input_bfd, asection *input_section,
7713 				bfd_byte *contents, Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs,
7714 				Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms,
7715 				asection **local_sections)
7716 {
7717   Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
7718   const Elf_Internal_Rela *relend;
7719   bfd_vma addend = 0;
7720   bfd_boolean use_saved_addend_p = FALSE;
7721   const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
7722 
7723   bed = get_elf_backend_data (output_bfd);
7724   relend = relocs + input_section->reloc_count * bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel;
7725   for (rel = relocs; rel < relend; ++rel)
7726     {
7727       const char *name;
7728       bfd_vma value = 0;
7729       reloc_howto_type *howto;
7730       bfd_boolean require_jalx;
7731       /* TRUE if the relocation is a RELA relocation, rather than a
7732          REL relocation.  */
7733       bfd_boolean rela_relocation_p = TRUE;
7734       unsigned int r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (output_bfd, rel->r_info);
7735       const char *msg;
7736       unsigned long r_symndx;
7737       asection *sec;
7738       Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
7739       struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
7740 
7741       /* Find the relocation howto for this relocation.  */
7742       howto = MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO (input_bfd, r_type,
7743 				       NEWABI_P (input_bfd)
7744 				       && (MIPS_RELOC_RELA_P
7745 					   (input_bfd, input_section,
7746 					    rel - relocs)));
7747 
7748       r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (input_bfd, rel->r_info);
7749       symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (input_bfd)->symtab_hdr;
7750       if (mips_elf_local_relocation_p (input_bfd, rel, local_sections, FALSE))
7751 	{
7752 	  sec = local_sections[r_symndx];
7753 	  h = NULL;
7754 	}
7755       else
7756 	{
7757 	  unsigned long extsymoff;
7758 
7759 	  extsymoff = 0;
7760 	  if (!elf_bad_symtab (input_bfd))
7761 	    extsymoff = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
7762 	  h = elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd) [r_symndx - extsymoff];
7763 	  while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
7764 		 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
7765 	    h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
7766 
7767 	  sec = NULL;
7768 	  if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
7769 	      || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
7770 	    sec = h->root.u.def.section;
7771 	}
7772 
7773       if (sec != NULL && elf_discarded_section (sec))
7774 	{
7775 	  /* For relocs against symbols from removed linkonce sections,
7776 	     or sections discarded by a linker script, we just want the
7777 	     section contents zeroed.  Avoid any special processing.  */
7778 	  _bfd_clear_contents (howto, input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
7779 	  rel->r_info = 0;
7780 	  rel->r_addend = 0;
7781 	  continue;
7782 	}
7783 
7784       if (r_type == R_MIPS_64 && ! NEWABI_P (input_bfd))
7785 	{
7786 	  /* Some 32-bit code uses R_MIPS_64.  In particular, people use
7787 	     64-bit code, but make sure all their addresses are in the
7788 	     lowermost or uppermost 32-bit section of the 64-bit address
7789 	     space.  Thus, when they use an R_MIPS_64 they mean what is
7790 	     usually meant by R_MIPS_32, with the exception that the
7791 	     stored value is sign-extended to 64 bits.  */
7792 	  howto = MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO (input_bfd, R_MIPS_32, FALSE);
7793 
7794 	  /* On big-endian systems, we need to lie about the position
7795 	     of the reloc.  */
7796 	  if (bfd_big_endian (input_bfd))
7797 	    rel->r_offset += 4;
7798 	}
7799 
7800       if (!use_saved_addend_p)
7801 	{
7802 	  Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
7803 
7804 	  /* If these relocations were originally of the REL variety,
7805 	     we must pull the addend out of the field that will be
7806 	     relocated.  Otherwise, we simply use the contents of the
7807 	     RELA relocation.  To determine which flavor or relocation
7808 	     this is, we depend on the fact that the INPUT_SECTION's
7809 	     REL_HDR is read before its REL_HDR2.  */
7810 	  rel_hdr = &elf_section_data (input_section)->rel_hdr;
7811 	  if ((size_t) (rel - relocs)
7812 	      >= (NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (rel_hdr) * bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel))
7813 	    rel_hdr = elf_section_data (input_section)->rel_hdr2;
7814 	  if (rel_hdr->sh_entsize == MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (input_bfd))
7815 	    {
7816 	      bfd_byte *location = contents + rel->r_offset;
7817 
7818 	      /* Note that this is a REL relocation.  */
7819 	      rela_relocation_p = FALSE;
7820 
7821 	      /* Get the addend, which is stored in the input file.  */
7822 	      _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_unshuffle (input_bfd, r_type, FALSE,
7823 					       location);
7824 	      addend = mips_elf_obtain_contents (howto, rel, input_bfd,
7825 						 contents);
7826 	      _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_shuffle(input_bfd, r_type, FALSE,
7827 					    location);
7828 
7829 	      addend &= howto->src_mask;
7830 
7831 	      /* For some kinds of relocations, the ADDEND is a
7832 		 combination of the addend stored in two different
7833 		 relocations.   */
7834 	      if (r_type == R_MIPS_HI16 || r_type == R_MIPS16_HI16
7835 		  || (r_type == R_MIPS_GOT16
7836 		      && mips_elf_local_relocation_p (input_bfd, rel,
7837 						      local_sections, FALSE)))
7838 		{
7839 		  const Elf_Internal_Rela *lo16_relocation;
7840 		  reloc_howto_type *lo16_howto;
7841 		  int lo16_type;
7842 
7843 		  if (r_type == R_MIPS16_HI16)
7844 		    lo16_type = R_MIPS16_LO16;
7845 		  else
7846 		    lo16_type = R_MIPS_LO16;
7847 
7848 		  /* The combined value is the sum of the HI16 addend,
7849 		     left-shifted by sixteen bits, and the LO16
7850 		     addend, sign extended.  (Usually, the code does
7851 		     a `lui' of the HI16 value, and then an `addiu' of
7852 		     the LO16 value.)
7853 
7854 		     Scan ahead to find a matching LO16 relocation.
7855 
7856 		     According to the MIPS ELF ABI, the R_MIPS_LO16
7857 		     relocation must be immediately following.
7858 		     However, for the IRIX6 ABI, the next relocation
7859 		     may be a composed relocation consisting of
7860 		     several relocations for the same address.  In
7861 		     that case, the R_MIPS_LO16 relocation may occur
7862 		     as one of these.  We permit a similar extension
7863 		     in general, as that is useful for GCC.
7864 
7865 		     In some cases GCC dead code elimination removes
7866 		     the LO16 but keeps the corresponding HI16.  This
7867 		     is strictly speaking a violation of the ABI but
7868 		     not immediately harmful.  */
7869 		  lo16_relocation = mips_elf_next_relocation (input_bfd,
7870 							      lo16_type,
7871 							      rel, relend);
7872 		  if (lo16_relocation == NULL)
7873 		    {
7874 		      const char *name;
7875 
7876 		      if (h)
7877 			name = h->root.root.string;
7878 		      else
7879 			name = bfd_elf_sym_name (input_bfd, symtab_hdr,
7880 						 local_syms + r_symndx,
7881 						 sec);
7882 		      (*_bfd_error_handler)
7883 			(_("%B: Can't find matching LO16 reloc against `%s' for %s at 0x%lx in section `%A'"),
7884 			 input_bfd, input_section, name, howto->name,
7885 			 rel->r_offset);
7886 		    }
7887 		  else
7888 		    {
7889 		      bfd_byte *lo16_location;
7890 		      bfd_vma l;
7891 
7892 		      lo16_location = contents + lo16_relocation->r_offset;
7893 
7894 		      /* Obtain the addend kept there.  */
7895 		      lo16_howto = MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO (input_bfd,
7896 							    lo16_type, FALSE);
7897 		      _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_unshuffle (input_bfd, lo16_type,
7898 						       FALSE, lo16_location);
7899 		      l = mips_elf_obtain_contents (lo16_howto,
7900 						    lo16_relocation,
7901 						    input_bfd, contents);
7902 		      _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_shuffle (input_bfd, lo16_type,
7903 						     FALSE, lo16_location);
7904 		      l &= lo16_howto->src_mask;
7905 		      l <<= lo16_howto->rightshift;
7906 		      l = _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (l, 16);
7907 
7908 		      addend <<= 16;
7909 
7910 		      /* Compute the combined addend.  */
7911 		      addend += l;
7912 		    }
7913 		}
7914 	      else
7915 		addend <<= howto->rightshift;
7916 	    }
7917 	  else
7918 	    addend = rel->r_addend;
7919 	  mips_elf_adjust_addend (output_bfd, info, input_bfd,
7920 				  local_syms, local_sections, rel);
7921 	}
7922 
7923       if (info->relocatable)
7924 	{
7925 	  if (r_type == R_MIPS_64 && ! NEWABI_P (output_bfd)
7926 	      && bfd_big_endian (input_bfd))
7927 	    rel->r_offset -= 4;
7928 
7929 	  if (!rela_relocation_p && rel->r_addend)
7930 	    {
7931 	      addend += rel->r_addend;
7932 	      if (r_type == R_MIPS_HI16
7933 		  || r_type == R_MIPS_GOT16)
7934 		addend = mips_elf_high (addend);
7935 	      else if (r_type == R_MIPS_HIGHER)
7936 		addend = mips_elf_higher (addend);
7937 	      else if (r_type == R_MIPS_HIGHEST)
7938 		addend = mips_elf_highest (addend);
7939 	      else
7940 		addend >>= howto->rightshift;
7941 
7942 	      /* We use the source mask, rather than the destination
7943 		 mask because the place to which we are writing will be
7944 		 source of the addend in the final link.  */
7945 	      addend &= howto->src_mask;
7946 
7947 	      if (r_type == R_MIPS_64 && ! NEWABI_P (output_bfd))
7948 		/* See the comment above about using R_MIPS_64 in the 32-bit
7949 		   ABI.  Here, we need to update the addend.  It would be
7950 		   possible to get away with just using the R_MIPS_32 reloc
7951 		   but for endianness.  */
7952 		{
7953 		  bfd_vma sign_bits;
7954 		  bfd_vma low_bits;
7955 		  bfd_vma high_bits;
7956 
7957 		  if (addend & ((bfd_vma) 1 << 31))
7958 #ifdef BFD64
7959 		    sign_bits = ((bfd_vma) 1 << 32) - 1;
7960 #else
7961 		    sign_bits = -1;
7962 #endif
7963 		  else
7964 		    sign_bits = 0;
7965 
7966 		  /* If we don't know that we have a 64-bit type,
7967 		     do two separate stores.  */
7968 		  if (bfd_big_endian (input_bfd))
7969 		    {
7970 		      /* Store the sign-bits (which are most significant)
7971 			 first.  */
7972 		      low_bits = sign_bits;
7973 		      high_bits = addend;
7974 		    }
7975 		  else
7976 		    {
7977 		      low_bits = addend;
7978 		      high_bits = sign_bits;
7979 		    }
7980 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, low_bits,
7981 			      contents + rel->r_offset);
7982 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, high_bits,
7983 			      contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
7984 		  continue;
7985 		}
7986 
7987 	      if (! mips_elf_perform_relocation (info, howto, rel, addend,
7988 						 input_bfd, input_section,
7989 						 contents, FALSE))
7990 		return FALSE;
7991 	    }
7992 
7993 	  /* Go on to the next relocation.  */
7994 	  continue;
7995 	}
7996 
7997       /* In the N32 and 64-bit ABIs there may be multiple consecutive
7998 	 relocations for the same offset.  In that case we are
7999 	 supposed to treat the output of each relocation as the addend
8000 	 for the next.  */
8001       if (rel + 1 < relend
8002 	  && rel->r_offset == rel[1].r_offset
8003 	  && ELF_R_TYPE (input_bfd, rel[1].r_info) != R_MIPS_NONE)
8004 	use_saved_addend_p = TRUE;
8005       else
8006 	use_saved_addend_p = FALSE;
8007 
8008       /* Figure out what value we are supposed to relocate.  */
8009       switch (mips_elf_calculate_relocation (output_bfd, input_bfd,
8010 					     input_section, info, rel,
8011 					     addend, howto, local_syms,
8012 					     local_sections, &value,
8013 					     &name, &require_jalx,
8014 					     use_saved_addend_p))
8015 	{
8016 	case bfd_reloc_continue:
8017 	  /* There's nothing to do.  */
8018 	  continue;
8019 
8020 	case bfd_reloc_undefined:
8021 	  /* mips_elf_calculate_relocation already called the
8022 	     undefined_symbol callback.  There's no real point in
8023 	     trying to perform the relocation at this point, so we
8024 	     just skip ahead to the next relocation.  */
8025 	  continue;
8026 
8027 	case bfd_reloc_notsupported:
8028 	  msg = _("internal error: unsupported relocation error");
8029 	  info->callbacks->warning
8030 	    (info, msg, name, input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset);
8031 	  return FALSE;
8032 
8033 	case bfd_reloc_overflow:
8034 	  if (use_saved_addend_p)
8035 	    /* Ignore overflow until we reach the last relocation for
8036 	       a given location.  */
8037 	    ;
8038 	  else
8039 	    {
8040 	      BFD_ASSERT (name != NULL);
8041 	      if (! ((*info->callbacks->reloc_overflow)
8042 		     (info, NULL, name, howto->name, (bfd_vma) 0,
8043 		      input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset)))
8044 		return FALSE;
8045 	    }
8046 	  break;
8047 
8048 	case bfd_reloc_ok:
8049 	  break;
8050 
8051 	default:
8052 	  abort ();
8053 	  break;
8054 	}
8055 
8056       /* If we've got another relocation for the address, keep going
8057 	 until we reach the last one.  */
8058       if (use_saved_addend_p)
8059 	{
8060 	  addend = value;
8061 	  continue;
8062 	}
8063 
8064       if (r_type == R_MIPS_64 && ! NEWABI_P (output_bfd))
8065 	/* See the comment above about using R_MIPS_64 in the 32-bit
8066 	   ABI.  Until now, we've been using the HOWTO for R_MIPS_32;
8067 	   that calculated the right value.  Now, however, we
8068 	   sign-extend the 32-bit result to 64-bits, and store it as a
8069 	   64-bit value.  We are especially generous here in that we
8070 	   go to extreme lengths to support this usage on systems with
8071 	   only a 32-bit VMA.  */
8072 	{
8073 	  bfd_vma sign_bits;
8074 	  bfd_vma low_bits;
8075 	  bfd_vma high_bits;
8076 
8077 	  if (value & ((bfd_vma) 1 << 31))
8078 #ifdef BFD64
8079 	    sign_bits = ((bfd_vma) 1 << 32) - 1;
8080 #else
8081 	    sign_bits = -1;
8082 #endif
8083 	  else
8084 	    sign_bits = 0;
8085 
8086 	  /* If we don't know that we have a 64-bit type,
8087 	     do two separate stores.  */
8088 	  if (bfd_big_endian (input_bfd))
8089 	    {
8090 	      /* Undo what we did above.  */
8091 	      rel->r_offset -= 4;
8092 	      /* Store the sign-bits (which are most significant)
8093 		 first.  */
8094 	      low_bits = sign_bits;
8095 	      high_bits = value;
8096 	    }
8097 	  else
8098 	    {
8099 	      low_bits = value;
8100 	      high_bits = sign_bits;
8101 	    }
8102 	  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, low_bits,
8103 		      contents + rel->r_offset);
8104 	  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, high_bits,
8105 		      contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
8106 	  continue;
8107 	}
8108 
8109       /* Actually perform the relocation.  */
8110       if (! mips_elf_perform_relocation (info, howto, rel, value,
8111 					 input_bfd, input_section,
8112 					 contents, require_jalx))
8113 	return FALSE;
8114     }
8115 
8116   return TRUE;
8117 }
8118 
8119 /* If NAME is one of the special IRIX6 symbols defined by the linker,
8120    adjust it appropriately now.  */
8121 
8122 static void
mips_elf_irix6_finish_dynamic_symbol(bfd * abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,const char * name,Elf_Internal_Sym * sym)8123 mips_elf_irix6_finish_dynamic_symbol (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8124 				      const char *name, Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
8125 {
8126   /* The linker script takes care of providing names and values for
8127      these, but we must place them into the right sections.  */
8128   static const char* const text_section_symbols[] = {
8129     "_ftext",
8130     "_etext",
8131     "__dso_displacement",
8132     "__elf_header",
8133     "__program_header_table",
8134     NULL
8135   };
8136 
8137   static const char* const data_section_symbols[] = {
8138     "_fdata",
8139     "_edata",
8140     "_end",
8141     "_fbss",
8142     NULL
8143   };
8144 
8145   const char* const *p;
8146   int i;
8147 
8148   for (i = 0; i < 2; ++i)
8149     for (p = (i == 0) ? text_section_symbols : data_section_symbols;
8150 	 *p;
8151 	 ++p)
8152       if (strcmp (*p, name) == 0)
8153 	{
8154 	  /* All of these symbols are given type STT_SECTION by the
8155 	     IRIX6 linker.  */
8156 	  sym->st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
8157 	  sym->st_other = STO_PROTECTED;
8158 
8159 	  /* The IRIX linker puts these symbols in special sections.  */
8160 	  if (i == 0)
8161 	    sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_TEXT;
8162 	  else
8163 	    sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_DATA;
8164 
8165 	  break;
8166 	}
8167 }
8168 
8169 /* Finish up dynamic symbol handling.  We set the contents of various
8170    dynamic sections here.  */
8171 
8172 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol(bfd * output_bfd,struct bfd_link_info * info,struct elf_link_hash_entry * h,Elf_Internal_Sym * sym)8173 _bfd_mips_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol (bfd *output_bfd,
8174 				     struct bfd_link_info *info,
8175 				     struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
8176 				     Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
8177 {
8178   bfd *dynobj;
8179   asection *sgot;
8180   struct mips_got_info *g, *gg;
8181   const char *name;
8182   int idx;
8183   struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
8184 
8185   htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
8186   dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
8187 
8188   if (h->plt.offset != MINUS_ONE)
8189     {
8190       asection *s;
8191       bfd_byte stub[MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_BIG_SIZE];
8192 
8193       /* This symbol has a stub.  Set it up.  */
8194 
8195       BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1);
8196 
8197       s = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj,
8198 				   MIPS_ELF_STUB_SECTION_NAME (dynobj));
8199       BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
8200 
8201       BFD_ASSERT ((htab->function_stub_size == MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_BIG_SIZE)
8202                   || (h->dynindx <= 0xffff));
8203 
8204       /* Values up to 2^31 - 1 are allowed.  Larger values would cause
8205 	 sign extension at runtime in the stub, resulting in a negative
8206 	 index value.  */
8207       if (h->dynindx & ~0x7fffffff)
8208 	return FALSE;
8209 
8210       /* Fill the stub.  */
8211       idx = 0;
8212       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_LW (output_bfd), stub + idx);
8213       idx += 4;
8214       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_MOVE (output_bfd), stub + idx);
8215       idx += 4;
8216       if (htab->function_stub_size == MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_BIG_SIZE)
8217         {
8218           bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_LUI ((h->dynindx >> 16) & 0x7fff),
8219                       stub + idx);
8220           idx += 4;
8221         }
8222       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_JALR, stub + idx);
8223       idx += 4;
8224 
8225       /* If a large stub is not required and sign extension is not a
8226          problem, then use legacy code in the stub.  */
8227       if (htab->function_stub_size == MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_BIG_SIZE)
8228 	bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_ORI (h->dynindx & 0xffff), stub + idx);
8229       else if (h->dynindx & ~0x7fff)
8230         bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_LI16U (h->dynindx & 0xffff), stub + idx);
8231       else
8232         bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_LI16S (output_bfd, h->dynindx),
8233 		    stub + idx);
8234 
8235       BFD_ASSERT (h->plt.offset <= s->size);
8236       memcpy (s->contents + h->plt.offset, stub, htab->function_stub_size);
8237 
8238       /* Mark the symbol as undefined.  plt.offset != -1 occurs
8239 	 only for the referenced symbol.  */
8240       sym->st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
8241 
8242       /* The run-time linker uses the st_value field of the symbol
8243 	 to reset the global offset table entry for this external
8244 	 to its stub address when unlinking a shared object.  */
8245       sym->st_value = (s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset
8246 		       + h->plt.offset);
8247     }
8248 
8249   BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1
8250 	      || h->forced_local);
8251 
8252   sgot = mips_elf_got_section (dynobj, FALSE);
8253   BFD_ASSERT (sgot != NULL);
8254   BFD_ASSERT (mips_elf_section_data (sgot) != NULL);
8255   g = mips_elf_section_data (sgot)->u.got_info;
8256   BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
8257 
8258   /* Run through the global symbol table, creating GOT entries for all
8259      the symbols that need them.  */
8260   if (g->global_gotsym != NULL
8261       && h->dynindx >= g->global_gotsym->dynindx)
8262     {
8263       bfd_vma offset;
8264       bfd_vma value;
8265 
8266       value = sym->st_value;
8267       offset = mips_elf_global_got_index (dynobj, output_bfd, h, R_MIPS_GOT16, info);
8268       MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, value, sgot->contents + offset);
8269     }
8270 
8271   if (g->next && h->dynindx != -1 && h->type != STT_TLS)
8272     {
8273       struct mips_got_entry e, *p;
8274       bfd_vma entry;
8275       bfd_vma offset;
8276 
8277       gg = g;
8278 
8279       e.abfd = output_bfd;
8280       e.symndx = -1;
8281       e.d.h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)h;
8282       e.tls_type = 0;
8283 
8284       for (g = g->next; g->next != gg; g = g->next)
8285 	{
8286 	  if (g->got_entries
8287 	      && (p = (struct mips_got_entry *) htab_find (g->got_entries,
8288 							   &e)))
8289 	    {
8290 	      offset = p->gotidx;
8291 	      if (info->shared
8292 		  || (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created
8293 		      && p->d.h != NULL
8294 		      && p->d.h->root.def_dynamic
8295 		      && !p->d.h->root.def_regular))
8296 		{
8297 		  /* Create an R_MIPS_REL32 relocation for this entry.  Due to
8298 		     the various compatibility problems, it's easier to mock
8299 		     up an R_MIPS_32 or R_MIPS_64 relocation and leave
8300 		     mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation to calculate the
8301 		     appropriate addend.  */
8302 		  Elf_Internal_Rela rel[3];
8303 
8304 		  memset (rel, 0, sizeof (rel));
8305 		  if (ABI_64_P (output_bfd))
8306 		    rel[0].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, 0, R_MIPS_64);
8307 		  else
8308 		    rel[0].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, 0, R_MIPS_32);
8309 		  rel[0].r_offset = rel[1].r_offset = rel[2].r_offset = offset;
8310 
8311 		  entry = 0;
8312 		  if (! (mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation
8313 			 (output_bfd, info, rel,
8314 			  e.d.h, NULL, sym->st_value, &entry, sgot)))
8315 		    return FALSE;
8316 		}
8317 	      else
8318 		entry = sym->st_value;
8319 	      MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, entry, sgot->contents + offset);
8320 	    }
8321 	}
8322     }
8323 
8324   /* Mark _DYNAMIC and _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ as absolute.  */
8325   name = h->root.root.string;
8326   if (strcmp (name, "_DYNAMIC") == 0
8327       || h == elf_hash_table (info)->hgot)
8328     sym->st_shndx = SHN_ABS;
8329   else if (strcmp (name, "_DYNAMIC_LINK") == 0
8330 	   || strcmp (name, "_DYNAMIC_LINKING") == 0)
8331     {
8332       sym->st_shndx = SHN_ABS;
8333       sym->st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
8334       sym->st_value = 1;
8335     }
8336   else if (strcmp (name, "_gp_disp") == 0 && ! NEWABI_P (output_bfd))
8337     {
8338       sym->st_shndx = SHN_ABS;
8339       sym->st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
8340       sym->st_value = elf_gp (output_bfd);
8341     }
8342   else if (SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd))
8343     {
8344       if (strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[0]) == 0
8345 	  || strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[1]) == 0)
8346 	{
8347 	  sym->st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
8348 	  sym->st_other = STO_PROTECTED;
8349 	  sym->st_value = 0;
8350 	  sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_DATA;
8351 	}
8352       else if (strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[2]) == 0)
8353 	{
8354 	  sym->st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
8355 	  sym->st_other = STO_PROTECTED;
8356 	  sym->st_value = mips_elf_hash_table (info)->procedure_count;
8357 	  sym->st_shndx = SHN_ABS;
8358 	}
8359       else if (sym->st_shndx != SHN_UNDEF && sym->st_shndx != SHN_ABS)
8360 	{
8361 	  if (h->type == STT_FUNC)
8362 	    sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_TEXT;
8363 	  else if (h->type == STT_OBJECT)
8364 	    sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_DATA;
8365 	}
8366     }
8367 
8368   /* Handle the IRIX6-specific symbols.  */
8369   if (IRIX_COMPAT (output_bfd) == ict_irix6)
8370     mips_elf_irix6_finish_dynamic_symbol (output_bfd, name, sym);
8371 
8372   if (! info->shared)
8373     {
8374       if (! mips_elf_hash_table (info)->use_rld_obj_head
8375 	  && (strcmp (name, "__rld_map") == 0
8376 	      || strcmp (name, "__RLD_MAP") == 0))
8377 	{
8378 	  asection *s = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".rld_map");
8379 	  BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
8380 	  sym->st_value = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
8381 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, 0, s->contents);
8382 	  if (mips_elf_hash_table (info)->rld_value == 0)
8383 	    mips_elf_hash_table (info)->rld_value = sym->st_value;
8384 	}
8385       else if (mips_elf_hash_table (info)->use_rld_obj_head
8386 	       && strcmp (name, "__rld_obj_head") == 0)
8387 	{
8388 	  /* IRIX6 does not use a .rld_map section.  */
8389 	  if (IRIX_COMPAT (output_bfd) == ict_irix5
8390               || IRIX_COMPAT (output_bfd) == ict_none)
8391 	    BFD_ASSERT (bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".rld_map")
8392 			!= NULL);
8393 	  mips_elf_hash_table (info)->rld_value = sym->st_value;
8394 	}
8395     }
8396 
8397   /* If this is a mips16 symbol, force the value to be even.  */
8398   if (sym->st_other == STO_MIPS16)
8399     sym->st_value &= ~1;
8400 
8401   return TRUE;
8402 }
8403 
8404 /* Likewise, for VxWorks.  */
8405 
8406 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_vxworks_finish_dynamic_symbol(bfd * output_bfd,struct bfd_link_info * info,struct elf_link_hash_entry * h,Elf_Internal_Sym * sym)8407 _bfd_mips_vxworks_finish_dynamic_symbol (bfd *output_bfd,
8408 					 struct bfd_link_info *info,
8409 					 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
8410 					 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
8411 {
8412   bfd *dynobj;
8413   asection *sgot;
8414   struct mips_got_info *g;
8415   struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
8416 
8417   htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
8418   dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
8419 
8420   if (h->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
8421     {
8422       bfd_byte *loc;
8423       bfd_vma plt_address, plt_index, got_address, got_offset, branch_offset;
8424       Elf_Internal_Rela rel;
8425       static const bfd_vma *plt_entry;
8426 
8427       BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1);
8428       BFD_ASSERT (htab->splt != NULL);
8429       BFD_ASSERT (h->plt.offset <= htab->splt->size);
8430 
8431       /* Calculate the address of the .plt entry.  */
8432       plt_address = (htab->splt->output_section->vma
8433 		     + htab->splt->output_offset
8434 		     + h->plt.offset);
8435 
8436       /* Calculate the index of the entry.  */
8437       plt_index = ((h->plt.offset - htab->plt_header_size)
8438 		   / htab->plt_entry_size);
8439 
8440       /* Calculate the address of the .got.plt entry.  */
8441       got_address = (htab->sgotplt->output_section->vma
8442 		     + htab->sgotplt->output_offset
8443 		     + plt_index * 4);
8444 
8445       /* Calculate the offset of the .got.plt entry from
8446 	 _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_.  */
8447       got_offset = mips_elf_gotplt_index (info, h);
8448 
8449       /* Calculate the offset for the branch at the start of the PLT
8450 	 entry.  The branch jumps to the beginning of .plt.  */
8451       branch_offset = -(h->plt.offset / 4 + 1) & 0xffff;
8452 
8453       /* Fill in the initial value of the .got.plt entry.  */
8454       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_address,
8455 		  htab->sgotplt->contents + plt_index * 4);
8456 
8457       /* Find out where the .plt entry should go.  */
8458       loc = htab->splt->contents + h->plt.offset;
8459 
8460       if (info->shared)
8461 	{
8462 	  plt_entry = mips_vxworks_shared_plt_entry;
8463 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0] | branch_offset, loc);
8464 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[1] | plt_index, loc + 4);
8465 	}
8466       else
8467 	{
8468 	  bfd_vma got_address_high, got_address_low;
8469 
8470 	  plt_entry = mips_vxworks_exec_plt_entry;
8471 	  got_address_high = ((got_address + 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
8472 	  got_address_low = got_address & 0xffff;
8473 
8474 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0] | branch_offset, loc);
8475 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[1] | plt_index, loc + 4);
8476 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[2] | got_address_high, loc + 8);
8477 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[3] | got_address_low, loc + 12);
8478 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[4], loc + 16);
8479 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[5], loc + 20);
8480 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[6], loc + 24);
8481 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[7], loc + 28);
8482 
8483 	  loc = (htab->srelplt2->contents
8484 		 + (plt_index * 3 + 2) * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
8485 
8486 	  /* Emit a relocation for the .got.plt entry.  */
8487 	  rel.r_offset = got_address;
8488 	  rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->root.hplt->indx, R_MIPS_32);
8489 	  rel.r_addend = h->plt.offset;
8490 	  bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
8491 
8492 	  /* Emit a relocation for the lui of %hi(<.got.plt slot>).  */
8493 	  loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
8494 	  rel.r_offset = plt_address + 8;
8495 	  rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->root.hgot->indx, R_MIPS_HI16);
8496 	  rel.r_addend = got_offset;
8497 	  bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
8498 
8499 	  /* Emit a relocation for the addiu of %lo(<.got.plt slot>).  */
8500 	  loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
8501 	  rel.r_offset += 4;
8502 	  rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->root.hgot->indx, R_MIPS_LO16);
8503 	  bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
8504 	}
8505 
8506       /* Emit an R_MIPS_JUMP_SLOT relocation against the .got.plt entry.  */
8507       loc = htab->srelplt->contents + plt_index * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
8508       rel.r_offset = got_address;
8509       rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_MIPS_JUMP_SLOT);
8510       rel.r_addend = 0;
8511       bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
8512 
8513       if (!h->def_regular)
8514 	sym->st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
8515     }
8516 
8517   BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1 || h->forced_local);
8518 
8519   sgot = mips_elf_got_section (dynobj, FALSE);
8520   BFD_ASSERT (sgot != NULL);
8521   BFD_ASSERT (mips_elf_section_data (sgot) != NULL);
8522   g = mips_elf_section_data (sgot)->u.got_info;
8523   BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
8524 
8525   /* See if this symbol has an entry in the GOT.  */
8526   if (g->global_gotsym != NULL
8527       && h->dynindx >= g->global_gotsym->dynindx)
8528     {
8529       bfd_vma offset;
8530       Elf_Internal_Rela outrel;
8531       bfd_byte *loc;
8532       asection *s;
8533 
8534       /* Install the symbol value in the GOT.   */
8535       offset = mips_elf_global_got_index (dynobj, output_bfd, h,
8536 					  R_MIPS_GOT16, info);
8537       MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, sym->st_value, sgot->contents + offset);
8538 
8539       /* Add a dynamic relocation for it.  */
8540       s = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
8541       loc = s->contents + (s->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
8542       outrel.r_offset = (sgot->output_section->vma
8543 			 + sgot->output_offset
8544 			 + offset);
8545       outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_MIPS_32);
8546       outrel.r_addend = 0;
8547       bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (dynobj, &outrel, loc);
8548     }
8549 
8550   /* Emit a copy reloc, if needed.  */
8551   if (h->needs_copy)
8552     {
8553       Elf_Internal_Rela rel;
8554 
8555       BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1);
8556 
8557       rel.r_offset = (h->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma
8558 		      + h->root.u.def.section->output_offset
8559 		      + h->root.u.def.value);
8560       rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_MIPS_COPY);
8561       rel.r_addend = 0;
8562       bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rel,
8563 				 htab->srelbss->contents
8564 				 + (htab->srelbss->reloc_count
8565 				    * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela)));
8566       ++htab->srelbss->reloc_count;
8567     }
8568 
8569   /* If this is a mips16 symbol, force the value to be even.  */
8570   if (sym->st_other == STO_MIPS16)
8571     sym->st_value &= ~1;
8572 
8573   return TRUE;
8574 }
8575 
8576 /* Install the PLT header for a VxWorks executable and finalize the
8577    contents of .rela.plt.unloaded.  */
8578 
8579 static void
mips_vxworks_finish_exec_plt(bfd * output_bfd,struct bfd_link_info * info)8580 mips_vxworks_finish_exec_plt (bfd *output_bfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
8581 {
8582   Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
8583   bfd_byte *loc;
8584   bfd_vma got_value, got_value_high, got_value_low, plt_address;
8585   static const bfd_vma *plt_entry;
8586   struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
8587 
8588   htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
8589   plt_entry = mips_vxworks_exec_plt0_entry;
8590 
8591   /* Calculate the value of _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_.  */
8592   got_value = (htab->root.hgot->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma
8593 	       + htab->root.hgot->root.u.def.section->output_offset
8594 	       + htab->root.hgot->root.u.def.value);
8595 
8596   got_value_high = ((got_value + 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
8597   got_value_low = got_value & 0xffff;
8598 
8599   /* Calculate the address of the PLT header.  */
8600   plt_address = htab->splt->output_section->vma + htab->splt->output_offset;
8601 
8602   /* Install the PLT header.  */
8603   loc = htab->splt->contents;
8604   bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0] | got_value_high, loc);
8605   bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[1] | got_value_low, loc + 4);
8606   bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[2], loc + 8);
8607   bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[3], loc + 12);
8608   bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[4], loc + 16);
8609   bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[5], loc + 20);
8610 
8611   /* Output the relocation for the lui of %hi(_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_).  */
8612   loc = htab->srelplt2->contents;
8613   rela.r_offset = plt_address;
8614   rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->root.hgot->indx, R_MIPS_HI16);
8615   rela.r_addend = 0;
8616   bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc);
8617   loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
8618 
8619   /* Output the relocation for the following addiu of
8620      %lo(_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_).  */
8621   rela.r_offset += 4;
8622   rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->root.hgot->indx, R_MIPS_LO16);
8623   bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc);
8624   loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
8625 
8626   /* Fix up the remaining relocations.  They may have the wrong
8627      symbol index for _G_O_T_ or _P_L_T_ depending on the order
8628      in which symbols were output.  */
8629   while (loc < htab->srelplt2->contents + htab->srelplt2->size)
8630     {
8631       Elf_Internal_Rela rel;
8632 
8633       bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
8634       rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->root.hplt->indx, R_MIPS_32);
8635       bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
8636       loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
8637 
8638       bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
8639       rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->root.hgot->indx, R_MIPS_HI16);
8640       bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
8641       loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
8642 
8643       bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
8644       rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->root.hgot->indx, R_MIPS_LO16);
8645       bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
8646       loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
8647     }
8648 }
8649 
8650 /* Install the PLT header for a VxWorks shared library.  */
8651 
8652 static void
mips_vxworks_finish_shared_plt(bfd * output_bfd,struct bfd_link_info * info)8653 mips_vxworks_finish_shared_plt (bfd *output_bfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
8654 {
8655   unsigned int i;
8656   struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
8657 
8658   htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
8659 
8660   /* We just need to copy the entry byte-by-byte.  */
8661   for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (mips_vxworks_shared_plt0_entry); i++)
8662     bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, mips_vxworks_shared_plt0_entry[i],
8663 		htab->splt->contents + i * 4);
8664 }
8665 
8666 /* Finish up the dynamic sections.  */
8667 
8668 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_finish_dynamic_sections(bfd * output_bfd,struct bfd_link_info * info)8669 _bfd_mips_elf_finish_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
8670 				       struct bfd_link_info *info)
8671 {
8672   bfd *dynobj;
8673   asection *sdyn;
8674   asection *sgot;
8675   struct mips_got_info *gg, *g;
8676   struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
8677 
8678   htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
8679   dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
8680 
8681   sdyn = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".dynamic");
8682 
8683   sgot = mips_elf_got_section (dynobj, FALSE);
8684   if (sgot == NULL)
8685     gg = g = NULL;
8686   else
8687     {
8688       BFD_ASSERT (mips_elf_section_data (sgot) != NULL);
8689       gg = mips_elf_section_data (sgot)->u.got_info;
8690       BFD_ASSERT (gg != NULL);
8691       g = mips_elf_got_for_ibfd (gg, output_bfd);
8692       BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
8693     }
8694 
8695   if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
8696     {
8697       bfd_byte *b;
8698       int dyn_to_skip = 0, dyn_skipped = 0;
8699 
8700       BFD_ASSERT (sdyn != NULL);
8701       BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
8702 
8703       for (b = sdyn->contents;
8704 	   b < sdyn->contents + sdyn->size;
8705 	   b += MIPS_ELF_DYN_SIZE (dynobj))
8706 	{
8707 	  Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
8708 	  const char *name;
8709 	  size_t elemsize;
8710 	  asection *s;
8711 	  bfd_boolean swap_out_p;
8712 
8713 	  /* Read in the current dynamic entry.  */
8714 	  (*get_elf_backend_data (dynobj)->s->swap_dyn_in) (dynobj, b, &dyn);
8715 
8716 	  /* Assume that we're going to modify it and write it out.  */
8717 	  swap_out_p = TRUE;
8718 
8719 	  switch (dyn.d_tag)
8720 	    {
8721 	    case DT_RELENT:
8722 	      dyn.d_un.d_val = MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (dynobj);
8723 	      break;
8724 
8725 	    case DT_RELAENT:
8726 	      BFD_ASSERT (htab->is_vxworks);
8727 	      dyn.d_un.d_val = MIPS_ELF_RELA_SIZE (dynobj);
8728 	      break;
8729 
8730 	    case DT_STRSZ:
8731 	      /* Rewrite DT_STRSZ.  */
8732 	      dyn.d_un.d_val =
8733 		_bfd_elf_strtab_size (elf_hash_table (info)->dynstr);
8734 	      break;
8735 
8736 	    case DT_PLTGOT:
8737 	      name = ".got";
8738 	      if (htab->is_vxworks)
8739 		{
8740 		  /* _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ is defined to be the beginning
8741 		     of the ".got" section in DYNOBJ.  */
8742 		  s = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, name);
8743 		  BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
8744 		  dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
8745 		}
8746 	      else
8747 		{
8748 		  s = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, name);
8749 		  BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
8750 		  dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->vma;
8751 		}
8752 	      break;
8753 
8754 	    case DT_MIPS_RLD_VERSION:
8755 	      dyn.d_un.d_val = 1; /* XXX */
8756 	      break;
8757 
8758 	    case DT_MIPS_FLAGS:
8759 	      dyn.d_un.d_val = RHF_NOTPOT; /* XXX */
8760 	      break;
8761 
8762 	    case DT_MIPS_TIME_STAMP:
8763 	      {
8764 		time_t t;
8765 		time (&t);
8766 		dyn.d_un.d_val = t;
8767 	      }
8768 	      break;
8769 
8770 	    case DT_MIPS_ICHECKSUM:
8771 	      /* XXX FIXME: */
8772 	      swap_out_p = FALSE;
8773 	      break;
8774 
8775 	    case DT_MIPS_IVERSION:
8776 	      /* XXX FIXME: */
8777 	      swap_out_p = FALSE;
8778 	      break;
8779 
8780 	    case DT_MIPS_BASE_ADDRESS:
8781 	      s = output_bfd->sections;
8782 	      BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
8783 	      dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->vma & ~(bfd_vma) 0xffff;
8784 	      break;
8785 
8786 	    case DT_MIPS_LOCAL_GOTNO:
8787 	      dyn.d_un.d_val = g->local_gotno;
8788 	      break;
8789 
8790 	    case DT_MIPS_UNREFEXTNO:
8791 	      /* The index into the dynamic symbol table which is the
8792 		 entry of the first external symbol that is not
8793 		 referenced within the same object.  */
8794 	      dyn.d_un.d_val = bfd_count_sections (output_bfd) + 1;
8795 	      break;
8796 
8797 	    case DT_MIPS_GOTSYM:
8798 	      if (gg->global_gotsym)
8799 		{
8800 		  dyn.d_un.d_val = gg->global_gotsym->dynindx;
8801 		  break;
8802 		}
8803 	      /* In case if we don't have global got symbols we default
8804 		 to setting DT_MIPS_GOTSYM to the same value as
8805 		 DT_MIPS_SYMTABNO, so we just fall through.  */
8806 
8807 	    case DT_MIPS_SYMTABNO:
8808 	      name = ".dynsym";
8809 	      elemsize = MIPS_ELF_SYM_SIZE (output_bfd);
8810 	      s = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, name);
8811 	      BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
8812 
8813 	      dyn.d_un.d_val = s->size / elemsize;
8814 	      break;
8815 
8816 	    case DT_MIPS_HIPAGENO:
8817 	      dyn.d_un.d_val = g->local_gotno - MIPS_RESERVED_GOTNO (info);
8818 	      break;
8819 
8820 	    case DT_MIPS_RLD_MAP:
8821 	      dyn.d_un.d_ptr = mips_elf_hash_table (info)->rld_value;
8822 	      break;
8823 
8824 	    case DT_MIPS_OPTIONS:
8825 	      s = (bfd_get_section_by_name
8826 		   (output_bfd, MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME (output_bfd)));
8827 	      dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->vma;
8828 	      break;
8829 
8830 	    case DT_RELASZ:
8831 	      BFD_ASSERT (htab->is_vxworks);
8832 	      /* The count does not include the JUMP_SLOT relocations.  */
8833 	      if (htab->srelplt)
8834 		dyn.d_un.d_val -= htab->srelplt->size;
8835 	      break;
8836 
8837 	    case DT_PLTREL:
8838 	      BFD_ASSERT (htab->is_vxworks);
8839 	      dyn.d_un.d_val = DT_RELA;
8840 	      break;
8841 
8842 	    case DT_PLTRELSZ:
8843 	      BFD_ASSERT (htab->is_vxworks);
8844 	      dyn.d_un.d_val = htab->srelplt->size;
8845 	      break;
8846 
8847 	    case DT_JMPREL:
8848 	      BFD_ASSERT (htab->is_vxworks);
8849 	      dyn.d_un.d_val = (htab->srelplt->output_section->vma
8850 				+ htab->srelplt->output_offset);
8851 	      break;
8852 
8853 	    case DT_TEXTREL:
8854 	      /* If we didn't need any text relocations after all, delete
8855 		 the dynamic tag.  */
8856 	      if (!(info->flags & DF_TEXTREL))
8857 		{
8858 		  dyn_to_skip = MIPS_ELF_DYN_SIZE (dynobj);
8859 		  swap_out_p = FALSE;
8860 		}
8861 	      break;
8862 
8863 	    case DT_FLAGS:
8864 	      /* If we didn't need any text relocations after all, clear
8865 		 DF_TEXTREL from DT_FLAGS.  */
8866 	      if (!(info->flags & DF_TEXTREL))
8867 		dyn.d_un.d_val &= ~DF_TEXTREL;
8868 	      else
8869 		swap_out_p = FALSE;
8870 	      break;
8871 
8872 	    default:
8873 	      swap_out_p = FALSE;
8874 	      break;
8875 	    }
8876 
8877 	  if (swap_out_p || dyn_skipped)
8878 	    (*get_elf_backend_data (dynobj)->s->swap_dyn_out)
8879 	      (dynobj, &dyn, b - dyn_skipped);
8880 
8881 	  if (dyn_to_skip)
8882 	    {
8883 	      dyn_skipped += dyn_to_skip;
8884 	      dyn_to_skip = 0;
8885 	    }
8886 	}
8887 
8888       /* Wipe out any trailing entries if we shifted down a dynamic tag.  */
8889       if (dyn_skipped > 0)
8890 	memset (b - dyn_skipped, 0, dyn_skipped);
8891     }
8892 
8893   if (sgot != NULL && sgot->size > 0)
8894     {
8895       if (htab->is_vxworks)
8896 	{
8897 	  /* The first entry of the global offset table points to the
8898 	     ".dynamic" section.  The second is initialized by the
8899 	     loader and contains the shared library identifier.
8900 	     The third is also initialized by the loader and points
8901 	     to the lazy resolution stub.  */
8902 	  MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd,
8903 			     sdyn->output_offset + sdyn->output_section->vma,
8904 			     sgot->contents);
8905 	  MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, 0,
8906 			     sgot->contents + MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd));
8907 	  MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, 0,
8908 			     sgot->contents
8909 			     + 2 * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd));
8910 	}
8911       else
8912 	{
8913 	  /* The first entry of the global offset table will be filled at
8914 	     runtime. The second entry will be used by some runtime loaders.
8915 	     This isn't the case of IRIX rld.  */
8916 	  MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, (bfd_vma) 0, sgot->contents);
8917 	  MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, (bfd_vma) 0x80000000,
8918 			     sgot->contents + MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd));
8919 	}
8920 
8921       elf_section_data (sgot->output_section)->this_hdr.sh_entsize
8922 	 = MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd);
8923     }
8924 
8925   /* Generate dynamic relocations for the non-primary gots.  */
8926   if (gg != NULL && gg->next)
8927     {
8928       Elf_Internal_Rela rel[3];
8929       bfd_vma addend = 0;
8930 
8931       memset (rel, 0, sizeof (rel));
8932       rel[0].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, 0, R_MIPS_REL32);
8933 
8934       for (g = gg->next; g->next != gg; g = g->next)
8935 	{
8936 	  bfd_vma index = g->next->local_gotno + g->next->global_gotno
8937 	    + g->next->tls_gotno;
8938 
8939 	  MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, 0, sgot->contents
8940 			     + index++ * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd));
8941 	  MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, 0x80000000, sgot->contents
8942 			     + index++ * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd));
8943 
8944 	  if (! info->shared)
8945 	    continue;
8946 
8947 	  while (index < g->assigned_gotno)
8948 	    {
8949 	      rel[0].r_offset = rel[1].r_offset = rel[2].r_offset
8950 		= index++ * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd);
8951 	      if (!(mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation
8952 		    (output_bfd, info, rel, NULL,
8953 		     bfd_abs_section_ptr,
8954 		     0, &addend, sgot)))
8955 		return FALSE;
8956 	      BFD_ASSERT (addend == 0);
8957 	    }
8958 	}
8959     }
8960 
8961   /* The generation of dynamic relocations for the non-primary gots
8962      adds more dynamic relocations.  We cannot count them until
8963      here.  */
8964 
8965   if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
8966     {
8967       bfd_byte *b;
8968       bfd_boolean swap_out_p;
8969 
8970       BFD_ASSERT (sdyn != NULL);
8971 
8972       for (b = sdyn->contents;
8973 	   b < sdyn->contents + sdyn->size;
8974 	   b += MIPS_ELF_DYN_SIZE (dynobj))
8975 	{
8976 	  Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
8977 	  asection *s;
8978 
8979 	  /* Read in the current dynamic entry.  */
8980 	  (*get_elf_backend_data (dynobj)->s->swap_dyn_in) (dynobj, b, &dyn);
8981 
8982 	  /* Assume that we're going to modify it and write it out.  */
8983 	  swap_out_p = TRUE;
8984 
8985 	  switch (dyn.d_tag)
8986 	    {
8987 	    case DT_RELSZ:
8988 	      /* Reduce DT_RELSZ to account for any relocations we
8989 		 decided not to make.  This is for the n64 irix rld,
8990 		 which doesn't seem to apply any relocations if there
8991 		 are trailing null entries.  */
8992 	      s = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
8993 	      dyn.d_un.d_val = (s->reloc_count
8994 				* (ABI_64_P (output_bfd)
8995 				   ? sizeof (Elf64_Mips_External_Rel)
8996 				   : sizeof (Elf32_External_Rel)));
8997 	      /* Adjust the section size too.  Tools like the prelinker
8998 		 can reasonably expect the values to the same.  */
8999 	      elf_section_data (s->output_section)->this_hdr.sh_size
9000 		= dyn.d_un.d_val;
9001 	      break;
9002 
9003 	    default:
9004 	      swap_out_p = FALSE;
9005 	      break;
9006 	    }
9007 
9008 	  if (swap_out_p)
9009 	    (*get_elf_backend_data (dynobj)->s->swap_dyn_out)
9010 	      (dynobj, &dyn, b);
9011 	}
9012     }
9013 
9014   {
9015     asection *s;
9016     Elf32_compact_rel cpt;
9017 
9018     if (SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd))
9019       {
9020 	/* Write .compact_rel section out.  */
9021 	s = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".compact_rel");
9022 	if (s != NULL)
9023 	  {
9024 	    cpt.id1 = 1;
9025 	    cpt.num = s->reloc_count;
9026 	    cpt.id2 = 2;
9027 	    cpt.offset = (s->output_section->filepos
9028 			  + sizeof (Elf32_External_compact_rel));
9029 	    cpt.reserved0 = 0;
9030 	    cpt.reserved1 = 0;
9031 	    bfd_elf32_swap_compact_rel_out (output_bfd, &cpt,
9032 					    ((Elf32_External_compact_rel *)
9033 					     s->contents));
9034 
9035 	    /* Clean up a dummy stub function entry in .text.  */
9036 	    s = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj,
9037 					 MIPS_ELF_STUB_SECTION_NAME (dynobj));
9038 	    if (s != NULL)
9039 	      {
9040 		file_ptr dummy_offset;
9041 
9042 		BFD_ASSERT (s->size >= htab->function_stub_size);
9043 		dummy_offset = s->size - htab->function_stub_size;
9044 		memset (s->contents + dummy_offset, 0,
9045 			htab->function_stub_size);
9046 	      }
9047 	  }
9048       }
9049 
9050     /* The psABI says that the dynamic relocations must be sorted in
9051        increasing order of r_symndx.  The VxWorks EABI doesn't require
9052        this, and because the code below handles REL rather than RELA
9053        relocations, using it for VxWorks would be outright harmful.  */
9054     if (!htab->is_vxworks)
9055       {
9056 	s = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
9057 	if (s != NULL
9058 	    && s->size > (bfd_vma)2 * MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (output_bfd))
9059 	  {
9060 	    reldyn_sorting_bfd = output_bfd;
9061 
9062 	    if (ABI_64_P (output_bfd))
9063 	      qsort ((Elf64_External_Rel *) s->contents + 1,
9064 		     s->reloc_count - 1, sizeof (Elf64_Mips_External_Rel),
9065 		     sort_dynamic_relocs_64);
9066 	    else
9067 	      qsort ((Elf32_External_Rel *) s->contents + 1,
9068 		     s->reloc_count - 1, sizeof (Elf32_External_Rel),
9069 		     sort_dynamic_relocs);
9070 	  }
9071       }
9072   }
9073 
9074   if (htab->is_vxworks && htab->splt->size > 0)
9075     {
9076       if (info->shared)
9077 	mips_vxworks_finish_shared_plt (output_bfd, info);
9078       else
9079 	mips_vxworks_finish_exec_plt (output_bfd, info);
9080     }
9081   return TRUE;
9082 }
9083 
9084 
9085 /* Set ABFD's EF_MIPS_ARCH and EF_MIPS_MACH flags.  */
9086 
9087 static void
mips_set_isa_flags(bfd * abfd)9088 mips_set_isa_flags (bfd *abfd)
9089 {
9090   flagword val;
9091 
9092   switch (bfd_get_mach (abfd))
9093     {
9094     default:
9095     case bfd_mach_mips3000:
9096       val = E_MIPS_ARCH_1;
9097       break;
9098 
9099     case bfd_mach_mips3900:
9100       val = E_MIPS_ARCH_1 | E_MIPS_MACH_3900;
9101       break;
9102 
9103     case bfd_mach_mips6000:
9104       val = E_MIPS_ARCH_2;
9105       break;
9106 
9107     case bfd_mach_mips4000:
9108     case bfd_mach_mips4300:
9109     case bfd_mach_mips4400:
9110     case bfd_mach_mips4600:
9111       val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3;
9112       break;
9113 
9114     case bfd_mach_mips4010:
9115       val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_4010;
9116       break;
9117 
9118     case bfd_mach_mips4100:
9119       val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_4100;
9120       break;
9121 
9122     case bfd_mach_mips4111:
9123       val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_4111;
9124       break;
9125 
9126     case bfd_mach_mips4120:
9127       val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_4120;
9128       break;
9129 
9130     case bfd_mach_mips4650:
9131       val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_4650;
9132       break;
9133 
9134     case bfd_mach_mips5400:
9135       val = E_MIPS_ARCH_4 | E_MIPS_MACH_5400;
9136       break;
9137 
9138     case bfd_mach_mips5500:
9139       val = E_MIPS_ARCH_4 | E_MIPS_MACH_5500;
9140       break;
9141 
9142     case bfd_mach_mips9000:
9143       val = E_MIPS_ARCH_4 | E_MIPS_MACH_9000;
9144       break;
9145 
9146     case bfd_mach_mips5000:
9147     case bfd_mach_mips7000:
9148     case bfd_mach_mips8000:
9149     case bfd_mach_mips10000:
9150     case bfd_mach_mips12000:
9151       val = E_MIPS_ARCH_4;
9152       break;
9153 
9154     case bfd_mach_mips5:
9155       val = E_MIPS_ARCH_5;
9156       break;
9157 
9158     case bfd_mach_mips_octeon:
9159       val = E_MIPS_ARCH_64R2 | E_MIPS_MACH_OCTEON;
9160       break;
9161 
9162     case bfd_mach_mips_sb1:
9163       val = E_MIPS_ARCH_64 | E_MIPS_MACH_SB1;
9164       break;
9165 
9166     case bfd_mach_mipsisa32:
9167       val = E_MIPS_ARCH_32;
9168       break;
9169 
9170     case bfd_mach_mipsisa64:
9171       val = E_MIPS_ARCH_64;
9172       break;
9173 
9174     case bfd_mach_mipsisa32r2:
9175       val = E_MIPS_ARCH_32R2;
9176       break;
9177 
9178     case bfd_mach_mipsisa64r2:
9179       val = E_MIPS_ARCH_64R2;
9180       break;
9181     }
9182   elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags &= ~(EF_MIPS_ARCH | EF_MIPS_MACH);
9183   elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags |= val;
9184 
9185 }
9186 
9187 
9188 /* The final processing done just before writing out a MIPS ELF object
9189    file.  This gets the MIPS architecture right based on the machine
9190    number.  This is used by both the 32-bit and the 64-bit ABI.  */
9191 
9192 void
_bfd_mips_elf_final_write_processing(bfd * abfd,bfd_boolean linker ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)9193 _bfd_mips_elf_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd,
9194 				      bfd_boolean linker ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9195 {
9196   unsigned int i;
9197   Elf_Internal_Shdr **hdrpp;
9198   const char *name;
9199   asection *sec;
9200 
9201   /* Keep the existing EF_MIPS_MACH and EF_MIPS_ARCH flags if the former
9202      is nonzero.  This is for compatibility with old objects, which used
9203      a combination of a 32-bit EF_MIPS_ARCH and a 64-bit EF_MIPS_MACH.  */
9204   if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_MACH) == 0)
9205     mips_set_isa_flags (abfd);
9206 
9207   /* Set the sh_info field for .gptab sections and other appropriate
9208      info for each special section.  */
9209   for (i = 1, hdrpp = elf_elfsections (abfd) + 1;
9210        i < elf_numsections (abfd);
9211        i++, hdrpp++)
9212     {
9213       switch ((*hdrpp)->sh_type)
9214 	{
9215 	case SHT_MIPS_MSYM:
9216 	case SHT_MIPS_LIBLIST:
9217 	  sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynstr");
9218 	  if (sec != NULL)
9219 	    (*hdrpp)->sh_link = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx;
9220 	  break;
9221 
9222 	case SHT_MIPS_GPTAB:
9223 	  BFD_ASSERT ((*hdrpp)->bfd_section != NULL);
9224 	  name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, (*hdrpp)->bfd_section);
9225 	  BFD_ASSERT (name != NULL
9226 		      && CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".gptab."));
9227 	  sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, name + sizeof ".gptab" - 1);
9228 	  BFD_ASSERT (sec != NULL);
9229 	  (*hdrpp)->sh_info = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx;
9230 	  break;
9231 
9232 	case SHT_MIPS_CONTENT:
9233 	  BFD_ASSERT ((*hdrpp)->bfd_section != NULL);
9234 	  name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, (*hdrpp)->bfd_section);
9235 	  BFD_ASSERT (name != NULL
9236 		      && CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.content"));
9237 	  sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd,
9238 					 name + sizeof ".MIPS.content" - 1);
9239 	  BFD_ASSERT (sec != NULL);
9240 	  (*hdrpp)->sh_link = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx;
9241 	  break;
9242 
9243 	case SHT_MIPS_SYMBOL_LIB:
9244 	  sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynsym");
9245 	  if (sec != NULL)
9246 	    (*hdrpp)->sh_link = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx;
9247 	  sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".liblist");
9248 	  if (sec != NULL)
9249 	    (*hdrpp)->sh_info = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx;
9250 	  break;
9251 
9252 	case SHT_MIPS_EVENTS:
9253 	  BFD_ASSERT ((*hdrpp)->bfd_section != NULL);
9254 	  name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, (*hdrpp)->bfd_section);
9255 	  BFD_ASSERT (name != NULL);
9256 	  if (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.events"))
9257 	    sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd,
9258 					   name + sizeof ".MIPS.events" - 1);
9259 	  else
9260 	    {
9261 	      BFD_ASSERT (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.post_rel"));
9262 	      sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd,
9263 					     (name
9264 					      + sizeof ".MIPS.post_rel" - 1));
9265 	    }
9266 	  BFD_ASSERT (sec != NULL);
9267 	  (*hdrpp)->sh_link = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx;
9268 	  break;
9269 
9270 	}
9271     }
9272 }
9273 
9274 /* When creating an IRIX5 executable, we need REGINFO and RTPROC
9275    segments.  */
9276 
9277 int
_bfd_mips_elf_additional_program_headers(bfd * abfd,struct bfd_link_info * info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)9278 _bfd_mips_elf_additional_program_headers (bfd *abfd,
9279 					  struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9280 {
9281   asection *s;
9282   int ret = 0;
9283 
9284   /* See if we need a PT_MIPS_REGINFO segment.  */
9285   s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".reginfo");
9286   if (s && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD))
9287     ++ret;
9288 
9289   /* See if we need a PT_MIPS_OPTIONS segment.  */
9290   if (IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix6
9291       && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd,
9292 				  MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME (abfd)))
9293     ++ret;
9294 
9295   /* See if we need a PT_MIPS_RTPROC segment.  */
9296   if (IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix5
9297       && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic")
9298       && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".mdebug"))
9299     ++ret;
9300 
9301   /* Allocate a PT_NULL header in dynamic objects.  See
9302      _bfd_mips_elf_modify_segment_map for details.  */
9303   if (!SGI_COMPAT (abfd)
9304       && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic"))
9305     ++ret;
9306 
9307   return ret;
9308 }
9309 
9310 /* Modify the segment map for an IRIX5 executable.  */
9311 
9312 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_modify_segment_map(bfd * abfd,struct bfd_link_info * info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)9313 _bfd_mips_elf_modify_segment_map (bfd *abfd,
9314 				  struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9315 {
9316   asection *s;
9317   struct elf_segment_map *m, **pm;
9318   bfd_size_type amt;
9319 
9320   /* If there is a .reginfo section, we need a PT_MIPS_REGINFO
9321      segment.  */
9322   s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".reginfo");
9323   if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
9324     {
9325       for (m = elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map; m != NULL; m = m->next)
9326 	if (m->p_type == PT_MIPS_REGINFO)
9327 	  break;
9328       if (m == NULL)
9329 	{
9330 	  amt = sizeof *m;
9331 	  m = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
9332 	  if (m == NULL)
9333 	    return FALSE;
9334 
9335 	  m->p_type = PT_MIPS_REGINFO;
9336 	  m->count = 1;
9337 	  m->sections[0] = s;
9338 
9339 	  /* We want to put it after the PHDR and INTERP segments.  */
9340 	  pm = &elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map;
9341 	  while (*pm != NULL
9342 		 && ((*pm)->p_type == PT_PHDR
9343 		     || (*pm)->p_type == PT_INTERP))
9344 	    pm = &(*pm)->next;
9345 
9346 	  m->next = *pm;
9347 	  *pm = m;
9348 	}
9349     }
9350 
9351   /* For IRIX 6, we don't have .mdebug sections, nor does anything but
9352      .dynamic end up in PT_DYNAMIC.  However, we do have to insert a
9353      PT_MIPS_OPTIONS segment immediately following the program header
9354      table.  */
9355   if (NEWABI_P (abfd)
9356       /* On non-IRIX6 new abi, we'll have already created a segment
9357 	 for this section, so don't create another.  I'm not sure this
9358 	 is not also the case for IRIX 6, but I can't test it right
9359 	 now.  */
9360       && IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix6)
9361     {
9362       for (s = abfd->sections; s; s = s->next)
9363 	if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS)
9364 	  break;
9365 
9366       if (s)
9367 	{
9368 	  struct elf_segment_map *options_segment;
9369 
9370 	  pm = &elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map;
9371 	  while (*pm != NULL
9372 		 && ((*pm)->p_type == PT_PHDR
9373 		     || (*pm)->p_type == PT_INTERP))
9374 	    pm = &(*pm)->next;
9375 
9376 	  if (*pm == NULL || (*pm)->p_type != PT_MIPS_OPTIONS)
9377 	    {
9378 	      amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
9379 	      options_segment = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
9380 	      options_segment->next = *pm;
9381 	      options_segment->p_type = PT_MIPS_OPTIONS;
9382 	      options_segment->p_flags = PF_R;
9383 	      options_segment->p_flags_valid = TRUE;
9384 	      options_segment->count = 1;
9385 	      options_segment->sections[0] = s;
9386 	      *pm = options_segment;
9387 	    }
9388 	}
9389     }
9390   else
9391     {
9392       if (IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix5)
9393 	{
9394 	  /* If there are .dynamic and .mdebug sections, we make a room
9395 	     for the RTPROC header.  FIXME: Rewrite without section names.  */
9396 	  if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".interp") == NULL
9397 	      && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic") != NULL
9398 	      && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".mdebug") != NULL)
9399 	    {
9400 	      for (m = elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map; m != NULL; m = m->next)
9401 		if (m->p_type == PT_MIPS_RTPROC)
9402 		  break;
9403 	      if (m == NULL)
9404 		{
9405 		  amt = sizeof *m;
9406 		  m = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
9407 		  if (m == NULL)
9408 		    return FALSE;
9409 
9410 		  m->p_type = PT_MIPS_RTPROC;
9411 
9412 		  s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rtproc");
9413 		  if (s == NULL)
9414 		    {
9415 		      m->count = 0;
9416 		      m->p_flags = 0;
9417 		      m->p_flags_valid = 1;
9418 		    }
9419 		  else
9420 		    {
9421 		      m->count = 1;
9422 		      m->sections[0] = s;
9423 		    }
9424 
9425 		  /* We want to put it after the DYNAMIC segment.  */
9426 		  pm = &elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map;
9427 		  while (*pm != NULL && (*pm)->p_type != PT_DYNAMIC)
9428 		    pm = &(*pm)->next;
9429 		  if (*pm != NULL)
9430 		    pm = &(*pm)->next;
9431 
9432 		  m->next = *pm;
9433 		  *pm = m;
9434 		}
9435 	    }
9436 	}
9437       /* On IRIX5, the PT_DYNAMIC segment includes the .dynamic,
9438 	 .dynstr, .dynsym, and .hash sections, and everything in
9439 	 between.  */
9440       for (pm = &elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map; *pm != NULL;
9441 	   pm = &(*pm)->next)
9442 	if ((*pm)->p_type == PT_DYNAMIC)
9443 	  break;
9444       m = *pm;
9445       if (m != NULL && IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_none)
9446 	{
9447 	  /* For a normal mips executable the permissions for the PT_DYNAMIC
9448 	     segment are read, write and execute. We do that here since
9449 	     the code in elf.c sets only the read permission. This matters
9450 	     sometimes for the dynamic linker.  */
9451 	  if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic") != NULL)
9452 	    {
9453 	      m->p_flags = PF_R | PF_W | PF_X;
9454 	      m->p_flags_valid = 1;
9455 	    }
9456 	}
9457       /* GNU/Linux binaries do not need the extended PT_DYNAMIC section.
9458 	 glibc's dynamic linker has traditionally derived the number of
9459 	 tags from the p_filesz field, and sometimes allocates stack
9460 	 arrays of that size.  An overly-big PT_DYNAMIC segment can
9461 	 be actively harmful in such cases.  Making PT_DYNAMIC contain
9462 	 other sections can also make life hard for the prelinker,
9463 	 which might move one of the other sections to a different
9464 	 PT_LOAD segment.  */
9465       if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd)
9466 	  && m != NULL
9467 	  && m->count == 1
9468 	  && strcmp (m->sections[0]->name, ".dynamic") == 0)
9469 	{
9470 	  static const char *sec_names[] =
9471 	  {
9472 	    ".dynamic", ".dynstr", ".dynsym", ".hash"
9473 	  };
9474 	  bfd_vma low, high;
9475 	  unsigned int i, c;
9476 	  struct elf_segment_map *n;
9477 
9478 	  low = ~(bfd_vma) 0;
9479 	  high = 0;
9480 	  for (i = 0; i < sizeof sec_names / sizeof sec_names[0]; i++)
9481 	    {
9482 	      s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, sec_names[i]);
9483 	      if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
9484 		{
9485 		  bfd_size_type sz;
9486 
9487 		  if (low > s->vma)
9488 		    low = s->vma;
9489 		  sz = s->size;
9490 		  if (high < s->vma + sz)
9491 		    high = s->vma + sz;
9492 		}
9493 	    }
9494 
9495 	  c = 0;
9496 	  for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
9497 	    if ((s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
9498 		&& s->vma >= low
9499 		&& s->vma + s->size <= high)
9500 	      ++c;
9501 
9502 	  amt = sizeof *n + (bfd_size_type) (c - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
9503 	  n = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
9504 	  if (n == NULL)
9505 	    return FALSE;
9506 	  *n = *m;
9507 	  n->count = c;
9508 
9509 	  i = 0;
9510 	  for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
9511 	    {
9512 	      if ((s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
9513 		  && s->vma >= low
9514 		  && s->vma + s->size <= high)
9515 		{
9516 		  n->sections[i] = s;
9517 		  ++i;
9518 		}
9519 	    }
9520 
9521 	  *pm = n;
9522 	}
9523     }
9524 
9525   /* Allocate a spare program header in dynamic objects so that tools
9526      like the prelinker can add an extra PT_LOAD entry.
9527 
9528      If the prelinker needs to make room for a new PT_LOAD entry, its
9529      standard procedure is to move the first (read-only) sections into
9530      the new (writable) segment.  However, the MIPS ABI requires
9531      .dynamic to be in a read-only segment, and the section will often
9532      start within sizeof (ElfNN_Phdr) bytes of the last program header.
9533 
9534      Although the prelinker could in principle move .dynamic to a
9535      writable segment, it seems better to allocate a spare program
9536      header instead, and avoid the need to move any sections.
9537      There is a long tradition of allocating spare dynamic tags,
9538      so allocating a spare program header seems like a natural
9539      extension.  */
9540   if (!SGI_COMPAT (abfd)
9541       && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic"))
9542     {
9543       for (pm = &elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map; *pm != NULL; pm = &(*pm)->next)
9544 	if ((*pm)->p_type == PT_NULL)
9545 	  break;
9546       if (*pm == NULL)
9547 	{
9548 	  m = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (*m));
9549 	  if (m == NULL)
9550 	    return FALSE;
9551 
9552 	  m->p_type = PT_NULL;
9553 	  *pm = m;
9554 	}
9555     }
9556 
9557   return TRUE;
9558 }
9559 
9560 /* Return the section that should be marked against GC for a given
9561    relocation.  */
9562 
9563 asection *
_bfd_mips_elf_gc_mark_hook(asection * sec,struct bfd_link_info * info,Elf_Internal_Rela * rel,struct elf_link_hash_entry * h,Elf_Internal_Sym * sym)9564 _bfd_mips_elf_gc_mark_hook (asection *sec,
9565 			    struct bfd_link_info *info,
9566 			    Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
9567 			    struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
9568 			    Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
9569 {
9570   /* ??? Do mips16 stub sections need to be handled special?  */
9571 
9572   if (h != NULL)
9573     switch (ELF_R_TYPE (sec->owner, rel->r_info))
9574       {
9575       case R_MIPS_GNU_VTINHERIT:
9576       case R_MIPS_GNU_VTENTRY:
9577 	return NULL;
9578       }
9579 
9580   return _bfd_elf_gc_mark_hook (sec, info, rel, h, sym);
9581 }
9582 
9583 /* Update the got entry reference counts for the section being removed.  */
9584 
9585 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_gc_sweep_hook(bfd * abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,struct bfd_link_info * info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,asection * sec ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,const Elf_Internal_Rela * relocs ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)9586 _bfd_mips_elf_gc_sweep_hook (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9587 			     struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9588 			     asection *sec ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9589 			     const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9590 {
9591 #if 0
9592   Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
9593   struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
9594   bfd_signed_vma *local_got_refcounts;
9595   const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel, *relend;
9596   unsigned long r_symndx;
9597   struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
9598 
9599   symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
9600   sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (abfd);
9601   local_got_refcounts = elf_local_got_refcounts (abfd);
9602 
9603   relend = relocs + sec->reloc_count;
9604   for (rel = relocs; rel < relend; rel++)
9605     switch (ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, rel->r_info))
9606       {
9607       case R_MIPS_GOT16:
9608       case R_MIPS_CALL16:
9609       case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
9610       case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
9611       case R_MIPS_GOT_HI16:
9612       case R_MIPS_GOT_LO16:
9613       case R_MIPS_GOT_DISP:
9614       case R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE:
9615       case R_MIPS_GOT_OFST:
9616 	/* ??? It would seem that the existing MIPS code does no sort
9617 	   of reference counting or whatnot on its GOT and PLT entries,
9618 	   so it is not possible to garbage collect them at this time.  */
9619 	break;
9620 
9621       default:
9622 	break;
9623       }
9624 #endif
9625 
9626   return TRUE;
9627 }
9628 
9629 /* Copy data from a MIPS ELF indirect symbol to its direct symbol,
9630    hiding the old indirect symbol.  Process additional relocation
9631    information.  Also called for weakdefs, in which case we just let
9632    _bfd_elf_link_hash_copy_indirect copy the flags for us.  */
9633 
9634 void
_bfd_mips_elf_copy_indirect_symbol(struct bfd_link_info * info,struct elf_link_hash_entry * dir,struct elf_link_hash_entry * ind)9635 _bfd_mips_elf_copy_indirect_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
9636 				    struct elf_link_hash_entry *dir,
9637 				    struct elf_link_hash_entry *ind)
9638 {
9639   struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *dirmips, *indmips;
9640 
9641   _bfd_elf_link_hash_copy_indirect (info, dir, ind);
9642 
9643   if (ind->root.type != bfd_link_hash_indirect)
9644     return;
9645 
9646   dirmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) dir;
9647   indmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) ind;
9648   dirmips->possibly_dynamic_relocs += indmips->possibly_dynamic_relocs;
9649   if (indmips->readonly_reloc)
9650     dirmips->readonly_reloc = TRUE;
9651   if (indmips->no_fn_stub)
9652     dirmips->no_fn_stub = TRUE;
9653 
9654   if (dirmips->tls_type == 0)
9655     dirmips->tls_type = indmips->tls_type;
9656 }
9657 
9658 void
_bfd_mips_elf_hide_symbol(struct bfd_link_info * info,struct elf_link_hash_entry * entry,bfd_boolean force_local)9659 _bfd_mips_elf_hide_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
9660 			   struct elf_link_hash_entry *entry,
9661 			   bfd_boolean force_local)
9662 {
9663   bfd *dynobj;
9664   asection *got;
9665   struct mips_got_info *g;
9666   struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
9667 
9668   h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) entry;
9669   if (h->forced_local)
9670     return;
9671   h->forced_local = force_local;
9672 
9673   dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
9674   if (dynobj != NULL && force_local && h->root.type != STT_TLS
9675       && (got = mips_elf_got_section (dynobj, TRUE)) != NULL
9676       && (g = mips_elf_section_data (got)->u.got_info) != NULL)
9677     {
9678       if (g->next)
9679 	{
9680 	  struct mips_got_entry e;
9681 	  struct mips_got_info *gg = g;
9682 
9683 	  /* Since we're turning what used to be a global symbol into a
9684 	     local one, bump up the number of local entries of each GOT
9685 	     that had an entry for it.  This will automatically decrease
9686 	     the number of global entries, since global_gotno is actually
9687 	     the upper limit of global entries.  */
9688 	  e.abfd = dynobj;
9689 	  e.symndx = -1;
9690 	  e.d.h = h;
9691 	  e.tls_type = 0;
9692 
9693 	  for (g = g->next; g != gg; g = g->next)
9694 	    if (htab_find (g->got_entries, &e))
9695 	      {
9696 		BFD_ASSERT (g->global_gotno > 0);
9697 		g->local_gotno++;
9698 		g->global_gotno--;
9699 	      }
9700 
9701 	  /* If this was a global symbol forced into the primary GOT, we
9702 	     no longer need an entry for it.  We can't release the entry
9703 	     at this point, but we must at least stop counting it as one
9704 	     of the symbols that required a forced got entry.  */
9705 	  if (h->root.got.offset == 2)
9706 	    {
9707 	      BFD_ASSERT (gg->assigned_gotno > 0);
9708 	      gg->assigned_gotno--;
9709 	    }
9710 	}
9711       else if (g->global_gotno == 0 && g->global_gotsym == NULL)
9712 	/* If we haven't got through GOT allocation yet, just bump up the
9713 	   number of local entries, as this symbol won't be counted as
9714 	   global.  */
9715 	g->local_gotno++;
9716       else if (h->root.got.offset == 1)
9717 	{
9718 	  /* If we're past non-multi-GOT allocation and this symbol had
9719 	     been marked for a global got entry, give it a local entry
9720 	     instead.  */
9721 	  BFD_ASSERT (g->global_gotno > 0);
9722 	  g->local_gotno++;
9723 	  g->global_gotno--;
9724 	}
9725     }
9726 
9727   _bfd_elf_link_hash_hide_symbol (info, &h->root, force_local);
9728 }
9729 
9730 #define PDR_SIZE 32
9731 
9732 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_discard_info(bfd * abfd,struct elf_reloc_cookie * cookie,struct bfd_link_info * info)9733 _bfd_mips_elf_discard_info (bfd *abfd, struct elf_reloc_cookie *cookie,
9734 			    struct bfd_link_info *info)
9735 {
9736   asection *o;
9737   bfd_boolean ret = FALSE;
9738   unsigned char *tdata;
9739   size_t i, skip;
9740 
9741   o = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".pdr");
9742   if (! o)
9743     return FALSE;
9744   if (o->size == 0)
9745     return FALSE;
9746   if (o->size % PDR_SIZE != 0)
9747     return FALSE;
9748   if (o->output_section != NULL
9749       && bfd_is_abs_section (o->output_section))
9750     return FALSE;
9751 
9752   tdata = bfd_zmalloc (o->size / PDR_SIZE);
9753   if (! tdata)
9754     return FALSE;
9755 
9756   cookie->rels = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (abfd, o, NULL, NULL,
9757 					    info->keep_memory);
9758   if (!cookie->rels)
9759     {
9760       free (tdata);
9761       return FALSE;
9762     }
9763 
9764   cookie->rel = cookie->rels;
9765   cookie->relend = cookie->rels + o->reloc_count;
9766 
9767   for (i = 0, skip = 0; i < o->size / PDR_SIZE; i ++)
9768     {
9769       if (bfd_elf_reloc_symbol_deleted_p (i * PDR_SIZE, cookie))
9770 	{
9771 	  tdata[i] = 1;
9772 	  skip ++;
9773 	}
9774     }
9775 
9776   if (skip != 0)
9777     {
9778       mips_elf_section_data (o)->u.tdata = tdata;
9779       o->size -= skip * PDR_SIZE;
9780       ret = TRUE;
9781     }
9782   else
9783     free (tdata);
9784 
9785   if (! info->keep_memory)
9786     free (cookie->rels);
9787 
9788   return ret;
9789 }
9790 
9791 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_ignore_discarded_relocs(asection * sec)9792 _bfd_mips_elf_ignore_discarded_relocs (asection *sec)
9793 {
9794   if (strcmp (sec->name, ".pdr") == 0)
9795     return TRUE;
9796   return FALSE;
9797 }
9798 
9799 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_write_section(bfd * output_bfd,struct bfd_link_info * link_info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,asection * sec,bfd_byte * contents)9800 _bfd_mips_elf_write_section (bfd *output_bfd,
9801 			     struct bfd_link_info *link_info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9802                              asection *sec, bfd_byte *contents)
9803 {
9804   bfd_byte *to, *from, *end;
9805   int i;
9806 
9807   if (strcmp (sec->name, ".pdr") != 0)
9808     return FALSE;
9809 
9810   if (mips_elf_section_data (sec)->u.tdata == NULL)
9811     return FALSE;
9812 
9813   to = contents;
9814   end = contents + sec->size;
9815   for (from = contents, i = 0;
9816        from < end;
9817        from += PDR_SIZE, i++)
9818     {
9819       if ((mips_elf_section_data (sec)->u.tdata)[i] == 1)
9820 	continue;
9821       if (to != from)
9822 	memcpy (to, from, PDR_SIZE);
9823       to += PDR_SIZE;
9824     }
9825   bfd_set_section_contents (output_bfd, sec->output_section, contents,
9826 			    sec->output_offset, sec->size);
9827   return TRUE;
9828 }
9829 
9830 /* MIPS ELF uses a special find_nearest_line routine in order the
9831    handle the ECOFF debugging information.  */
9832 
9833 struct mips_elf_find_line
9834 {
9835   struct ecoff_debug_info d;
9836   struct ecoff_find_line i;
9837 };
9838 
9839 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_find_nearest_line(bfd * abfd,asection * section,asymbol ** symbols,bfd_vma offset,const char ** filename_ptr,const char ** functionname_ptr,unsigned int * line_ptr)9840 _bfd_mips_elf_find_nearest_line (bfd *abfd, asection *section,
9841 				 asymbol **symbols, bfd_vma offset,
9842 				 const char **filename_ptr,
9843 				 const char **functionname_ptr,
9844 				 unsigned int *line_ptr)
9845 {
9846   asection *msec;
9847 
9848   if (_bfd_dwarf1_find_nearest_line (abfd, section, symbols, offset,
9849 				     filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
9850 				     line_ptr))
9851     return TRUE;
9852 
9853   if (_bfd_dwarf2_find_nearest_line (abfd, section, symbols, offset,
9854 				     filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
9855 				     line_ptr, ABI_64_P (abfd) ? 8 : 0,
9856 				     &elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info))
9857     return TRUE;
9858 
9859   msec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".mdebug");
9860   if (msec != NULL)
9861     {
9862       flagword origflags;
9863       struct mips_elf_find_line *fi;
9864       const struct ecoff_debug_swap * const swap =
9865 	get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap;
9866 
9867       /* If we are called during a link, mips_elf_final_link may have
9868 	 cleared the SEC_HAS_CONTENTS field.  We force it back on here
9869 	 if appropriate (which it normally will be).  */
9870       origflags = msec->flags;
9871       if (elf_section_data (msec)->this_hdr.sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
9872 	msec->flags |= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
9873 
9874       fi = elf_tdata (abfd)->find_line_info;
9875       if (fi == NULL)
9876 	{
9877 	  bfd_size_type external_fdr_size;
9878 	  char *fraw_src;
9879 	  char *fraw_end;
9880 	  struct fdr *fdr_ptr;
9881 	  bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (struct mips_elf_find_line);
9882 
9883 	  fi = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
9884 	  if (fi == NULL)
9885 	    {
9886 	      msec->flags = origflags;
9887 	      return FALSE;
9888 	    }
9889 
9890 	  if (! _bfd_mips_elf_read_ecoff_info (abfd, msec, &fi->d))
9891 	    {
9892 	      msec->flags = origflags;
9893 	      return FALSE;
9894 	    }
9895 
9896 	  /* Swap in the FDR information.  */
9897 	  amt = fi->d.symbolic_header.ifdMax * sizeof (struct fdr);
9898 	  fi->d.fdr = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
9899 	  if (fi->d.fdr == NULL)
9900 	    {
9901 	      msec->flags = origflags;
9902 	      return FALSE;
9903 	    }
9904 	  external_fdr_size = swap->external_fdr_size;
9905 	  fdr_ptr = fi->d.fdr;
9906 	  fraw_src = (char *) fi->d.external_fdr;
9907 	  fraw_end = (fraw_src
9908 		      + fi->d.symbolic_header.ifdMax * external_fdr_size);
9909 	  for (; fraw_src < fraw_end; fraw_src += external_fdr_size, fdr_ptr++)
9910 	    (*swap->swap_fdr_in) (abfd, fraw_src, fdr_ptr);
9911 
9912 	  elf_tdata (abfd)->find_line_info = fi;
9913 
9914 	  /* Note that we don't bother to ever free this information.
9915              find_nearest_line is either called all the time, as in
9916              objdump -l, so the information should be saved, or it is
9917              rarely called, as in ld error messages, so the memory
9918              wasted is unimportant.  Still, it would probably be a
9919              good idea for free_cached_info to throw it away.  */
9920 	}
9921 
9922       if (_bfd_ecoff_locate_line (abfd, section, offset, &fi->d, swap,
9923 				  &fi->i, filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
9924 				  line_ptr))
9925 	{
9926 	  msec->flags = origflags;
9927 	  return TRUE;
9928 	}
9929 
9930       msec->flags = origflags;
9931     }
9932 
9933   /* Fall back on the generic ELF find_nearest_line routine.  */
9934 
9935   return _bfd_elf_find_nearest_line (abfd, section, symbols, offset,
9936 				     filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
9937 				     line_ptr);
9938 }
9939 
9940 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_find_inliner_info(bfd * abfd,const char ** filename_ptr,const char ** functionname_ptr,unsigned int * line_ptr)9941 _bfd_mips_elf_find_inliner_info (bfd *abfd,
9942 				 const char **filename_ptr,
9943 				 const char **functionname_ptr,
9944 				 unsigned int *line_ptr)
9945 {
9946   bfd_boolean found;
9947   found = _bfd_dwarf2_find_inliner_info (abfd, filename_ptr,
9948 					 functionname_ptr, line_ptr,
9949 					 & elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info);
9950   return found;
9951 }
9952 
9953 
9954 /* When are writing out the .options or .MIPS.options section,
9955    remember the bytes we are writing out, so that we can install the
9956    GP value in the section_processing routine.  */
9957 
9958 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_set_section_contents(bfd * abfd,sec_ptr section,const void * location,file_ptr offset,bfd_size_type count)9959 _bfd_mips_elf_set_section_contents (bfd *abfd, sec_ptr section,
9960 				    const void *location,
9961 				    file_ptr offset, bfd_size_type count)
9962 {
9963   if (MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME_P (section->name))
9964     {
9965       bfd_byte *c;
9966 
9967       if (elf_section_data (section) == NULL)
9968 	{
9969 	  bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (struct bfd_elf_section_data);
9970 	  section->used_by_bfd = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
9971 	  if (elf_section_data (section) == NULL)
9972 	    return FALSE;
9973 	}
9974       c = mips_elf_section_data (section)->u.tdata;
9975       if (c == NULL)
9976 	{
9977 	  c = bfd_zalloc (abfd, section->size);
9978 	  if (c == NULL)
9979 	    return FALSE;
9980 	  mips_elf_section_data (section)->u.tdata = c;
9981 	}
9982 
9983       memcpy (c + offset, location, count);
9984     }
9985 
9986   return _bfd_elf_set_section_contents (abfd, section, location, offset,
9987 					count);
9988 }
9989 
9990 /* This is almost identical to bfd_generic_get_... except that some
9991    MIPS relocations need to be handled specially.  Sigh.  */
9992 
9993 bfd_byte *
_bfd_elf_mips_get_relocated_section_contents(bfd * abfd,struct bfd_link_info * link_info,struct bfd_link_order * link_order,bfd_byte * data,bfd_boolean relocatable,asymbol ** symbols)9994 _bfd_elf_mips_get_relocated_section_contents
9995   (bfd *abfd,
9996    struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
9997    struct bfd_link_order *link_order,
9998    bfd_byte *data,
9999    bfd_boolean relocatable,
10000    asymbol **symbols)
10001 {
10002   /* Get enough memory to hold the stuff */
10003   bfd *input_bfd = link_order->u.indirect.section->owner;
10004   asection *input_section = link_order->u.indirect.section;
10005   bfd_size_type sz;
10006 
10007   long reloc_size = bfd_get_reloc_upper_bound (input_bfd, input_section);
10008   arelent **reloc_vector = NULL;
10009   long reloc_count;
10010 
10011   if (reloc_size < 0)
10012     goto error_return;
10013 
10014   reloc_vector = bfd_malloc (reloc_size);
10015   if (reloc_vector == NULL && reloc_size != 0)
10016     goto error_return;
10017 
10018   /* read in the section */
10019   sz = input_section->rawsize ? input_section->rawsize : input_section->size;
10020   if (!bfd_get_section_contents (input_bfd, input_section, data, 0, sz))
10021     goto error_return;
10022 
10023   reloc_count = bfd_canonicalize_reloc (input_bfd,
10024 					input_section,
10025 					reloc_vector,
10026 					symbols);
10027   if (reloc_count < 0)
10028     goto error_return;
10029 
10030   if (reloc_count > 0)
10031     {
10032       arelent **parent;
10033       /* for mips */
10034       int gp_found;
10035       bfd_vma gp = 0x12345678;	/* initialize just to shut gcc up */
10036 
10037       {
10038 	struct bfd_hash_entry *h;
10039 	struct bfd_link_hash_entry *lh;
10040 	/* Skip all this stuff if we aren't mixing formats.  */
10041 	if (abfd && input_bfd
10042 	    && abfd->xvec == input_bfd->xvec)
10043 	  lh = 0;
10044 	else
10045 	  {
10046 	    h = bfd_hash_lookup (&link_info->hash->table, "_gp", FALSE, FALSE);
10047 	    lh = (struct bfd_link_hash_entry *) h;
10048 	  }
10049       lookup:
10050 	if (lh)
10051 	  {
10052 	    switch (lh->type)
10053 	      {
10054 	      case bfd_link_hash_undefined:
10055 	      case bfd_link_hash_undefweak:
10056 	      case bfd_link_hash_common:
10057 		gp_found = 0;
10058 		break;
10059 	      case bfd_link_hash_defined:
10060 	      case bfd_link_hash_defweak:
10061 		gp_found = 1;
10062 		gp = lh->u.def.value;
10063 		break;
10064 	      case bfd_link_hash_indirect:
10065 	      case bfd_link_hash_warning:
10066 		lh = lh->u.i.link;
10067 		/* @@FIXME  ignoring warning for now */
10068 		goto lookup;
10069 	      case bfd_link_hash_new:
10070 	      default:
10071 		abort ();
10072 	      }
10073 	  }
10074 	else
10075 	  gp_found = 0;
10076       }
10077       /* end mips */
10078       for (parent = reloc_vector; *parent != NULL; parent++)
10079 	{
10080 	  char *error_message = NULL;
10081 	  bfd_reloc_status_type r;
10082 
10083 	  /* Specific to MIPS: Deal with relocation types that require
10084 	     knowing the gp of the output bfd.  */
10085 	  asymbol *sym = *(*parent)->sym_ptr_ptr;
10086 
10087 	  /* If we've managed to find the gp and have a special
10088 	     function for the relocation then go ahead, else default
10089 	     to the generic handling.  */
10090 	  if (gp_found
10091 	      && (*parent)->howto->special_function
10092 	      == _bfd_mips_elf32_gprel16_reloc)
10093 	    r = _bfd_mips_elf_gprel16_with_gp (input_bfd, sym, *parent,
10094 					       input_section, relocatable,
10095 					       data, gp);
10096 	  else
10097 	    r = bfd_perform_relocation (input_bfd, *parent, data,
10098 					input_section,
10099 					relocatable ? abfd : NULL,
10100 					&error_message);
10101 
10102 	  if (relocatable)
10103 	    {
10104 	      asection *os = input_section->output_section;
10105 
10106 	      /* A partial link, so keep the relocs */
10107 	      os->orelocation[os->reloc_count] = *parent;
10108 	      os->reloc_count++;
10109 	    }
10110 
10111 	  if (r != bfd_reloc_ok)
10112 	    {
10113 	      switch (r)
10114 		{
10115 		case bfd_reloc_undefined:
10116 		  if (!((*link_info->callbacks->undefined_symbol)
10117 			(link_info, bfd_asymbol_name (*(*parent)->sym_ptr_ptr),
10118 			 input_bfd, input_section, (*parent)->address, TRUE)))
10119 		    goto error_return;
10120 		  break;
10121 		case bfd_reloc_dangerous:
10122 		  BFD_ASSERT (error_message != NULL);
10123 		  if (!((*link_info->callbacks->reloc_dangerous)
10124 			(link_info, error_message, input_bfd, input_section,
10125 			 (*parent)->address)))
10126 		    goto error_return;
10127 		  break;
10128 		case bfd_reloc_overflow:
10129 		  if (!((*link_info->callbacks->reloc_overflow)
10130 			(link_info, NULL,
10131 			 bfd_asymbol_name (*(*parent)->sym_ptr_ptr),
10132 			 (*parent)->howto->name, (*parent)->addend,
10133 			 input_bfd, input_section, (*parent)->address)))
10134 		    goto error_return;
10135 		  break;
10136 		case bfd_reloc_outofrange:
10137 		default:
10138 		  abort ();
10139 		  break;
10140 		}
10141 
10142 	    }
10143 	}
10144     }
10145   if (reloc_vector != NULL)
10146     free (reloc_vector);
10147   return data;
10148 
10149 error_return:
10150   if (reloc_vector != NULL)
10151     free (reloc_vector);
10152   return NULL;
10153 }
10154 
10155 /* Create a MIPS ELF linker hash table.  */
10156 
10157 struct bfd_link_hash_table *
_bfd_mips_elf_link_hash_table_create(bfd * abfd)10158 _bfd_mips_elf_link_hash_table_create (bfd *abfd)
10159 {
10160   struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *ret;
10161   bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (struct mips_elf_link_hash_table);
10162 
10163   ret = bfd_malloc (amt);
10164   if (ret == NULL)
10165     return NULL;
10166 
10167   if (!_bfd_elf_link_hash_table_init (&ret->root, abfd,
10168 				      mips_elf_link_hash_newfunc,
10169 				      sizeof (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry)))
10170     {
10171       free (ret);
10172       return NULL;
10173     }
10174 
10175 #if 0
10176   /* We no longer use this.  */
10177   for (i = 0; i < SIZEOF_MIPS_DYNSYM_SECNAMES; i++)
10178     ret->dynsym_sec_strindex[i] = (bfd_size_type) -1;
10179 #endif
10180   ret->procedure_count = 0;
10181   ret->compact_rel_size = 0;
10182   ret->use_rld_obj_head = FALSE;
10183   ret->rld_value = 0;
10184   ret->mips16_stubs_seen = FALSE;
10185   ret->is_vxworks = FALSE;
10186   ret->srelbss = NULL;
10187   ret->sdynbss = NULL;
10188   ret->srelplt = NULL;
10189   ret->srelplt2 = NULL;
10190   ret->sgotplt = NULL;
10191   ret->splt = NULL;
10192   ret->plt_header_size = 0;
10193   ret->plt_entry_size = 0;
10194   ret->function_stub_size = 0;
10195 
10196   return &ret->root.root;
10197 }
10198 
10199 /* Likewise, but indicate that the target is VxWorks.  */
10200 
10201 struct bfd_link_hash_table *
_bfd_mips_vxworks_link_hash_table_create(bfd * abfd)10202 _bfd_mips_vxworks_link_hash_table_create (bfd *abfd)
10203 {
10204   struct bfd_link_hash_table *ret;
10205 
10206   ret = _bfd_mips_elf_link_hash_table_create (abfd);
10207   if (ret)
10208     {
10209       struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
10210 
10211       htab = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *) ret;
10212       htab->is_vxworks = 1;
10213     }
10214   return ret;
10215 }
10216 
10217 /* We need to use a special link routine to handle the .reginfo and
10218    the .mdebug sections.  We need to merge all instances of these
10219    sections together, not write them all out sequentially.  */
10220 
10221 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_final_link(bfd * abfd,struct bfd_link_info * info)10222 _bfd_mips_elf_final_link (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
10223 {
10224   asection *o;
10225   struct bfd_link_order *p;
10226   asection *reginfo_sec, *mdebug_sec, *gptab_data_sec, *gptab_bss_sec;
10227   asection *rtproc_sec;
10228   Elf32_RegInfo reginfo;
10229   struct ecoff_debug_info debug;
10230   const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
10231   const struct ecoff_debug_swap *swap = bed->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap;
10232   HDRR *symhdr = &debug.symbolic_header;
10233   void *mdebug_handle = NULL;
10234   asection *s;
10235   EXTR esym;
10236   unsigned int i;
10237   bfd_size_type amt;
10238   struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
10239 
10240   static const char * const secname[] =
10241   {
10242     ".text", ".init", ".fini", ".data",
10243     ".rodata", ".sdata", ".sbss", ".bss"
10244   };
10245   static const int sc[] =
10246   {
10247     scText, scInit, scFini, scData,
10248     scRData, scSData, scSBss, scBss
10249   };
10250 
10251   /* We'd carefully arranged the dynamic symbol indices, and then the
10252      generic size_dynamic_sections renumbered them out from under us.
10253      Rather than trying somehow to prevent the renumbering, just do
10254      the sort again.  */
10255   htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
10256   if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
10257     {
10258       bfd *dynobj;
10259       asection *got;
10260       struct mips_got_info *g;
10261       bfd_size_type dynsecsymcount;
10262 
10263       /* When we resort, we must tell mips_elf_sort_hash_table what
10264 	 the lowest index it may use is.  That's the number of section
10265 	 symbols we're going to add.  The generic ELF linker only
10266 	 adds these symbols when building a shared object.  Note that
10267 	 we count the sections after (possibly) removing the .options
10268 	 section above.  */
10269 
10270       dynsecsymcount = count_section_dynsyms (abfd, info);
10271       if (! mips_elf_sort_hash_table (info, dynsecsymcount + 1))
10272 	return FALSE;
10273 
10274       /* Make sure we didn't grow the global .got region.  */
10275       dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
10276       got = mips_elf_got_section (dynobj, FALSE);
10277       g = mips_elf_section_data (got)->u.got_info;
10278 
10279       if (g->global_gotsym != NULL)
10280 	BFD_ASSERT ((elf_hash_table (info)->dynsymcount
10281 		     - g->global_gotsym->dynindx)
10282 		    <= g->global_gotno);
10283     }
10284 
10285   /* Get a value for the GP register.  */
10286   if (elf_gp (abfd) == 0)
10287     {
10288       struct bfd_link_hash_entry *h;
10289 
10290       h = bfd_link_hash_lookup (info->hash, "_gp", FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
10291       if (h != NULL && h->type == bfd_link_hash_defined)
10292 	elf_gp (abfd) = (h->u.def.value
10293 			 + h->u.def.section->output_section->vma
10294 			 + h->u.def.section->output_offset);
10295       else if (htab->is_vxworks
10296 	       && (h = bfd_link_hash_lookup (info->hash,
10297 					     "_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_",
10298 					     FALSE, FALSE, TRUE))
10299 	       && h->type == bfd_link_hash_defined)
10300 	elf_gp (abfd) = (h->u.def.section->output_section->vma
10301 			 + h->u.def.section->output_offset
10302 			 + h->u.def.value);
10303       else if (info->relocatable)
10304 	{
10305 	  bfd_vma lo = MINUS_ONE;
10306 
10307 	  /* Find the GP-relative section with the lowest offset.  */
10308 	  for (o = abfd->sections; o != NULL; o = o->next)
10309 	    if (o->vma < lo
10310 		&& (elf_section_data (o)->this_hdr.sh_flags & SHF_MIPS_GPREL))
10311 	      lo = o->vma;
10312 
10313 	  /* And calculate GP relative to that.  */
10314 	  elf_gp (abfd) = lo + ELF_MIPS_GP_OFFSET (info);
10315 	}
10316       else
10317 	{
10318 	  /* If the relocate_section function needs to do a reloc
10319 	     involving the GP value, it should make a reloc_dangerous
10320 	     callback to warn that GP is not defined.  */
10321 	}
10322     }
10323 
10324   /* Go through the sections and collect the .reginfo and .mdebug
10325      information.  */
10326   reginfo_sec = NULL;
10327   mdebug_sec = NULL;
10328   gptab_data_sec = NULL;
10329   gptab_bss_sec = NULL;
10330   for (o = abfd->sections; o != NULL; o = o->next)
10331     {
10332       if (strcmp (o->name, ".reginfo") == 0)
10333 	{
10334 	  memset (&reginfo, 0, sizeof reginfo);
10335 
10336 	  /* We have found the .reginfo section in the output file.
10337 	     Look through all the link_orders comprising it and merge
10338 	     the information together.  */
10339 	  for (p = o->map_head.link_order; p != NULL; p = p->next)
10340 	    {
10341 	      asection *input_section;
10342 	      bfd *input_bfd;
10343 	      Elf32_External_RegInfo ext;
10344 	      Elf32_RegInfo sub;
10345 
10346 	      if (p->type != bfd_indirect_link_order)
10347 		{
10348 		  if (p->type == bfd_data_link_order)
10349 		    continue;
10350 		  abort ();
10351 		}
10352 
10353 	      input_section = p->u.indirect.section;
10354 	      input_bfd = input_section->owner;
10355 
10356 	      if (! bfd_get_section_contents (input_bfd, input_section,
10357 					      &ext, 0, sizeof ext))
10358 		return FALSE;
10359 
10360 	      bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_in (input_bfd, &ext, &sub);
10361 
10362 	      reginfo.ri_gprmask |= sub.ri_gprmask;
10363 	      reginfo.ri_cprmask[0] |= sub.ri_cprmask[0];
10364 	      reginfo.ri_cprmask[1] |= sub.ri_cprmask[1];
10365 	      reginfo.ri_cprmask[2] |= sub.ri_cprmask[2];
10366 	      reginfo.ri_cprmask[3] |= sub.ri_cprmask[3];
10367 
10368 	      /* ri_gp_value is set by the function
10369 		 mips_elf32_section_processing when the section is
10370 		 finally written out.  */
10371 
10372 	      /* Hack: reset the SEC_HAS_CONTENTS flag so that
10373 		 elf_link_input_bfd ignores this section.  */
10374 	      input_section->flags &= ~SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
10375 	    }
10376 
10377 	  /* Size has been set in _bfd_mips_elf_always_size_sections.  */
10378 	  BFD_ASSERT(o->size == sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo));
10379 
10380 	  /* Skip this section later on (I don't think this currently
10381 	     matters, but someday it might).  */
10382 	  o->map_head.link_order = NULL;
10383 
10384 	  reginfo_sec = o;
10385 	}
10386 
10387       if (strcmp (o->name, ".mdebug") == 0)
10388 	{
10389 	  struct extsym_info einfo;
10390 	  bfd_vma last;
10391 
10392 	  /* We have found the .mdebug section in the output file.
10393 	     Look through all the link_orders comprising it and merge
10394 	     the information together.  */
10395 	  symhdr->magic = swap->sym_magic;
10396 	  /* FIXME: What should the version stamp be?  */
10397 	  symhdr->vstamp = 0;
10398 	  symhdr->ilineMax = 0;
10399 	  symhdr->cbLine = 0;
10400 	  symhdr->idnMax = 0;
10401 	  symhdr->ipdMax = 0;
10402 	  symhdr->isymMax = 0;
10403 	  symhdr->ioptMax = 0;
10404 	  symhdr->iauxMax = 0;
10405 	  symhdr->issMax = 0;
10406 	  symhdr->issExtMax = 0;
10407 	  symhdr->ifdMax = 0;
10408 	  symhdr->crfd = 0;
10409 	  symhdr->iextMax = 0;
10410 
10411 	  /* We accumulate the debugging information itself in the
10412 	     debug_info structure.  */
10413 	  debug.line = NULL;
10414 	  debug.external_dnr = NULL;
10415 	  debug.external_pdr = NULL;
10416 	  debug.external_sym = NULL;
10417 	  debug.external_opt = NULL;
10418 	  debug.external_aux = NULL;
10419 	  debug.ss = NULL;
10420 	  debug.ssext = debug.ssext_end = NULL;
10421 	  debug.external_fdr = NULL;
10422 	  debug.external_rfd = NULL;
10423 	  debug.external_ext = debug.external_ext_end = NULL;
10424 
10425 	  mdebug_handle = bfd_ecoff_debug_init (abfd, &debug, swap, info);
10426 	  if (mdebug_handle == NULL)
10427 	    return FALSE;
10428 
10429 	  esym.jmptbl = 0;
10430 	  esym.cobol_main = 0;
10431 	  esym.weakext = 0;
10432 	  esym.reserved = 0;
10433 	  esym.ifd = ifdNil;
10434 	  esym.asym.iss = issNil;
10435 	  esym.asym.st = stLocal;
10436 	  esym.asym.reserved = 0;
10437 	  esym.asym.index = indexNil;
10438 	  last = 0;
10439 	  for (i = 0; i < sizeof (secname) / sizeof (secname[0]); i++)
10440 	    {
10441 	      esym.asym.sc = sc[i];
10442 	      s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, secname[i]);
10443 	      if (s != NULL)
10444 		{
10445 		  esym.asym.value = s->vma;
10446 		  last = s->vma + s->size;
10447 		}
10448 	      else
10449 		esym.asym.value = last;
10450 	      if (!bfd_ecoff_debug_one_external (abfd, &debug, swap,
10451 						 secname[i], &esym))
10452 		return FALSE;
10453 	    }
10454 
10455 	  for (p = o->map_head.link_order; p != NULL; p = p->next)
10456 	    {
10457 	      asection *input_section;
10458 	      bfd *input_bfd;
10459 	      const struct ecoff_debug_swap *input_swap;
10460 	      struct ecoff_debug_info input_debug;
10461 	      char *eraw_src;
10462 	      char *eraw_end;
10463 
10464 	      if (p->type != bfd_indirect_link_order)
10465 		{
10466 		  if (p->type == bfd_data_link_order)
10467 		    continue;
10468 		  abort ();
10469 		}
10470 
10471 	      input_section = p->u.indirect.section;
10472 	      input_bfd = input_section->owner;
10473 
10474 	      if (bfd_get_flavour (input_bfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
10475 		  || (get_elf_backend_data (input_bfd)
10476 		      ->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap) == NULL)
10477 		{
10478 		  /* I don't know what a non MIPS ELF bfd would be
10479 		     doing with a .mdebug section, but I don't really
10480 		     want to deal with it.  */
10481 		  continue;
10482 		}
10483 
10484 	      input_swap = (get_elf_backend_data (input_bfd)
10485 			    ->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap);
10486 
10487 	      BFD_ASSERT (p->size == input_section->size);
10488 
10489 	      /* The ECOFF linking code expects that we have already
10490 		 read in the debugging information and set up an
10491 		 ecoff_debug_info structure, so we do that now.  */
10492 	      if (! _bfd_mips_elf_read_ecoff_info (input_bfd, input_section,
10493 						   &input_debug))
10494 		return FALSE;
10495 
10496 	      if (! (bfd_ecoff_debug_accumulate
10497 		     (mdebug_handle, abfd, &debug, swap, input_bfd,
10498 		      &input_debug, input_swap, info)))
10499 		return FALSE;
10500 
10501 	      /* Loop through the external symbols.  For each one with
10502 		 interesting information, try to find the symbol in
10503 		 the linker global hash table and save the information
10504 		 for the output external symbols.  */
10505 	      eraw_src = input_debug.external_ext;
10506 	      eraw_end = (eraw_src
10507 			  + (input_debug.symbolic_header.iextMax
10508 			     * input_swap->external_ext_size));
10509 	      for (;
10510 		   eraw_src < eraw_end;
10511 		   eraw_src += input_swap->external_ext_size)
10512 		{
10513 		  EXTR ext;
10514 		  const char *name;
10515 		  struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
10516 
10517 		  (*input_swap->swap_ext_in) (input_bfd, eraw_src, &ext);
10518 		  if (ext.asym.sc == scNil
10519 		      || ext.asym.sc == scUndefined
10520 		      || ext.asym.sc == scSUndefined)
10521 		    continue;
10522 
10523 		  name = input_debug.ssext + ext.asym.iss;
10524 		  h = mips_elf_link_hash_lookup (mips_elf_hash_table (info),
10525 						 name, FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
10526 		  if (h == NULL || h->esym.ifd != -2)
10527 		    continue;
10528 
10529 		  if (ext.ifd != -1)
10530 		    {
10531 		      BFD_ASSERT (ext.ifd
10532 				  < input_debug.symbolic_header.ifdMax);
10533 		      ext.ifd = input_debug.ifdmap[ext.ifd];
10534 		    }
10535 
10536 		  h->esym = ext;
10537 		}
10538 
10539 	      /* Free up the information we just read.  */
10540 	      free (input_debug.line);
10541 	      free (input_debug.external_dnr);
10542 	      free (input_debug.external_pdr);
10543 	      free (input_debug.external_sym);
10544 	      free (input_debug.external_opt);
10545 	      free (input_debug.external_aux);
10546 	      free (input_debug.ss);
10547 	      free (input_debug.ssext);
10548 	      free (input_debug.external_fdr);
10549 	      free (input_debug.external_rfd);
10550 	      free (input_debug.external_ext);
10551 
10552 	      /* Hack: reset the SEC_HAS_CONTENTS flag so that
10553 		 elf_link_input_bfd ignores this section.  */
10554 	      input_section->flags &= ~SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
10555 	    }
10556 
10557 	  if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd) && info->shared)
10558 	    {
10559 	      /* Create .rtproc section.  */
10560 	      rtproc_sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rtproc");
10561 	      if (rtproc_sec == NULL)
10562 		{
10563 		  flagword flags = (SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY
10564 				    | SEC_LINKER_CREATED | SEC_READONLY);
10565 
10566 		  rtproc_sec = bfd_make_section_with_flags (abfd,
10567 							    ".rtproc",
10568 							    flags);
10569 		  if (rtproc_sec == NULL
10570 		      || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, rtproc_sec, 4))
10571 		    return FALSE;
10572 		}
10573 
10574 	      if (! mips_elf_create_procedure_table (mdebug_handle, abfd,
10575 						     info, rtproc_sec,
10576 						     &debug))
10577 		return FALSE;
10578 	    }
10579 
10580 	  /* Build the external symbol information.  */
10581 	  einfo.abfd = abfd;
10582 	  einfo.info = info;
10583 	  einfo.debug = &debug;
10584 	  einfo.swap = swap;
10585 	  einfo.failed = FALSE;
10586 	  mips_elf_link_hash_traverse (mips_elf_hash_table (info),
10587 				       mips_elf_output_extsym, &einfo);
10588 	  if (einfo.failed)
10589 	    return FALSE;
10590 
10591 	  /* Set the size of the .mdebug section.  */
10592 	  o->size = bfd_ecoff_debug_size (abfd, &debug, swap);
10593 
10594 	  /* Skip this section later on (I don't think this currently
10595 	     matters, but someday it might).  */
10596 	  o->map_head.link_order = NULL;
10597 
10598 	  mdebug_sec = o;
10599 	}
10600 
10601       if (CONST_STRNEQ (o->name, ".gptab."))
10602 	{
10603 	  const char *subname;
10604 	  unsigned int c;
10605 	  Elf32_gptab *tab;
10606 	  Elf32_External_gptab *ext_tab;
10607 	  unsigned int j;
10608 
10609 	  /* The .gptab.sdata and .gptab.sbss sections hold
10610 	     information describing how the small data area would
10611 	     change depending upon the -G switch.  These sections
10612 	     not used in executables files.  */
10613 	  if (! info->relocatable)
10614 	    {
10615 	      for (p = o->map_head.link_order; p != NULL; p = p->next)
10616 		{
10617 		  asection *input_section;
10618 
10619 		  if (p->type != bfd_indirect_link_order)
10620 		    {
10621 		      if (p->type == bfd_data_link_order)
10622 			continue;
10623 		      abort ();
10624 		    }
10625 
10626 		  input_section = p->u.indirect.section;
10627 
10628 		  /* Hack: reset the SEC_HAS_CONTENTS flag so that
10629 		     elf_link_input_bfd ignores this section.  */
10630 		  input_section->flags &= ~SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
10631 		}
10632 
10633 	      /* Skip this section later on (I don't think this
10634 		 currently matters, but someday it might).  */
10635 	      o->map_head.link_order = NULL;
10636 
10637 	      /* Really remove the section.  */
10638 	      bfd_section_list_remove (abfd, o);
10639 	      --abfd->section_count;
10640 
10641 	      continue;
10642 	    }
10643 
10644 	  /* There is one gptab for initialized data, and one for
10645 	     uninitialized data.  */
10646 	  if (strcmp (o->name, ".gptab.sdata") == 0)
10647 	    gptab_data_sec = o;
10648 	  else if (strcmp (o->name, ".gptab.sbss") == 0)
10649 	    gptab_bss_sec = o;
10650 	  else
10651 	    {
10652 	      (*_bfd_error_handler)
10653 		(_("%s: illegal section name `%s'"),
10654 		 bfd_get_filename (abfd), o->name);
10655 	      bfd_set_error (bfd_error_nonrepresentable_section);
10656 	      return FALSE;
10657 	    }
10658 
10659 	  /* The linker script always combines .gptab.data and
10660 	     .gptab.sdata into .gptab.sdata, and likewise for
10661 	     .gptab.bss and .gptab.sbss.  It is possible that there is
10662 	     no .sdata or .sbss section in the output file, in which
10663 	     case we must change the name of the output section.  */
10664 	  subname = o->name + sizeof ".gptab" - 1;
10665 	  if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, subname) == NULL)
10666 	    {
10667 	      if (o == gptab_data_sec)
10668 		o->name = ".gptab.data";
10669 	      else
10670 		o->name = ".gptab.bss";
10671 	      subname = o->name + sizeof ".gptab" - 1;
10672 	      BFD_ASSERT (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, subname) != NULL);
10673 	    }
10674 
10675 	  /* Set up the first entry.  */
10676 	  c = 1;
10677 	  amt = c * sizeof (Elf32_gptab);
10678 	  tab = bfd_malloc (amt);
10679 	  if (tab == NULL)
10680 	    return FALSE;
10681 	  tab[0].gt_header.gt_current_g_value = elf_gp_size (abfd);
10682 	  tab[0].gt_header.gt_unused = 0;
10683 
10684 	  /* Combine the input sections.  */
10685 	  for (p = o->map_head.link_order; p != NULL; p = p->next)
10686 	    {
10687 	      asection *input_section;
10688 	      bfd *input_bfd;
10689 	      bfd_size_type size;
10690 	      unsigned long last;
10691 	      bfd_size_type gpentry;
10692 
10693 	      if (p->type != bfd_indirect_link_order)
10694 		{
10695 		  if (p->type == bfd_data_link_order)
10696 		    continue;
10697 		  abort ();
10698 		}
10699 
10700 	      input_section = p->u.indirect.section;
10701 	      input_bfd = input_section->owner;
10702 
10703 	      /* Combine the gptab entries for this input section one
10704 		 by one.  We know that the input gptab entries are
10705 		 sorted by ascending -G value.  */
10706 	      size = input_section->size;
10707 	      last = 0;
10708 	      for (gpentry = sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab);
10709 		   gpentry < size;
10710 		   gpentry += sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab))
10711 		{
10712 		  Elf32_External_gptab ext_gptab;
10713 		  Elf32_gptab int_gptab;
10714 		  unsigned long val;
10715 		  unsigned long add;
10716 		  bfd_boolean exact;
10717 		  unsigned int look;
10718 
10719 		  if (! (bfd_get_section_contents
10720 			 (input_bfd, input_section, &ext_gptab, gpentry,
10721 			  sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab))))
10722 		    {
10723 		      free (tab);
10724 		      return FALSE;
10725 		    }
10726 
10727 		  bfd_mips_elf32_swap_gptab_in (input_bfd, &ext_gptab,
10728 						&int_gptab);
10729 		  val = int_gptab.gt_entry.gt_g_value;
10730 		  add = int_gptab.gt_entry.gt_bytes - last;
10731 
10732 		  exact = FALSE;
10733 		  for (look = 1; look < c; look++)
10734 		    {
10735 		      if (tab[look].gt_entry.gt_g_value >= val)
10736 			tab[look].gt_entry.gt_bytes += add;
10737 
10738 		      if (tab[look].gt_entry.gt_g_value == val)
10739 			exact = TRUE;
10740 		    }
10741 
10742 		  if (! exact)
10743 		    {
10744 		      Elf32_gptab *new_tab;
10745 		      unsigned int max;
10746 
10747 		      /* We need a new table entry.  */
10748 		      amt = (bfd_size_type) (c + 1) * sizeof (Elf32_gptab);
10749 		      new_tab = bfd_realloc (tab, amt);
10750 		      if (new_tab == NULL)
10751 			{
10752 			  free (tab);
10753 			  return FALSE;
10754 			}
10755 		      tab = new_tab;
10756 		      tab[c].gt_entry.gt_g_value = val;
10757 		      tab[c].gt_entry.gt_bytes = add;
10758 
10759 		      /* Merge in the size for the next smallest -G
10760 			 value, since that will be implied by this new
10761 			 value.  */
10762 		      max = 0;
10763 		      for (look = 1; look < c; look++)
10764 			{
10765 			  if (tab[look].gt_entry.gt_g_value < val
10766 			      && (max == 0
10767 				  || (tab[look].gt_entry.gt_g_value
10768 				      > tab[max].gt_entry.gt_g_value)))
10769 			    max = look;
10770 			}
10771 		      if (max != 0)
10772 			tab[c].gt_entry.gt_bytes +=
10773 			  tab[max].gt_entry.gt_bytes;
10774 
10775 		      ++c;
10776 		    }
10777 
10778 		  last = int_gptab.gt_entry.gt_bytes;
10779 		}
10780 
10781 	      /* Hack: reset the SEC_HAS_CONTENTS flag so that
10782 		 elf_link_input_bfd ignores this section.  */
10783 	      input_section->flags &= ~SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
10784 	    }
10785 
10786 	  /* The table must be sorted by -G value.  */
10787 	  if (c > 2)
10788 	    qsort (tab + 1, c - 1, sizeof (tab[0]), gptab_compare);
10789 
10790 	  /* Swap out the table.  */
10791 	  amt = (bfd_size_type) c * sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab);
10792 	  ext_tab = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
10793 	  if (ext_tab == NULL)
10794 	    {
10795 	      free (tab);
10796 	      return FALSE;
10797 	    }
10798 
10799 	  for (j = 0; j < c; j++)
10800 	    bfd_mips_elf32_swap_gptab_out (abfd, tab + j, ext_tab + j);
10801 	  free (tab);
10802 
10803 	  o->size = c * sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab);
10804 	  o->contents = (bfd_byte *) ext_tab;
10805 
10806 	  /* Skip this section later on (I don't think this currently
10807 	     matters, but someday it might).  */
10808 	  o->map_head.link_order = NULL;
10809 	}
10810     }
10811 
10812   /* Invoke the regular ELF backend linker to do all the work.  */
10813   if (!bfd_elf_final_link (abfd, info))
10814     return FALSE;
10815 
10816   /* Now write out the computed sections.  */
10817 
10818   if (reginfo_sec != NULL)
10819     {
10820       Elf32_External_RegInfo ext;
10821 
10822       bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_out (abfd, &reginfo, &ext);
10823       if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, reginfo_sec, &ext, 0, sizeof ext))
10824 	return FALSE;
10825     }
10826 
10827   if (mdebug_sec != NULL)
10828     {
10829       BFD_ASSERT (abfd->output_has_begun);
10830       if (! bfd_ecoff_write_accumulated_debug (mdebug_handle, abfd, &debug,
10831 					       swap, info,
10832 					       mdebug_sec->filepos))
10833 	return FALSE;
10834 
10835       bfd_ecoff_debug_free (mdebug_handle, abfd, &debug, swap, info);
10836     }
10837 
10838   if (gptab_data_sec != NULL)
10839     {
10840       if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, gptab_data_sec,
10841 				      gptab_data_sec->contents,
10842 				      0, gptab_data_sec->size))
10843 	return FALSE;
10844     }
10845 
10846   if (gptab_bss_sec != NULL)
10847     {
10848       if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, gptab_bss_sec,
10849 				      gptab_bss_sec->contents,
10850 				      0, gptab_bss_sec->size))
10851 	return FALSE;
10852     }
10853 
10854   if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd))
10855     {
10856       rtproc_sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rtproc");
10857       if (rtproc_sec != NULL)
10858 	{
10859 	  if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, rtproc_sec,
10860 					  rtproc_sec->contents,
10861 					  0, rtproc_sec->size))
10862 	    return FALSE;
10863 	}
10864     }
10865 
10866   return TRUE;
10867 }
10868 
10869 /* Structure for saying that BFD machine EXTENSION extends BASE.  */
10870 
10871 struct mips_mach_extension {
10872   unsigned long extension, base;
10873 };
10874 
10875 
10876 /* An array describing how BFD machines relate to one another.  The entries
10877    are ordered topologically with MIPS I extensions listed last.  */
10878 
10879 static const struct mips_mach_extension mips_mach_extensions[] = {
10880   /* MIPS64r2 extensions.  */
10881   { bfd_mach_mips_octeon, bfd_mach_mipsisa64r2 },
10882 
10883   /* MIPS64 extensions.  */
10884   { bfd_mach_mipsisa64r2, bfd_mach_mipsisa64 },
10885   { bfd_mach_mips_sb1, bfd_mach_mipsisa64 },
10886 
10887   /* MIPS V extensions.  */
10888   { bfd_mach_mipsisa64, bfd_mach_mips5 },
10889 
10890   /* R10000 extensions.  */
10891   { bfd_mach_mips12000, bfd_mach_mips10000 },
10892 
10893   /* R5000 extensions.  Note: the vr5500 ISA is an extension of the core
10894      vr5400 ISA, but doesn't include the multimedia stuff.  It seems
10895      better to allow vr5400 and vr5500 code to be merged anyway, since
10896      many libraries will just use the core ISA.  Perhaps we could add
10897      some sort of ASE flag if this ever proves a problem.  */
10898   { bfd_mach_mips5500, bfd_mach_mips5400 },
10899   { bfd_mach_mips5400, bfd_mach_mips5000 },
10900 
10901   /* MIPS IV extensions.  */
10902   { bfd_mach_mips5, bfd_mach_mips8000 },
10903   { bfd_mach_mips10000, bfd_mach_mips8000 },
10904   { bfd_mach_mips5000, bfd_mach_mips8000 },
10905   { bfd_mach_mips7000, bfd_mach_mips8000 },
10906   { bfd_mach_mips9000, bfd_mach_mips8000 },
10907 
10908   /* VR4100 extensions.  */
10909   { bfd_mach_mips4120, bfd_mach_mips4100 },
10910   { bfd_mach_mips4111, bfd_mach_mips4100 },
10911 
10912   /* MIPS III extensions.  */
10913   { bfd_mach_mips8000, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
10914   { bfd_mach_mips4650, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
10915   { bfd_mach_mips4600, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
10916   { bfd_mach_mips4400, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
10917   { bfd_mach_mips4300, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
10918   { bfd_mach_mips4100, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
10919   { bfd_mach_mips4010, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
10920 
10921   /* MIPS32 extensions.  */
10922   { bfd_mach_mipsisa32r2, bfd_mach_mipsisa32 },
10923 
10924   /* MIPS II extensions.  */
10925   { bfd_mach_mips4000, bfd_mach_mips6000 },
10926   { bfd_mach_mipsisa32, bfd_mach_mips6000 },
10927 
10928   /* MIPS I extensions.  */
10929   { bfd_mach_mips6000, bfd_mach_mips3000 },
10930   { bfd_mach_mips3900, bfd_mach_mips3000 }
10931 };
10932 
10933 
10934 /* Return true if bfd machine EXTENSION is an extension of machine BASE.  */
10935 
10936 static bfd_boolean
mips_mach_extends_p(unsigned long base,unsigned long extension)10937 mips_mach_extends_p (unsigned long base, unsigned long extension)
10938 {
10939   size_t i;
10940 
10941   if (extension == base)
10942     return TRUE;
10943 
10944   if (base == bfd_mach_mipsisa32
10945       && mips_mach_extends_p (bfd_mach_mipsisa64, extension))
10946     return TRUE;
10947 
10948   if (base == bfd_mach_mipsisa32r2
10949       && mips_mach_extends_p (bfd_mach_mipsisa64r2, extension))
10950     return TRUE;
10951 
10952   for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (mips_mach_extensions); i++)
10953     if (extension == mips_mach_extensions[i].extension)
10954       {
10955 	extension = mips_mach_extensions[i].base;
10956 	if (extension == base)
10957 	  return TRUE;
10958       }
10959 
10960   return FALSE;
10961 }
10962 
10963 
10964 /* Return true if the given ELF header flags describe a 32-bit binary.  */
10965 
10966 static bfd_boolean
mips_32bit_flags_p(flagword flags)10967 mips_32bit_flags_p (flagword flags)
10968 {
10969   return ((flags & EF_MIPS_32BITMODE) != 0
10970 	  || (flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_O32
10971 	  || (flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_EABI32
10972 	  || (flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_1
10973 	  || (flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_2
10974 	  || (flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_32
10975 	  || (flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_32R2);
10976 }
10977 
10978 
10979 /* Merge object attributes from IBFD into OBFD.  Raise an error if
10980    there are conflicting attributes.  */
10981 static bfd_boolean
mips_elf_merge_obj_attributes(bfd * ibfd,bfd * obfd)10982 mips_elf_merge_obj_attributes (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
10983 {
10984   obj_attribute *in_attr;
10985   obj_attribute *out_attr;
10986 
10987   if (!elf_known_obj_attributes_proc (obfd)[0].i)
10988     {
10989       /* This is the first object.  Copy the attributes.  */
10990       _bfd_elf_copy_obj_attributes (ibfd, obfd);
10991 
10992       /* Use the Tag_null value to indicate the attributes have been
10993 	 initialized.  */
10994       elf_known_obj_attributes_proc (obfd)[0].i = 1;
10995 
10996       return TRUE;
10997     }
10998 
10999   /* Check for conflicting Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP attributes and merge
11000      non-conflicting ones.  */
11001   in_attr = elf_known_obj_attributes (ibfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
11002   out_attr = elf_known_obj_attributes (obfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
11003   if (in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i != out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i)
11004     {
11005       out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].type = 1;
11006       if (out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i == 0)
11007 	out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i = in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i;
11008       else if (in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i == 0)
11009 	;
11010       else if (in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i > 3)
11011 	_bfd_error_handler
11012 	  (_("Warning: %B uses unknown floating point ABI %d"), ibfd,
11013 	   in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i);
11014       else if (out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i > 3)
11015 	_bfd_error_handler
11016 	  (_("Warning: %B uses unknown floating point ABI %d"), obfd,
11017 	   out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i);
11018       else
11019 	switch (out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i)
11020 	  {
11021 	  case 1:
11022 	    switch (in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i)
11023 	      {
11024 	      case 2:
11025 		_bfd_error_handler
11026 		  (_("Warning: %B uses -msingle-float, %B uses -mdouble-float"),
11027 		   obfd, ibfd);
11028 
11029 	      case 3:
11030 		_bfd_error_handler
11031 		  (_("Warning: %B uses hard float, %B uses soft float"),
11032 		   obfd, ibfd);
11033 		break;
11034 
11035 	      default:
11036 		abort ();
11037 	      }
11038 	    break;
11039 
11040 	  case 2:
11041 	    switch (in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i)
11042 	      {
11043 	      case 1:
11044 		_bfd_error_handler
11045 		  (_("Warning: %B uses -msingle-float, %B uses -mdouble-float"),
11046 		   ibfd, obfd);
11047 
11048 	      case 3:
11049 		_bfd_error_handler
11050 		  (_("Warning: %B uses hard float, %B uses soft float"),
11051 		   obfd, ibfd);
11052 		break;
11053 
11054 	      default:
11055 		abort ();
11056 	      }
11057 	    break;
11058 
11059 	  case 3:
11060 	    switch (in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i)
11061 	      {
11062 	      case 1:
11063 	      case 2:
11064 		_bfd_error_handler
11065 		  (_("Warning: %B uses hard float, %B uses soft float"),
11066 		   ibfd, obfd);
11067 		break;
11068 
11069 	      default:
11070 		abort ();
11071 	      }
11072 	    break;
11073 
11074 	  default:
11075 	    abort ();
11076 	  }
11077     }
11078 
11079   /* Merge Tag_compatibility attributes and any common GNU ones.  */
11080   _bfd_elf_merge_object_attributes (ibfd, obfd);
11081 
11082   return TRUE;
11083 }
11084 
11085 /* Merge backend specific data from an object file to the output
11086    object file when linking.  */
11087 
11088 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_merge_private_bfd_data(bfd * ibfd,bfd * obfd)11089 _bfd_mips_elf_merge_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
11090 {
11091   flagword old_flags;
11092   flagword new_flags;
11093   bfd_boolean ok;
11094   bfd_boolean null_input_bfd = TRUE;
11095   asection *sec;
11096 
11097   /* Check if we have the same endianess */
11098   if (! _bfd_generic_verify_endian_match (ibfd, obfd))
11099     {
11100       (*_bfd_error_handler)
11101 	(_("%B: endianness incompatible with that of the selected emulation"),
11102 	 ibfd);
11103       return FALSE;
11104     }
11105 
11106   if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
11107       || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
11108     return TRUE;
11109 
11110   if (strcmp (bfd_get_target (ibfd), bfd_get_target (obfd)) != 0)
11111     {
11112       (*_bfd_error_handler)
11113 	(_("%B: ABI is incompatible with that of the selected emulation"),
11114 	 ibfd);
11115       return FALSE;
11116     }
11117 
11118   if (!mips_elf_merge_obj_attributes (ibfd, obfd))
11119     return FALSE;
11120 
11121   new_flags = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_flags;
11122   elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= new_flags & EF_MIPS_NOREORDER;
11123   old_flags = elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags;
11124 
11125   if (! elf_flags_init (obfd))
11126     {
11127       elf_flags_init (obfd) = TRUE;
11128       elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags = new_flags;
11129       elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS]
11130 	= elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS];
11131 
11132       if (bfd_get_arch (obfd) == bfd_get_arch (ibfd)
11133 	  && (bfd_get_arch_info (obfd)->the_default
11134 	      || mips_mach_extends_p (bfd_get_mach (obfd),
11135 				      bfd_get_mach (ibfd))))
11136 	{
11137 	  if (! bfd_set_arch_mach (obfd, bfd_get_arch (ibfd),
11138 				   bfd_get_mach (ibfd)))
11139 	    return FALSE;
11140 	}
11141 
11142       return TRUE;
11143     }
11144 
11145   /* Check flag compatibility.  */
11146 
11147   new_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_NOREORDER;
11148   old_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_NOREORDER;
11149 
11150   /* Some IRIX 6 BSD-compatibility objects have this bit set.  It
11151      doesn't seem to matter.  */
11152   new_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_XGOT;
11153   old_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_XGOT;
11154 
11155   /* MIPSpro generates ucode info in n64 objects.  Again, we should
11156      just be able to ignore this.  */
11157   new_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_UCODE;
11158   old_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_UCODE;
11159 
11160   /* Don't care about the PIC flags from dynamic objects; they are
11161      PIC by design.  */
11162   if ((new_flags & (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC)) != 0
11163       && (ibfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0)
11164     new_flags &= ~ (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC);
11165 
11166   if (new_flags == old_flags)
11167     return TRUE;
11168 
11169   /* Check to see if the input BFD actually contains any sections.
11170      If not, its flags may not have been initialised either, but it cannot
11171      actually cause any incompatibility.  */
11172   for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
11173     {
11174       /* Ignore synthetic sections and empty .text, .data and .bss sections
11175 	  which are automatically generated by gas.  */
11176       if (strcmp (sec->name, ".reginfo")
11177 	  && strcmp (sec->name, ".mdebug")
11178 	  && (sec->size != 0
11179 	      || (strcmp (sec->name, ".text")
11180 		  && strcmp (sec->name, ".data")
11181 		  && strcmp (sec->name, ".bss"))))
11182 	{
11183 	  null_input_bfd = FALSE;
11184 	  break;
11185 	}
11186     }
11187   if (null_input_bfd)
11188     return TRUE;
11189 
11190   ok = TRUE;
11191 
11192   if (((new_flags & (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC)) != 0)
11193       != ((old_flags & (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC)) != 0))
11194     {
11195       (*_bfd_error_handler)
11196 	(_("%B: warning: linking PIC files with non-PIC files"),
11197 	 ibfd);
11198       ok = TRUE;
11199     }
11200 
11201   if (new_flags & (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC))
11202     elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= EF_MIPS_CPIC;
11203   if (! (new_flags & EF_MIPS_PIC))
11204     elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_PIC;
11205 
11206   new_flags &= ~ (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC);
11207   old_flags &= ~ (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC);
11208 
11209   /* Compare the ISAs.  */
11210   if (mips_32bit_flags_p (old_flags) != mips_32bit_flags_p (new_flags))
11211     {
11212       (*_bfd_error_handler)
11213 	(_("%B: linking 32-bit code with 64-bit code"),
11214 	 ibfd);
11215       ok = FALSE;
11216     }
11217   else if (!mips_mach_extends_p (bfd_get_mach (ibfd), bfd_get_mach (obfd)))
11218     {
11219       /* OBFD's ISA isn't the same as, or an extension of, IBFD's.  */
11220       if (mips_mach_extends_p (bfd_get_mach (obfd), bfd_get_mach (ibfd)))
11221 	{
11222 	  /* Copy the architecture info from IBFD to OBFD.  Also copy
11223 	     the 32-bit flag (if set) so that we continue to recognise
11224 	     OBFD as a 32-bit binary.  */
11225 	  bfd_set_arch_info (obfd, bfd_get_arch_info (ibfd));
11226 	  elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags &= ~(EF_MIPS_ARCH | EF_MIPS_MACH);
11227 	  elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags
11228 	    |= new_flags & (EF_MIPS_ARCH | EF_MIPS_MACH | EF_MIPS_32BITMODE);
11229 
11230 	  /* Copy across the ABI flags if OBFD doesn't use them
11231 	     and if that was what caused us to treat IBFD as 32-bit.  */
11232 	  if ((old_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == 0
11233 	      && mips_32bit_flags_p (new_flags)
11234 	      && !mips_32bit_flags_p (new_flags & ~EF_MIPS_ABI))
11235 	    elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= new_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI;
11236 	}
11237       else
11238 	{
11239 	  /* The ISAs aren't compatible.  */
11240 	  (*_bfd_error_handler)
11241 	    (_("%B: linking %s module with previous %s modules"),
11242 	     ibfd,
11243 	     bfd_printable_name (ibfd),
11244 	     bfd_printable_name (obfd));
11245 	  ok = FALSE;
11246 	}
11247     }
11248 
11249   new_flags &= ~(EF_MIPS_ARCH | EF_MIPS_MACH | EF_MIPS_32BITMODE);
11250   old_flags &= ~(EF_MIPS_ARCH | EF_MIPS_MACH | EF_MIPS_32BITMODE);
11251 
11252   /* Compare ABIs.  The 64-bit ABI does not use EF_MIPS_ABI.  But, it
11253      does set EI_CLASS differently from any 32-bit ABI.  */
11254   if ((new_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) != (old_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI)
11255       || (elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS]
11256 	  != elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS]))
11257     {
11258       /* Only error if both are set (to different values).  */
11259       if (((new_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) && (old_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI))
11260 	  || (elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS]
11261 	      != elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS]))
11262 	{
11263 	  (*_bfd_error_handler)
11264 	    (_("%B: ABI mismatch: linking %s module with previous %s modules"),
11265 	     ibfd,
11266 	     elf_mips_abi_name (ibfd),
11267 	     elf_mips_abi_name (obfd));
11268 	  ok = FALSE;
11269 	}
11270       new_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_ABI;
11271       old_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_ABI;
11272     }
11273 
11274   /* For now, allow arbitrary mixing of ASEs (retain the union).  */
11275   if ((new_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE) != (old_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE))
11276     {
11277       elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= new_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE;
11278 
11279       new_flags &= ~ EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE;
11280       old_flags &= ~ EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE;
11281     }
11282 
11283   /* Warn about any other mismatches */
11284   if (new_flags != old_flags)
11285     {
11286       (*_bfd_error_handler)
11287 	(_("%B: uses different e_flags (0x%lx) fields than previous modules (0x%lx)"),
11288 	 ibfd, (unsigned long) new_flags,
11289 	 (unsigned long) old_flags);
11290       ok = FALSE;
11291     }
11292 
11293   if (! ok)
11294     {
11295       bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
11296       return FALSE;
11297     }
11298 
11299   return TRUE;
11300 }
11301 
11302 /* Function to keep MIPS specific file flags like as EF_MIPS_PIC.  */
11303 
11304 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_set_private_flags(bfd * abfd,flagword flags)11305 _bfd_mips_elf_set_private_flags (bfd *abfd, flagword flags)
11306 {
11307   BFD_ASSERT (!elf_flags_init (abfd)
11308 	      || elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags == flags);
11309 
11310   elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags = flags;
11311   elf_flags_init (abfd) = TRUE;
11312   return TRUE;
11313 }
11314 
11315 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_print_private_bfd_data(bfd * abfd,void * ptr)11316 _bfd_mips_elf_print_private_bfd_data (bfd *abfd, void *ptr)
11317 {
11318   FILE *file = ptr;
11319 
11320   BFD_ASSERT (abfd != NULL && ptr != NULL);
11321 
11322   /* Print normal ELF private data.  */
11323   _bfd_elf_print_private_bfd_data (abfd, ptr);
11324 
11325   /* xgettext:c-format */
11326   fprintf (file, _("private flags = %lx:"), elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags);
11327 
11328   if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_O32)
11329     fprintf (file, _(" [abi=O32]"));
11330   else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_O64)
11331     fprintf (file, _(" [abi=O64]"));
11332   else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_EABI32)
11333     fprintf (file, _(" [abi=EABI32]"));
11334   else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_EABI64)
11335     fprintf (file, _(" [abi=EABI64]"));
11336   else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI))
11337     fprintf (file, _(" [abi unknown]"));
11338   else if (ABI_N32_P (abfd))
11339     fprintf (file, _(" [abi=N32]"));
11340   else if (ABI_64_P (abfd))
11341     fprintf (file, _(" [abi=64]"));
11342   else
11343     fprintf (file, _(" [no abi set]"));
11344 
11345   if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_1)
11346     fprintf (file, " [mips1]");
11347   else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_2)
11348     fprintf (file, " [mips2]");
11349   else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_3)
11350     fprintf (file, " [mips3]");
11351   else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_4)
11352     fprintf (file, " [mips4]");
11353   else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_5)
11354     fprintf (file, " [mips5]");
11355   else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_32)
11356     fprintf (file, " [mips32]");
11357   else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_64)
11358     fprintf (file, " [mips64]");
11359   else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_32R2)
11360     fprintf (file, " [mips32r2]");
11361   else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_64R2)
11362     fprintf (file, " [mips64r2]");
11363   else
11364     fprintf (file, _(" [unknown ISA]"));
11365 
11366   if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE_MDMX)
11367     fprintf (file, " [mdmx]");
11368 
11369   if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE_M16)
11370     fprintf (file, " [mips16]");
11371 
11372   if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_32BITMODE)
11373     fprintf (file, " [32bitmode]");
11374   else
11375     fprintf (file, _(" [not 32bitmode]"));
11376 
11377   if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_NOREORDER)
11378     fprintf (file, " [noreorder]");
11379 
11380   if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_PIC)
11381     fprintf (file, " [PIC]");
11382 
11383   if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_CPIC)
11384     fprintf (file, " [CPIC]");
11385 
11386   if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_XGOT)
11387     fprintf (file, " [XGOT]");
11388 
11389   if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_UCODE)
11390     fprintf (file, " [UCODE]");
11391 
11392   fputc ('\n', file);
11393 
11394   return TRUE;
11395 }
11396 
11397 const struct bfd_elf_special_section _bfd_mips_elf_special_sections[] =
11398 {
11399   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".lit4"),   0, SHT_PROGBITS,   SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_MIPS_GPREL },
11400   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".lit8"),   0, SHT_PROGBITS,   SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_MIPS_GPREL },
11401   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".mdebug"), 0, SHT_MIPS_DEBUG, 0 },
11402   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sbss"),  -2, SHT_NOBITS,     SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_MIPS_GPREL },
11403   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sdata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS,   SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_MIPS_GPREL },
11404   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".ucode"),  0, SHT_MIPS_UCODE, 0 },
11405   { NULL,                     0,  0, 0,              0 }
11406 };
11407 
11408 /* Merge non visibility st_other attributes.  Ensure that the
11409    STO_OPTIONAL flag is copied into h->other, even if this is not a
11410    definiton of the symbol.  */
11411 void
_bfd_mips_elf_merge_symbol_attribute(struct elf_link_hash_entry * h,const Elf_Internal_Sym * isym,bfd_boolean definition,bfd_boolean dynamic ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)11412 _bfd_mips_elf_merge_symbol_attribute (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
11413 				      const Elf_Internal_Sym *isym,
11414 				      bfd_boolean definition,
11415 				      bfd_boolean dynamic ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
11416 {
11417   if ((isym->st_other & ~ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (-1)) != 0)
11418     {
11419       unsigned char other;
11420 
11421       other = (definition ? isym->st_other : h->other);
11422       other &= ~ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (-1);
11423       h->other = other | ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other);
11424     }
11425 
11426   if (!definition
11427       && ELF_MIPS_IS_OPTIONAL (isym->st_other))
11428     h->other |= STO_OPTIONAL;
11429 }
11430 
11431 /* Decide whether an undefined symbol is special and can be ignored.
11432    This is the case for OPTIONAL symbols on IRIX.  */
11433 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_ignore_undef_symbol(struct elf_link_hash_entry * h)11434 _bfd_mips_elf_ignore_undef_symbol (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
11435 {
11436   return ELF_MIPS_IS_OPTIONAL (h->other) ? TRUE : FALSE;
11437 }
11438 
11439 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_common_definition(Elf_Internal_Sym * sym)11440 _bfd_mips_elf_common_definition (Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
11441 {
11442   return (sym->st_shndx == SHN_COMMON
11443 	  || sym->st_shndx == SHN_MIPS_ACOMMON
11444 	  || sym->st_shndx == SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON);
11445 }
11446